WorkshopManual Indica PDF
WorkshopManual Indica PDF
WorkshopManual Indica PDF
INDICA
GROUP INDEX
All specifications are given in C.G.S. System (Metric Reproduction or translation of the whole or part of the
System) unless otherwise specified. workshop manual without our written approval is
prohibited.
Created by :
Tata Motors Ltd. Subject to modification in Design, Specification and
PCBU - International Business. Equipment.
Mumbai
ii
GROUP INDEX
MAIN INTRODUCTION
iii
GROUP INDEX
GROUP INDEX
GENERAL G
ENGINE (475 SI MPFI)
FUEL SYSTEM
EXHAUST
CLUTCH
TRANSAXLE
DRIVE SHAFT
SUSPENSION
BRAKES
ABS
MECHANICAL STEERING
POWER STEERING
BODY
AIR CONDITIONING
ELECTRICAL
DIAGNOSTICS
v
GROUP INDEX
GENERAL
NEXT
GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
GENERAL G
GENERAL
INTRODUCTION :
i
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
GENERAL G
GENERAL
CONTENTS
6. Technical Specifications 9
8. Filling Capacities 18
iii
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
GENERAL G
GENERAL
GOOD WORKSHOP PRACTICE & SAFETY
PRECAUTIONS
Following are some safety precautions to be observed in
the workshop.
l Always ensure that all the repair / maintenance work
carried out should be as per the instructions provided
in the workshop manual.
l Use protective clothing, apron, hand gloves, and safety
shoes while working in the workshop. Do not wear
watch, rings and belt while serving the vehicle.
l Keep your work area, equipment and tools clean at all
times.
l Make sure you use the proper tool for the job and use
it the rightway. The improper tool or its incorrect use Fig. 1
can damage the part you are working on or cause
injury or both.
l Never keep the tools on the floor/vehicle. The tools
should be kept in the tool box after use.
l Cover fenders, seats, steering wheel and any other
parts those are likely to get scratched/soiled before
starting any service work (Fig. 1).
l While servicing the vehicle in engine running condition
make sure that the gear shifting lever is in neutral
position and parking brake is fully applied. Never run
the engine without proper ventilation and adequate
means of getting rid of exhaust gases.
l Do not work near the radiator fan when engine is ‘ON’
to avoid getting injured by electrically operated
radiator fan.
Fig. 2
l Prior to removing or disassembling parts, they must
be inspected carefully to isolate the cause for which
the service is called for (Fig. 2).
l All the reusable dismantled components must be kept
in a clean enamel coated white tray sequentially in an
orderly manner to facilitate their accurate and proper
reinstallation (Fig. 3).
l Never reuse the parts like oil seals, gaskets, packing,
O-rings, locking washers, split pins, self locking nuts
and certain other parts.
l Plug the ports / openings of aggregates such as FIP /
Injectors, TMC, etc., whenever removed from the car.
Fig. 3
1
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
GENERAL G
GENERAL
l For correct reinstallation of vacuum fuel hoses attach
a tag describing the correct positions (Fig. 4).
l Make sure only the branded lubricants, coolant,
corrosion protection coatings and sealants are used.
nif ke
ma inta
old
To
r
te
nis
Ca
To
Fig. 4
l Check all the lines for leaks related to the systems like
fuel, oil, coolant, vacuum, exhaust and brakes after
servicing (Fig. 5).
Fig. 5
2
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
GENERAL G
GENERAL
Precaution for Electrical circuit service :
l Disconnect the negative cable of the battery while
servicing the electrical parts that do not require battery
power (Fig. 7).
l While removing the battery first disconnect the
negative cable and then the positive cable. While
reinstalling the battery, first connect the positive cable
and then negative cable.
Fig. 7
Fig. 8
Fig. 9
3
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
GENERAL G
GENERAL
l Dirt / corroded terminals result in improper contact.
The terminals should be cleaned carefully.
l Improper contact pressure between mating terminals
disturbs the connectivity between them.
l Replace the damaged connector body to avoid
exposure of the terminals in case of inadequate
contact pressure.
l Ensure proper connection between the terminal to
the wire. Rectify the loose connection by repairing /
replacing the wire harness (Fig. 10).
l Worn out insulation of the wire may result in short
circuit.
l Avoid water entering the connectors.
Fig. 10
Fig. 11b
4
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
GENERAL G
GENERAL
LIFTING AND JACKING POINTS
Rear LH
Rear RH
Front RH Front LH
Fig. 12
Fig. 13
5
NEXT
INDEX
PREVIOUS
GENERAL G
CHASSIS TYPE NO. AND SALES DESIGNATIONS
GENERAL
CHASSIS TYPES
PETROL VERSIONS
600 234 INDICA LEi Indica car with MPFI 75 PS, Euro-II, Petrol Engine, Power Steering, heating demist.
600 206 INDICA LSi Indica car with MPFI 75 PS, Euro-II, Petrol Engine, Power Steering, HVAC.
600 260 INDICA LX Indica car with MPFI 85 PS, Euro-II, Petrol Engine, Power Steering, HVAC, DAB
& ABS.
600 261 INDICA LXi Indica car with MPFI 85 PS, Euro-II, Petrol Engine, Power Steering, HVAC, DAB, PAB
& ABS.
6
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
GENERAL G
GENERAL
CHASSIS NUMBERING SYSTEM & LOCATION (for location see fig. 14)
Chassis number consists of 17 digits as given below :
Indicates produced in
TATA Motors Limited, India
L - For LHD
Example :
MAT 600 260 4PR 00065 indicates Indica MPFI 85 PS, Euro-II, Petrol Engine, Power Steering, HVAC, DAB & ABS, produced
between 1.4.2003 to 31.3.2004 in K-block Pune, Right hand drive for export and Sr. No. of the car is 00065.
CHASSIS NUMBER
(on dashboard corner)
Chassis
VIN No. No. Engine
Number
Fig. 14 Fig. 15
7
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
GENERAL G
GENERAL
AGGREGATE NUMBERING SYSTEM Barrel 1
: Indicates basic model
& LOCATION: (for location see fig. 15) 21 For TA 65 Transaxle
Barrel 2 : First digit indicates control of vehicle as
ENGINE : Numbering below :
1 - For normal control vehicle
XXXXX XX X X XX X XXXXX 3 - Full forward control vehicle
Second digit indicates first and second
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
gear speed ratio with version of gear box
Barrel 1 : Indicates engine model as below -
475 SI : For MPFI engine Eg. : F - for first gear ratio 3.42 / second gear ratio
1.95 with 5 gear version, Gear final 65/14
Barrel 2 : Variation in basic model with speedo ratio 19/17.
45 : 475 SI Injected type petrol engine, 85 PS, Barrel 3 : Indicates year of production
@ 5500 rpm, MPFI, meeting EURO-III emis- 3 for - 2003
sion norms. 4 for - 2004
5 for - 2005
Barrel 3 : ‘L’ in case of LHD executions
6 for - 2006
Punching of ‘L’ is not required if engine is
7 for - 2007
same for RHD and LHD executions.
Barrel 4 : Indicates plant location
Barrel 4 : Month of production. P for ‘K’ Block Pune
Barrel 5 : Indicates Serial no. of Transaxle, consists of
Month Code Month Code Month Code
5 digits and commences from serial no.
January A May E Sept. J 00001 and will start every year on first
February B June F October K January.
Example - 211F 3P 00005
March C July G Nov. L
BODY SHELL : Numbering
April D August H Dec. M XX X X XXXXX
1 2 3 4
Barrel 5 : Year of production Barrel 1 : - Indicates, Basic model
WZ - For 2003 M1 for Indica MPFI - Euro III
VZ - For 2004 Barrel 2 : - Indicates year of production
UZ - For 2005 3 for 2003
4 for 2004
TZ - For 2006 5 for 2005
SZ - For 2007 6 for 2006
7 for 2007
Barrel 6 : Indicates plant location.
Barrel 3 : - Indicates plant location
P - for ‘K’ block, pune
P for K Block Pune
Barrel 7 : Serial No. Indicates Serial No. Of engine. Barrel 4 : - Indicates cumulative serial number to
The barrel consists of 5 digits and start every year with 00001 on first January.
commences from serial number 00001 &
will start every year on first January. Example : M1 3P 00001
XX XX X X XXXXX
Transaxle Number
1 2 3 4 5
Fig. 16
8
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
GENERAL G
GENERAL
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
2. CLUTCH
Single plate dry friction Single plate dry friction
diaphragm type. diaphragm type.
Outside diameter of : 190 mm 190 mm
Clutch lining
Friction Area : 285 sq.cm. 285 sq.cm.
3. TRANSAXLE
Front wheel drive through Front wheel drive through
constant velocity joints constant velocity joints
Model : TA 65-5/3.42 (5 speed) TA 65 -5/3.42 (5 speed)
with overdrive with overdrive
Type : Synchromesh on all Synchromesh on all
forward gears. Sliding forward gears. Sliding
mesh for reverse gears mesh for reverse gears
No. of gears : 5 forward 5 forward
1 reverse 1 reverse
9
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
GENERAL G
GENERAL
VEHICLE LEi & LSi LX & LXi
Gear ratios : 1st - 3.42 3.42
2nd - 1.95 1.95
3rd - 1.36 1.36
4th - 0.95 0.95
5th - 0.77 0.714
REV. - 3.58 3.58
Final drive ratios : 4.06 4.64
Gear shift : Floor mounted with international “H” pattern with fifth and reverse
inline. (in all models)
4. REAR AXLE : Non driven axle independently suspended. (in all models)
5. SUSPENSION
Front : Independent, Lower wishbone, McPherson Strut type (in all models)
Rear : Independent, Semi-trailing arm with coil spring mounted on
hydraulic shock absorbers. (in all models)
Antiroll Bar : At front At front
6. STEERING
Type : Hydraulic assisted Powerl Rack Hydraulic assisted power Rack
& Pinion Steering Gear & Pinion Steering Gear
with collapsible with collapsible
steering column steering column
Steering Wheel : 380 mm dia. 380 mm dia.
7. BRAKES
Service Brakes : Dual circuit, diagonal Dual circuit, diagonal split
split hydraulic brakes hydraulic brakes through
through tandem tandem master cylinder, vacuum
master cylinder. assisted 9'' Booster. ABS :Standard
(can be optional)
Front Brakes : 231 mm dia., 17mm thick, 231 mm dia., 20mm thick.
ventilated disc brake ventilated disc brake
Rear Brakes : 180 mm dia. drum brake 200 mm dia. drum brake
Parking Brakes : Lever type, Console mounted, Cable operated mechanical linkage
acting on rear wheel. (in all models)
10
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
GENERAL G
GENERAL
VEHICLE LEi & LSi LX & LXi
8. WHEELS AND TYRES
Tyres : 165/65 R13 175/60 R14
Wheel Rims : 4.5 J x 13 Stylised steel rims 5 J x 14 steel rims
No. of Wheels : Front - 2, Rear - 2, Spare - 1 Front - 2, Rear - 2, Spare - 1
9. FUEL TANK
Capacity : 37 litres 37 litres
12. PERFORMANCE
Max. speed at rated GVW : 155 Kmph 160 Kmph
11
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
GENERAL G
GENERAL
VEHICLE LEi & LSi LX & LXi
13. MAIN CHASSIS DIMENSIONS AS PER ISO : 612 IN MM (NOMINAL) (Fig. 17).
(TOLERANCES AS PER INTEREUROPE STVZO)
Wheel Base : 2400 2400
Track Front : 1400 1380
Track Rear : 1380 1374
Front Overhang : 785 785
Rear Overhang : 490 490
Overall Length : 3675 3675
Max. Width -
a) Over body : 1665 1665
b) Over outer rear view : 1915 1915
mirror in folded
condition
Overall Height (Unladen) : 1485 - Unladen 1500 - Unladen
Minimum Turning Circle Dia : 9.8 m 9.8 m
Minimum Turning : 10.2 m 10.2 m
Clearance Circle Dia
Ground Clearance (Unladen) : 166 mm - unladen 165 mm - unladen
12
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
GENERAL G
GENERAL
VEHICLE LEi & LSi LX & LXi
17. EXCLUSIVE CHASSIS FITMNETS
Power Steering : Standard Standard
Radial ply tyres : Standard Standard
Steering Wheel : Four spoke soft feel Four spoke soft feel (pu) with
leather grip
13
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
GENERAL G
GENERAL
VEHICLE LEi & LSi LX & LXi
Rear fog lamp : Not Provided Standard
Key IN, Parking lamp : Not Provided Standard
ON Audio Warning
Side repeater lamp : Standard Standard clear lens with Amber bulbs
Fuel Gauge : Standard Standard
Battery charge : Standard Standard
indication lamp
Horn : High & Low tone High & Low tone
REAR WIPER/WASHER : Standard Standard
with Defogger on Rear Glass
Motorised Head lamp : Not Provided Standard
levelling device
High Mounted stop : Standard Standard
lamp (Spoiler mounted)
Low Fuel warning lamp : Standard Standard
Immobiliser : Standard with Standard with
Remote Sense Remote Sense
Tail lamp and rear : Standard Registration Plate Lamp Standard
registration plate lamp Direction Indicator with Clear Lens
and Amber bulb
Other Standard Items/Features Spot
(Reading) Lamp in Cabin Lamp Security
System on Indicator
Mobile Charger Socket : Standard Standard
14
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
GENERAL G
VEHICLE LEi & LSi LX & LXi GENERAL
15
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
GENERAL
16
Fig. 17
MAIN CHASSIS DIMENSIONS
GENERAL
INDEX
unladen
1485 mm (LEi/LSi)
& 1500 mm (LX/LXi)
2400 mm 490 mm 1400 mm (LEi/LSi)
785 mm 1380 mm (LX/LXi)
GROUP INDEX
1665 mm
1380 mm (LEi/LSi)
1374 mm (LX/LXi)
3675 mm
NEXT
PREVIOUS
G
GENERAL G
GENERAL
TIGHTENING TORQUES OF STANDARD BOLTS & NUTS
Wherever the tightening torques are not specified use the following values for these fastners.
Grade Bolt or Nut Size Pitch (mm) Tightening N-m Torque kg M
M6 1.0 8.5 - 10 0.85 - 1.0
1. This standard is applicable to bolts having the following marks embossed on the bolt head and punch mark on the nut
head.
Grade
8.8 For The Bolt
10.9 For The Bolt
8 For The Nut
10 For The Nut
Note : Always use the calibrated torque wrenches.
17
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
GENERAL G
GENERAL
FILLING CAPACITIES
* PREMIXED READY
TO USE ENGINE
COOLANT @ 6 Litres
IMPORTANT : For petrol cars fitted with Catalytic Converter always use only unleaded petrol with an octane rating of not less than 91 RON
* If concentrated antifreeze agent is used mix it with soft water in the ratio of 50:50.
Fig. 18
18
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
GENERAL G
GENERAL
FUEL, LUBRICANTS & COOLANTS (Details)
Fuel : For Petrol car (with catalytic converter) Transaxle :
Unleaded regular grade petrol conforming to SABS 1598 Use recommended brand of gear oil 75W90 GL4 Synthetic
(or equivalent) and octane rating not less than 91 RON
Grease for axle bearings :
(RON stands for Research Octane Number) is
recommended to be used as fuel. Lithium base complex grease
Do not use leaded petrol in a car fitted with catalytic Brake fluid :
converter.
IS 8654/DOT 4
Even single fill of leaded petrol will seriously damage the
Power Steering :
catalytic converter.
ATF 206/ Dexron
Coolants :
Lubricants:
Presence of dirt in the coolant chokes up passages in the
Engine oil (Petrol Engine) :
radiator,
Recommended grade of engine oil conforming to 10W40
cylinder head and cylinder block, thereby causing
API SL (ACEA A2/B2) specification and range of ambient
insufficient
temperature at which these can be used are given in the
table below. cooling of engine.
Ambient Temp. Engine oil grade To prevent rust formation and freezing of coolant inside
in deg. C the
passages of radiator, cylinder block and cylinder head, use
-20 deg. to 40 deg. SAE 10W/40 only
Below -20 deg. SAE 5W/30 or Lower viscosity branded premixed engine coolant.
grade Engine Coolant Antifreez :
Coolant as per class II, JIS K 2234
19
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
GENERAL G
GENERAL
BRANDED LUBRICANTS & COOLANTS :
USE ONLY GENUINE ENGINE OILS, COOLANTS AND OTHER LUBRICANTS RECOMMENDED BY TATA FOR
OPTIMUM PERFORMANCE
20
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE (475 SI MPFI)
NEXT
GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
ENGINE
i
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
CONTENTS
Sr. No. Description Page No. ENGINE
1. Technical specifications 1
2. List of special tools 2
3. Tightening torques 3
4. Carburetted engine vs MPFI engine 6
5. MPFI engine advantages 7
6. MPFI schematic circuit diagram 8
7. Features of MPFI engine 9
8. MPFI sensors / actuators 12
9. Intank fuel pump 26
10. Ignition Coil Assembly 27
11. ECU 30
12. Trouble shooting of MPFI sensors 32
13. ECU Handling & care 36
14. Preliminary inspection of engine 37
15. Exploded Views 40
16. Removal & installation of engine from the car 58
17. Radiator, removal and installation 60
18. Alternator/Power steering pump & A. C. compressor belts removal, inspection, & fitment
a. For 85 PS Engine 61
b. For 75 PS Engine 63
19. Timing belt Removal / Fitment 64
20. Cylinder Head Sub-assembly
a. Disassembly, inspection of Rocker shafts & arms, spark plug
camshaft, valves, valve guides, valve seats and valve seat inserts 67
b. Assembly of cylinder head 82
c. Valve clearance adjustment 84
21. Cylinder block sub assembly
a. Disassembly, inspection & assembly of : Pistons & piston rings, Connecting rods, 87
Crankshaft, cylinder block, oil pump, water pump, thermostat assembly
b. Removal, installation & machining of cylinder liners 101
22. Lubrication system 103
23. Cooling system 105
24. Air intake system 113
25. Air cleaner 114
26. Accelerator Cable 115
27. Assembly Foot Control 116
28. Engine Testing 117
29. Evaporative Emission Circuit 118
30. Trouble Shooting 119
Note : This section is common for both 85 PS & 75 PS engines, but following pages are exclusive for respective engines:
l For 85 PS : 41, 51, 56 & 61 l For 75 PS : 42, 50, 57 & 63. Please also check page no. 65 for selection of camshaft.
iii
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATION
ENGINE ENGINE
Capacity : 1405 cc
Max. torque
(For LX & LXi) : 115 Nm at 3000 rpm as per ISO : 1585
(For LEi & LSi) : 110 Nm at 3000 rpm as per ISO : 1585
Fuel system : Grouped Injection with close loop Air / Fuel control supported by Hitachi EMS
1
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
ENGINE
Sr. No. Description Part No.
2. Extended socket (10mmA/F) for oil sump mounting screw 2702 5890 06 03
20. Hitachi HDM 2000 diagnostic monitor with accessories 2932 9900 60 54
and Telco cartridge 1.20
2
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
TIGHTENING TORQUES :
The fasteners should be tightened to specified torque at recommended intervals (km). If various fasteners are not
tightened to specified torques, that is either over tightened or let loose, it will result in leakage at joints and ENGINE
damage to the parts/threads. It will also adversely affect the performance of the parts/systems as clearances/
bearing plays in the aggregates are governed by the tightening torques of the fasteners.
When choosing the torque wrench, remember that it should not be subjected to torque exceeding three fourths
of its capacity. Before tightening, clean the threads and apply a little oil.
3
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Tolerance on Torque values + 5% for those marked # and + 10% for others
Note @ Apply oil on seal face and screw in until seal touches face. Tighten further by 3/4 turn. Do not over tighten.
4
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 MPFI - EURO II
INDEX
Cap Head Cover
Head Cover
Inlet Inlet
Manifold Throttle
Manifold
Exhaust Body
Exhaust
Throttle Manifold
Manifold
Body
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Timing
Timing Cover
Cover
AC
Compressor Cylinder Block
AC
GROUP INDEX
Compressor Cylinder Block
NEXT
85 PS ENGINE 75 PS ENGINE
PREVIOUS
5
ENGINE
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
l Fuel Metering
Primary
l Ignition System slow jet
l Cold Start
l Change in Atmospheric Condition Response
(Altitude, Temperature etc.) Bypass
port
Carburetted Engine : (Fig 1).
Primary main jet
l In this case fuel metering is done by carburettor i.e.
fuel quantity is controlled by fuel jet and air flow
Idle port
into the engine due to the vacuum available at the
venturi. Fuel quantity is a continuously variable Fig. 1 Carburettor system - illustration
function with respect to air flow.
2
l Ignition system consists of a Distributor driven by a 1. Fuel
camshaft. The Distributor timing is a continuously 2. Air 1
5
variable function as engine speed and load changes. 3.Throttle valve
4. Intake manifold
Due to Mechanical make/break system, the Ignition 5. Injector
energy is low (low dwell time) at high speeds. 6. Engine 3
6
M U LTI POINT FUEL INJECTION
Fig. 2
6
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Manifold pressure
ENGINE
sensor
Throttle
body
Cylinder head
cover
LTRS
arrangement
Blow
ISC Valve
by hose
Fuel Canister
rail purge
valve
Cylinder
head Intake Ignition
manifold coil
475 SI MPFI ENGINE ADVANTAGES speed is increased as a function of Water and Air
temperature inputs to the ECU.
475 MPFI engine uses HITACHI multipoint fuel injection
system. Seven sensors located at various points in the l Emission :
engine, sense important parameters of the engine The petrol injection engine has low emissions because
operation & send signals to a ECU located under the air fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric using
dashboard. Based on predetermined engine mapping, lambda sensor. Faster warm up from cold start ensures
the ECU precisely controls the fuel delivery injection early operation of catalytic converter in turn reducing
timing to ensure optimum fuel utilisation with the emission.
minimum emission.
l Fuel Economy :
MPFI engine provides the following advantages :
The petrol injection engine has a better fuel economy
l Better Engine Performance : because the engine is optimised at each operating
Optimum fuel quantity and Spark timing is calculated point, discretly.
by ECU for any operating condition. l Quick Response :
l Better Cold Starting and Warm up : The petrol injection engine will have a better
ECU identifies cranking condition and quick starting is driveability and better acceleration since the fuel
ensured by providing sufficient fuel quantity and delivery and spark timing are controlled by ECU,
optimum spark timing. For quicker warm up, idling which quickly responds to engine/Driver demands.
7
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
ENGINE
MPFI SCHEMATIC CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
8
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
FEATURES OF MPFI
FEATURE HOW ACHIEVED USER BENEFIT
CRANKING MODE : ENGINE
Variable Injected Quantity Injector pulse width starts Good Cold starting
with very high value and
drops as cranking rpm, Air & Water
temperature increases.
IDLING MODE :
Idle speed is dependent on Based on inputs to ECU Better Idle stability
l Water temperature
l Engine Load (A/C)
l Battery Voltage
l Manifold Vacuum.
and speed is maintained
by Closed Loop control
ISC Valve memorises ISC Valve position (steps) Better Idle stability
the previous position is continuously memorised whenever Idle state
(Learned Function) and renewed in memory. changes.
9
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
ENGINE
‘LIMP HOME’ Idle Speed When the following sensors Flexibility and user
are ‘No Good’, then idle convenience
speed assumes default value
for Throttle position sensor,
MAP Sensor, Vehicle speed
sensor, air temperature sensor,
water temperature sensor.
‘LIMP HOME’ ISC Valve When ISC Valve fails in User convenience
closed condition, open throttle
marginally to start the engine.
Engine Stall protection When engine rpm is as low Better Idle stability and
as 650 rpm, ECU cuts A/C user convenience
relay.
ACCELERATION MODE :
High Engine Speed Fuel is cut beyond 6500 rpm Engine safety
Control
Zero Vehicle Speed Fuel Fuel is cut if ‘no load Better fuel economy
cut acceleration’ is sustained
beyond certain time say,
180 sec.
A/C compressor is kept A/C relay is cut-off depending Better over taking ability
‘OFF’ during ‘rapid’ upon vehicle speed
acceleration and throttle position.
DECELERATION MODE :
Fuel Cut during ECU cuts the fuel depending upon Better fuel economy
deceleration throttle position and rate of
change of rpm.
10
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Inertia Switch (Fig. 4). When the Vehicle collision Safety (Fire Protection)
occurs, inertia switch cuts
‘OFF’ fuel pump
Immobiliser (If fitted) Remote operated Safety (Anti-theft device)
Immobiliser cuts supply to
Main Relay and Fuel Pump.
11
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
SENSOR SHIELD
W 0.75 EWH
CRANK ANGLE SENSOR 21 CRANK
FWH
(CR+) ANGLE
SENSOR
B 0.75 EWH [ MAKE HITACHI ]
CRANK ANGLE SENSOR 20
FWH
(CR-)
CRANK ANGLE SENSOR SHIELD 19 FWH
EWH
(CRS) W/Y AV 0.75
ECU
12
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
TT-20
Negative Temperature Coefficient (NTC)
2 Pin connector
Working Principle
A semiconductor material changes its resistance when
exposed to variable temperature source.
Resistance decreases as temperature increases.
System Integration :
This sensor provides air temperature or water
temperature input to ECU when placed in air/water Fig. 7 Air temperature sensor
stream.
Fitment Data :
(ATS = AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR)
(WTS = WATER TEMPERATURE SENSOR)
ATS is fitted on air filter (Clean side of air filter) (Fig. 7)
WTS is fitted on thermostat housing (Before
thermostat) (Fig. 8)
Stand Alone Diagnosis (See Illustration) :
for both ATS & WTS
Use Multimeter
Thermister resistance
2.5 k W+ 0.25 k W @ 200 + 10C
0.84 k W+ 0.10 k W @ 500 + 10C W
Fig. 8 Water temperature sensor
Air temperature sensor :
Sensor end Pin assignment
ECU 18 TA
18 26
Electrical Circuit :
ECU 26 TAG
Measure the resistance across pins 18 & 26
EWH
ECU 24 TW
[ MAKE HITACHI ]
BR/W 0.75
24 32 WATER TEMP. SENSOR 32
ECU 32 TWG
GND. (TWG) FWH EWH
13
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
FWH EWH
(+5V)(VCC)
PRESSURE/MAP
Use Hitachi Diagnostic tester W/O 0.75 SENSOR
PRESSURE SENSOR 22
FWH EWH [ MAKE HITACHI ]
SIGNAL (PM)
Check for ‘Intake manifold pressure’ value during
BR/R 0.75
cranking. SENSOR GND. 112
(GNDS)
FWH EWH
0.75
ECU
To Throttle Position
Sensor
14
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
SERA 483-06
Linear Potentiometer type
3-Pin Connector
Working Principle :
A fixed input DC volt to a potentiometer provides a
variable output DC volt when the circuit resistance is
varied externally.
Output voltage increases when circuit resistance
reduces.
System Integration :
Fig. 11 Throttle Position Sensor (TPS)
Sensor provides variable signal Input to ECU when
throttle lever is operated (opened / closed). This
requires a supply volt of 5.12 VDC from ECU.
Fitment Data :
This sensor is a part of Integrated Throttle Body which
is fitted on inlet manifold upstream side. Throttle lever
shaft is extended to a crank lever which operates the
sensor (varies the circuit resistance). Fig. 11
Stand Alone Diagnosis :
Use Multimeter
With ignition “ON”.
Supply volt » 5.12 vdc
Signal volt » 0.5 vdc at Idle position
= 4.5 + 0.15 vdc at WOT position
Sensor end Pin Assignment Fig. 12 Throttle Position Sensor (Side view)
ECU 31 Supply VCC
ECU 23 Signal THS
31 23 30
ECU 30 Ground THSG
Measure signal voltage across pin 23 & 30 with
sensor connected to wiring hamess.
System Diagnosis : Electrical Circuit :
Use Hitachi Diagnostic tester
From Pressure/Map
Check for ‘Throttle sensor’ voltage by pressing the Sensor
15
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
ECU
16
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
LAMBDA SENSOR :
l Lambda oxygen sensor located in exhaust pipe Fig. 5 7 6 4
15. 8 ENGINE
800
600
400
200
0
0.8 0.9 1 1.1 1.2
Excess-air factor
Fig. 16 Lambda Sensor Voltage Curve
17
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Electrical Circuit :
18
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
AEP 125-1
Stepper motor type
6 Pin connector
Working Principle : Fig. 22 & 23
A linear flow pneumatic valve allows accurate flow control
by varying flow cross section area.This is done by a moving
spindle in both open/close directions operated by a
stepper motor.
System Integration :
ECU provides drive signal to the stepper motor of ISC
valve to allow more/less air depending upon engine
demand to maintain target speed of 750 rpm ( N =
50 rpm) in hot condition. Also, the input from various
other sensors helps ISC valve to maintain the target Fig. 20 Throttle Body showing Idle Speed control valve fitted
Idle Speed for various engine loads ISC Valve in inset
e.g. : A/C idle speed = 800 rpm
Engine water temp dependent Speed, say at 300C =
1100 rpm.
0.75
0.75
Fitment Data : P1 P2
LG/B 0.75
This actuator is part of Integral Throttle Body which is fitted FWH
2 ISC S/M ØA (ISCA)
on inlet manifold upstream side. Fig. 20
G/R 0.75
Stand Alone Diagnosis : FWH
3 ISC S/M ØA (ISCA)
19
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
20
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Fitment Data :
This valve is mounted on the engine block. In petrol vapour
circuit this valve connects canister purge line to intake
manifold, downstream side of integrated throttle body.
Fig. 25
Stand Alone Diagnosis :
Use Multimeter
Solenoid coil resistance = 26 W @ 200 C
Actuator end Pin assignment Fig. 26 Purge valve
P supply (+) main relay
P 11
ECU 11 CP
Measure the resistance across pin P & 11
System Diagnosis : Electrical Circuit :
Use Hitachi Diagnostic tester
CANISTER PURGE VALVE
Check for CPC solenoid ‘ON/OFF’ condition by freely 0.75 Y/L
11 CANISTER PURGE
accelerating the engine from idle to 4000 rpm. EWH EWH FWH (CP)
[ MAKE HITACHI ]
ECU
21
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Fig. 27
3.5
3.0
2.5
0.2
FLOW IN M3 / H
2.0
0.1
1.5
1.0
0.5
0.0
Fig. 28
22
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
(or ECU 102). With ignition ON, measure the supply voltage 2 CYL 0.75
Y/G
102 INJECTOR (IJ2)
FWH 2CYL, 3CYL
w.r.t. engine ground at the wiring harness end by removing 3 CYL
EWH
0.75
ECU
all injector connectors. INJECTOR 8.6_ X 4
[ MAKE HITACHI ]
(+ ve)
23
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
FUEL IN
FILTER
(1) TERMINAL
(Driving Signal)
from E.CU.)
(3) CORE
(2) COIL
(COPPER)
(5) YOKE
A
(6) SWIRLER
(7) BALL VALVE
(8) NOZZLE
ORIFICE
FUEL OUT
Fig. 31
24
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
DIAPHRAGM FUEL IN
VALVE
25
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
1 2 1 from relay
2 car body
Measure the coil resistance across Pin 1&2
Actuator end (Relay) Pin assignment
P Supply (+)
P 108 Fig. 36 Intank Fuel Pump
ECU 108 FP
System Diagnosis :
Use Hitachi Diagnostic tester
Check for Fuel pump relay ‘ON/OFF’ condition.
NOTE :
With ignition ON, Fuel pump is switched off after 1 sec. if
engine is not cranked.
26
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
27
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Electrical Circuit :
H.T. CABLE
0.75
H.T. CABLE
H.T. CABLE
AV 0.75
[ MAKE ANU/DELTRONIX ] 15 IGNITION1(IG1)
EWH
H.T. CABLE 1CYL, 4CYL
SPARK
PLUGS H.T. CABLE 0.75
BODY EARTH AV 0.75
ECU
IGNITION COIL
[ MAKE HITACHI ]
GND (ENGINE)
ENIGNE GND
28
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
91 W 91 W
1g. Key S. W.
CURRENT LIMIT CIRCUIT
Fig. 39
CYL. 4
CYL. 1
ENGINE FRONT
SIDE
CYL. 2
CYL. 3
Fig. 40
29
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
30
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Oxygen Sensor
D/N Switch
SPECIFICATIONS :
Type : Intelligent Driver ICs :
H8 536
1. Idle Speed control
Data Line :
2. Diagnostic line
16 Bit
Diagnosis level :
Clock Speed :
16 MHz 3 levels
Memory : a) Test switch (Actuators)
62k ROM b) Read Memory switch (Blink code)
2K RAM c) Diagnostic Monitor (HDM 2000)
A/D Convertor :
10 Bit (high accuracy)
FEATURES :
Grouped Ignition
Grouped Injection
31
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
32
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
EXPLANATION OF BUTTONS :
On this instrument, you can select each mode from the
menu display screen using the cursor.The following table ENGINE
shows the main functions of the keys.These key functions
vary depending on the selected mode.
Moves up the cursor, and scrolls up the display screen. Increments a numeric value.
Moves down the cursor, and scrolls down the display screen.
Decrements a numeric value.
Moves left the cursor, and scrolls left the display screen. Increments a numeric value.
Moves right the cursor, and scrolls right the display screen. Decrements a numeric value.
Use this key for item selection, deselection, execution, confirmation, etc.,
These keys for carrying out individual functions on each display screen.
Fig. 46
33
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
34
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
35
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
36
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
PRELIMINARY INSPECTION OF ENGINE : gradually with left foot. If the engine stalls, it means
Before proceeding to carry out actual overhauling of that clutch does not slip.
engine it is desirable to have a preliminary inspection OR ENGINE
of engine to ascertain whether an engine overhaul is
Drive the car with weight equal to GVW in 3rd gear
necessary and to what extent.
on level ground and let the speed drop down to
Most common reasons for which engine is overhauled approximately 15 kmph. Now press accelerator pedal
are : fully. With slipping clutch, the car speed will not pick
up and also clutch burning smell will be noticed. If
1. Loss of power
this does not occur and car picks up speed, it
2. Excessive engine oil consumption indicates that clutch does not slip.
3. Extremely low engine oil pressure e. BRAKE BINDING
4. Mechanical failures During driving apply brake number of times and then
shift the gear to neutral position Check brake drums
To know exact reason and general condition of engine,
for over-heating and if necessary jack up the car and
proceed as follows : check the wheels for free rotation.
1. LOSS OF POWER f. CHECKING ENGINE COMPRESSION PRESSURE
Loss of engine power may be due to : If loss of power is not on account of defective fuel
a. Defective Ignition system system, lack of air, choked exhaust silencer, clutch
slipping and brake binding. check engine
b. Defective Fuel system compression as follows :
c. Clogged air cleaner/choked catalytic converter 1. Warm up engine preferably by road drive to get
exhaust silencer a temperature of about 75 to 85 0C.
d. Clutch slippage 2. Remove all spark plugs.
e. Brake binding 3. Remove air cleaner filter element.
f. Loss of engine compression 4. Install Compression gauge (Range about 0 to 25
a. IGNITION SYSTEM kg/cm2) into one of the spark plug hole.
b. FUEL SYSTEM
Check condition of fuel filter. If found blocked
replace fuel filter.
c. CLOGGED AIR CLEANER/CHOKED EXHAUST
SILENCER
Check air filter element If found choked clean or
replace.
d. CLUTCH SLIPPAGE
Clutch slipping can be confirmed by any of the
following two methods :
Drive the car in 1st or 2nd gear at maximum
speed corresponding to that gear. With
accelerator pedal fully pressed, apply brake
Fig. 50
37
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
5. Disengage clutch (to reduce starting load on engine) 4. Take a clean vessel, place it below the drain plug of
and depress accelerator pedal all the way to make oil sump.
throttle valve open fully.
ENGINE 5. Drain the hot oil into the clean vessel. Drain it fully.
6. Crank engine with fully charged battery, and read
6. Screw in oil sump drain plug and tighten it.
the highest pressure on compression gauge.
7. Weigh the vessel along with oil let this weight be
7. Carry out steps 5 to 7 on each cylinder to obtain
‘w1’, gms.
compression pressures. The specified
compression pressure is 9.5 bar minimum. 8. Refill the weighed oil into the oil sump. Do not spill
any oil. The vessel used for draining should not be
8. Variation in compression pressure between cylinders
used for any other purposes.
should not be more than 0.5 bar.
9. Drive the vehicle approx. 200 - 300 km. This drive
9. Low compression pressure may be due to leakage
should include at least 30 - 40 kms. of highway
past valves / piston rings/blown cylinder head gasket.
or similar road, vehicle running at about 60 kmph.
To ascertain the point of leakage, spray small quantity
of clean engine oil in to the cylinder showing low Let this drive distance be ‘D’ kms.
pressure and re-check compression pressure. If it 10. Immediately after the test drive, place the vehicle
improves, wear in piston rings/cylinder bore is at the same spot from where it started.
indicated. If it does not, leakage past the valves is
indicated. If compression pressure of adjacent 11. Place the same previously used vessel below the
cylinder is also on lower side, it may be due to blown oil sump, unscrew the drain plug and drain off
cylinder head gasket. oil into the vessel. Drain the sump fully.
2. EXCESSIVE ENGINE OIL CONSUMPTION 12. Weigh the vessel along with oil, now for the
second time. Let this weight be ‘w2’ gms.
High engine oil consumption may also lead to overhauling
of the engine but before proceeding to overhauling, check 13. Find out standard oil consumption as -
following points : (w1 - w2)(wt. of oil consumed, gms) x 1000
Std. oil consumption
=
1. Make sure that there is absolutely no external oil ‘C’ (litres/1000km) sp. wt. of oil (gm/cm3) x ‘D’ (drive dist. in km.)
leak (i. e. from the camshaft oil seal, crankshaft oil
seal, oil sump gasket, oil pump gasket, cylinder head w1 - w2
‘C’ = litres/1000km
cover gasket etc.) 0.88 x D
2. If no external leakage is found, determine the exact 3. EXCESSIVE LOW OIL PRESSURE EXTREMELY
engine oil consumption, as per following procedure. Check the following :
DETERMINING EXACT ENGINE OIL CONSUMPTION : a. External leakages.
CAUTION : b. Oil level in sump upto maximum mark on
Do not make a rough estimate of engine oil consumption by dipstick.
noting the kilometers covered by the car at any random stage c. Oil pressure transducer for proper functioning.
and finding oil consumed from the topped up position
d. Functioning of pressure relief valve on oil pump.
taking into consideration dipstick level and oil sump
capacity. e. Oil pump performance using a suitable pressure
gauge.
PROCEDURE :
Oil pressure found to be less than 2.8 bar at maximum
1. Once it is doubted that engine oil consumption is speed and 1.2 bar at idling speed, may be due to
higher, place the car on a level ground. improper functioning of oil pump or defective oil
2. Top up oil sump to its capacity of 4 litres. pump relief valve.
3. Warm up the engine so that oil temperature is 75 - If low oil pressure is not on account of above factors,
800 C. wear of journals/bearings is indicated for which
overhaul of engine may be considered.
38
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
39
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE
40
SR. NO. PART DESCRIPTION
01 ASSY.ENGINE COVER
02 ASSY.RUBBER GROMMET (ENGINE COVER MTG)
03 CR CSK SCREW M6X16
INDEX
04 ASSY.ENGINE COVER MTG.BKT. (FRONT)
05 PAN HD SCR M6X8
06 ASSY.BUFFER (FOR ENG.COVER MTG.)
07 HEX FL NUT
08 ASSY.LIFTING HOOK REAR
09 HEX.FL.SCREW M8X18
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
GROUP INDEX
NEXT
2.5 ENGINE COVER MOUNTING
PREVIOUS
(same for 85 PS & 75 PS engines)
- Specified Torque in Kgm MOVING PARTS (For 85 PS engine)
# Allowed Tolerance of ±5%
INDEX
®
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
5.5 #
GROUP INDEX
SR. NO. PART DESCRIPTION
01 ASSY.CRANKSHAFT WITH PIN - NORMAL
01-a CRANKSHAFT-NORMAL 08 KEY
01-b CYL PIN 8m6X16 09 ASSY.FLYWHEEL COMPLETE. 13 ASSY.CONNECTING ROD
02 ASSY.GEAR (FOR CRANKSHAFT) (SINTERED) 09-a DOWEL 13-a BOLT (FOR CONNECTING ROD)
(FOR CLUTCH ON FLYWHEEL)
03 PULLEY CRANKSHAFT-ALT.DRIVE (4-GROOVES)
NEXT
13-b NUT (FOR CONNECTING ROD)
10 HEX.BOLT (FOR FLYWHEEL)
04 PULLEY (4 GROOVE)(ON CRANKSHAFT FOR AC) 13-c SET BRG.HALF NORMAL (CON.ROD) (BIMETAL)
11 SET MAIN BEARING SHELLS NORMAL
05 HEX FL BOLT M8X38 14 PISTON SET WITH RINGS GRADE A (IP)
(BIMETAL)
PREVIOUS
06 HEX.BOLT (FOR CRANKSHAFT GEAR) 14-a PISTON SET WITHOUT RINGS GRADE A (IP)
12 SET THRUST WASHERS (BIMETAL)
07 WASHER (FOR CRANKSHAFT GEAR) 14-b SET PISTON RINGS ABC STD (IP)
41
ENGINE
ENGINE
42
- Specified Torque in Kgm MOVING PARTS (For 75 PS engine)
# Allowed Tolerance of ±5%
INDEX
®
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
5.5 #
GROUP INDEX
SR. NO. PART DESCRIPTION
01 ASSY.CRANKSHAFT WITH PIN - NORMAL
01-a CRANKSHAFT-NORMAL 08 KEY
01-b CYL PIN 8m6X16 09 ASSY.FLYWHEEL COMPLETE. 13 ASSY.CONNECTING ROD
02 ASSY.GEAR (FOR CRANKSHAFT) (SINTERED) 09-a DOWEL 13-a BOLT (FOR CONNECTING ROD)
(FOR CLUTCH ON FLYWHEEL)
03 PULLEY CRANKSHAFT-ALT.DRIVE (4-GROOVES)
NEXT
13-b NUT (FOR CONNECTING ROD)
10 HEX.BOLT (FOR FLYWHEEL)
04 PULLEY (4 GROOVE)(ON CRANKSHAFT FOR AC) 13-c SET BRG.HALF NORMAL (CON.ROD) (BIMETAL)
11 SET MAIN BEARING SHELLS NORMAL
05 HEX FL BOLT M8X38 14 PISTON SET WITH RINGS GRADE A (IP)
(BIMETAL)
PREVIOUS
06 HEX.BOLT (FOR CRANKSHAFT GEAR) 14-a PISTON SET WITHOUT RINGS GRADE A (IP)
12 SET THRUST WASHERS (BIMETAL)
07 WASHER (FOR CRANKSHAFT GEAR) 14-b SET PISTON RINGS ABC STD (IP)
ENGINE TIMING (same for 85 PS & 75 PS * engines)
* View is same for 85 PS & PS engines, but for 75 PS engine camshaft is different
INDEX
1 TIMING BELT
2 OIL SEAL (CAMSHAFT-FRONT)
3 TIMING GEAR (CAMSHAFT)
4 WASHER (FOR CAMSHAFT GEAR)
5 HEX BOLT (CAMSHAFT GEAR MTG.)
6 ASSY.TENSIONER (TIMING BELT)
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
13 ROCKER ARM
14 ADJUSTING SCREW (FOR ROCKER ARM)
GROUP INDEX
15 ROCKER NUT
16 .ASSY.ROCKER SHAFT WITH SEALING CAP ®
17 SPRING (ROCKER ARM SHAFT)
18 ROCKER SPRING SEAT
19 SCREW-ROCKER SHAFT HOLDER.
20 CAM THRUST PLATE (FRONT)
21 CAP SCREW M6X20
4.5
NEXT
PREVIOUS
® -Non Reusable Part
- Specified Torque in Kgm
43
ENGINE
ENGINE
44
FUEL INJECTION EQUIPMENT (same for 85 PS & 75 PS engines)
INDEX
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
GROUP INDEX
05 SUPPORT BRACKET - CANISTER PURGE VALVE
06 HEX FL SCREW M8X16
07 CANISTER PURGE VALVE
08 RUBBER SLEEVE (CANISTER PURGE VALVE)
09 CLAMP - CANISTER PURGE VALVE
10 HEX FL SCREW M6X10
11 RUBBER HOSE-CARBON CANISTER TO CPV (380)
12 RUBBER HOSE-CPV TO INTAKE MANIFOLD (240)
13 SPRING CLAMP (14)
NEXT
14 SPRING CLIP (10)
15 ASSY.ACT.CARBON CANISTER (KOEL)
16 ASSY.BRACKET (FOR CARBON CANISTER MTG.)
PREVIOUS
17 HEX FL SCREW M6X16 - Specified Torque in Kgm
CYLINDER BLOCK ASSY. (same for 85 PS & 75 PS engines)
- Specified Torque in Kgm
# Allowed Tolerance of ±5% 1.0 #
® 3.5
® -Non Reusable Part
®
INDEX
5.5 # ®
1.0
®
2.0
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
1.0 #
1.0 ®
®
1.0
0.6 to 0.7#
GROUP INDEX
1.0 ®
3.5
®
NEXT
01-h DOWEL 6h6x10 (1-no screw behind) 12 HEX FL SCR M10X14 (for timing cover)
01-i HOLLOW DOWEL 8h6X6.5X8L (6) 13 ASSY.FRONT COVER(LOWER)(TIMING COVER) 28 ASSY.STRAINER (FOR OIL PUMP)
02 .ASSY.REAR COVER CRANKCASE WITH OIL SEAL 14 HEX FL SCREW M6X14 29 GASKET (FOR OIL PUMP STRAINER)
02-a REAR COVER - CRANKCASE (HOLLOW DOWEL) 15 COVER (TIMING BELT-FRONT) 30 STUD CM6X16
31 HEX FL NUT BM6
PREVIOUS
02-b 0IL SEAL-CRANKSHAFT (REAR) 16 SEALING STRAP
03 GASKET (REAR COVER CRANKCASE) 17 SHOULDER BOLT (FOR TIMING COVER) 32 ADAPTOR (OIL FILTER)
04 ASSY HEX SCREW M6X20 (6-for rear cover) 18 BRIGHT WASHER 10.5 33 ASSY.OIL FILTER
05 ASSY.DIPSTICK TUBE 19 RUBBER BUSH (TIMING COVER)
45
ENGINE
ENGINE
46
CYLINDER HEAD & COVER (same for 85 PS & 75 PS engines)
INDEX
01-b INTAKE VALVE 1.0
01-c EXHAUST VALVE
01-d SPRING SEAT
01-e VALVE SPRING
01-f VALVE SPRING RETAINER
01-g LOCK HALF
01-h SPARK PLUG ASSEMBLY.(M/S CHAMPION)
01-i ASSY.CYLINDER HEAD (WITHOUT VALVES)
01-i-a CYLINDER HEAD
01-I-B STUD CM8X25 (FOR INTAKE MANIFOLD)
01-I-C STUD CM8X20 (FOR PURGE VALVE MTG. BRACKET.)
01-I-D STUD CM8X25 (FOR EXHAUST MANIFOLD)
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
10 RUBBER HOSE-BLOW
BY-HD.COVER TO MANIFOLD
11 HOSE CLAMP 25 1.0
12 HOSE CLAMP 20 1-i-d 09
13 GASKET (FOR CYL.HEAD COVER) 1.0 07
14 STUD (FOR CYL.HD.COVER)
GROUP INDEX
15 SPACER TUBE 11
(FOR CYL.HD.COVER)
16 ASSY.RUBBER BUSH
(FOR CYL.HD.COVER)
17 DOMED CAP NUT
(FOR CYL.HEAD COVER MTG.) 10
®
18 SEALING WASHER
(FOR CYL.HEAD COVER)
19 OIL FILLER CAP
20 GASKET 12
21 VALVE GUIDE 21
22 VALVE INSERT
NEXT
®
®
22
-Non Reusable Part
PREVIOUS
®
- Specified Torque in Kgm
GASKET KIT (same for 85 PS & 75 PS engines)
INDEX
®
®
®
®
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
®
®
®
®
SR. PART DESCRIPTION
NO.
1 Rear Gasket
®
®
®
GROUP INDEX
4 Cylinder Head Cover Gasket
5 Oil Filler Cap Gasket
6 Throttle Body Gasket
®
®
10 Oil Pump Strainer Gasket
11 Water Pump Gasket
12 Gasket
NEXT
13 Gasket Elbow
14 Rear Crankshaft Oil Seal
(Rear Crankcase Cover)
PREVIOUS
15 Camshaft Front Oil Seal
® -Non Reusable Part
16 Front Crankshaft Oil Seal
47
ENGINE
ENGINE
48
AIR INTAKE SYSTEM (same for 85 PS & 75 PS engines)
INDEX
®
®
SR. PART DESCRIPTION ®
NO.
01 ASSY AIR FILTER MPFI
02 ASSY.FILTER ELEMENT
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
GROUP INDEX
16 RUBBER GROMMET (FOR RESONATOR BOX)
17 HEX FL BOLT M8X25
18 AIR INTAKE SNORKEL
19 ASSY.CLAMP (FOR SNORKEL MTG.)
20 HEX FL SCREW M6X14 (FOR SNORKEL MOUNTING)
21 HOSE (RESONATOR BOX)
22 HOSE CLAMP (42 DIA.)
23 INTAKE DUCT (FROM AIR INTAKE SYSTEM)
24 HOSE (AIR FILTER TO INTAKE DUCT)
25 HOSE CLAMP (72 DIA.)
26 HEX FL NUT AM6 8C (FOR SNORKEL MOUNTING)
27 PLUG (ON THROTTLE BODY)
NEXT
28 GASKET (FOR INTEGRATE THROTTLE BODY)
29 HEX FL NUT AM6 8C
30 RUBBER BELLOW (AIR FILTER TO THRO.BODY)
PREVIOUS
31 HOSE CLAMP ( 53 DIA.)
32 HOSE CLAMP (72 DIA.) ® -Non Reusable Part
INTAKE & EXHAUST MANIFOLDS (same for 85 PS & 75 PS engines)
INDEX
06
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
1234
1234
1234
1234
1234
®
SR. PART DESCRIPTION
NO.
GROUP INDEX
01 ASSY.INTAKE MANIFOLD COMPT (FOR LTRS)
®
02 BRACKET (FOR ACC.CABLE MTG) (LTRS)
03 CYL PIN 4m6X8 IS2393
04 HEX FL SCREW M6X12
05 ASSY.CABLE LEVER COMPLETE (FOR LTRS) 2.0
06 STICKER (FOR SPARK PLUG CONNECTION)
®
NEXT
10 EXHAUST MANIFOLD
11 GASKET EXHAUST MANIFOLD
12 .ASSY.HEAT SHIELD (FOR EXHAUST MANIFOLD)
PREVIOUS
® -Non Reusable Part
13 HEX FL SCREW M6X10
- Specified Torque in Kgm
14 STUD CM8X32
49
ENGINE
ENGINE
50
® -Non Reusable Part ENGINE ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT (75 PS)
- Specified Torque in Kgm
2.0
INDEX
2.0
3.0
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
1.5
®
4.0
2.5
GROUP INDEX
2.0
8.0
NEXT
04 HEX FL NUT AM8 08-a-b-c CYL PIN 8m6X25 IS2393 23 HEX FL SCREW M8X18
05 HEX FL BOLT M8X125 08-b ASSY.BRACKET (ALTERNATOR - UPPER) 24 PULLEY (POWER STG.PUMP) 4 GROOVES
06 BRIGHT WASHER 8.4 08-c HEX FL BOLT M10X40 25 HEX FL.NUT AM12X1.25
PREVIOUS
07 NYLOC NUT M8 9 HEX FL SCREW M8X18
08 ASSY.CLAMP ROD COMP.WITH BRACKET (172mm) 10 HEX FL BOLT M8X45
ENGINE ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT (85 PS)
SR. PART DESCRIPTION
NO.
01 BRACKET (ALTERNATOR,IDLER & PSTG.MTG.)
02 HEX FL SCREW M8X18
INDEX
03 HEX FL BOLT M8X25
04 SUPPORT BKT.(FOR ALT.BKT.& TOP SUPPORT)
05 HEX FL SCREW M8X18
06 BRACKET (FOR ALT.TOP SUPPORT) 2.0
07 HEX FL BOLT M8X25
08 SLIDER (FOR TENSIONER MTG.) (ALUMINIUM)
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
GROUP INDEX
16 PULLEY-PSTG.PUMP (5-GROOVES)
2.3
4.0
2.3
NEXT
PREVIOUS
- Specified Torque in Kgm
51
ENGINE
ENGINE
52
ENGINE ELECTRICAL/A.C. EQUIPMENT
(same for 85 PS & 75 PS engines)
INDEX
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
2.4
GROUP INDEX
16 SET ASSY.COMPRESSOR MTG.(HALLA-110CC)DLX
5.0 16-a BRACKET(MTG.A/C COMPRESSOR)(HALLA-110CC)
2.5 16-b ASSY.AIR COMPRESSOR (with sealed connector)
®
2.5 16-c HEX FL SCREW M8X30
17 STUD (FOR A.C. & ALT. BRACKET)
18 HEX FL NUT AM8
19 HEX FL SCREW M8X18
20 POLY-V BELT (4-GROOVES-730)
21 SET ASSY.IDLER (AUTOLEC)
21-a ASSY.IDLER (FOR A/C COMP.) (AUTOLEC)
NEXT
21-b DUST CAP
PREVIOUS
®
21-d SCREW (FOR A/C COMP TENSIONER)
- Specified Torque in Kgm 21-e NYLOC NUT M8
EMS KIT COMPONENTS
- Specified Torque in Kgm 1.0
(same for 85 PS & 75 PS engines)
INDEX
12
11
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
1.0
08 09
10
GROUP INDEX
1.4
NOTE : Vehicles speed sensor, one of EMS component, is a part of instrument cluster. (not shown)
SR. PART DESCRIPTION
NO. 04 BRACKET (FOR CRANK ANGLE SENSOR)
01 KIT-EMS BHARAT STAGE-II FE (HITACHI) 05 CR CSK SCREW M6X16
01-a ASSY.COIL WITH IGNITOR (HITACHI) 01-e-bINSULATOR (FOR FUEL INJECTOR) 06 CYL PIN 6m6X14
NEXT
01-b ENGINE CONTROL UNIT (BS-II) FE (HITACHI) 01-e-c RUBBER RING (FOR FUEL INJECTOR) 07 HEX FL BOLT M6X20
01-b ENGINE CONTROL UNIT (BS-II) FE (HITACHI) 01-f INTEG.THROTTLE BODY(HITACHI) NEW PR.SEN. 08 MANIFOLD AIR PRESSURE SENSOR
01-c CRANK ANGLE SENSOR (HITACHI) 01-g ASSY.PRESSURE REGULATOR (HITACHI). 09 THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
PREVIOUS
01-d WATER/AIR TEMP.SENSOR (HITACHI) 01-g-a O-RING (FOR PR.REGULATOR) 10 ISC VALVE
01-e ASSY.FUEL INJECTOR (HITACHI) 02 HEX FL SCREW M5X12 11 WATER TEMPERATURE SENSOR
01-e-a O-RING (FOR FUEL INJECTOR) 03 ASSY HEX SCREW M6X25 (Ignition coil) 12 LAMBDA SENSOR
53
ENGINE
ENGINE
54
® -Non Reusable Part
ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM (same for 85 PS & 75 PS engines)
- Specified Torque in Kgm
NOTE : Please read this view in conjunction with view of Radiator (next page), as both are related.
®
1.0
INDEX
1.0
®
®
2.0 TO AUX. TANK
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
1.5
®
®
48 ®
®
1.5
GROUP INDEX
2.0
1.0
NEXT
14 SPRING BAND CLAMP FORM A 12X23D TS17665 43 ASSY.COVER (THERMOSTAT) 53 HEX FL NUT BM6
15 ASSY.TUBE(CYL.HEAD VENT) 44 ASSY.THERMOSTAT (82 DEG.SOT ) 54 ASSY.HOSE (WATER BYPASS) (SPR.BAND)
16 SPRING BAND CLAMP FORM A 12X14D TS17665 45 SEAL THERMOSTAT 55 HOSE CLAMP 35
PREVIOUS
36 ASSY.WATER PUMP (OFFER DRG.) 46 HEX FL NUT AM6 56 ASSY.ELBOW (FOR WATER INLET
37 GASKET (FOR WATER PUMP) 47 SEALING WASHER 12X15.5 57 GASKET (FOR WATER INLET ELBOW)
38 ASSY HEX SCREW M6X20 48 TEMPERATURE TRANSDUCER-M/S PRICOL 58 HEX FL SCREW M8X18
RADIATOR (same for 85 PS & 75 PS engines)
NOTE : Please read this view in conjunction with view of Engine Cooling System (previous page), as both are related.
FROM HEATER 06
TO WATER ELBOW
08
*
INDEX
07 1.0 17
Fitted on Body 08 18
19
1.0 1.5
Fitted on Body
09
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
CK
TO BLO
*
To Heater
1.5
T
TA
OS
M
ER
GROUP INDEX
TH
TO
1.5
NEXT
08 ASSY.CLAMP (FOR INT.HOSE AUX.TANK BR.) 23 RUBBER HOSE-COVER THERMOSTAT TO RADIATOR 32 RUBBER GROMET (RAD MOUNT)
09 HEX FL SCREW M6X10 24 SPRING BAND CLAMP FORM A 15X49D 33 ASSY.BKT.RAD.MTG.TOP RH COMPL
14 SPRING BAND CLAMP FORM A 12X23D 25 ASSY.AUX.WATER TANK W/H PR.CAP 34 ASSY.BKT.RAD.MTG.TOP LH COMPL
PREVIOUS
15 ASSY.TUBE(CYL.HEAD VENT) 26 ASSY.BRACKET-REAR (FOR AUXILLIARY TANK) 35 HEX FL SCREW M6X12
16 SPRING BAND CLAMP FORM A 12X14D 27 HEX FL SCREW M6X12 59 SCREW FOR TOP MOUNTING BRACKET (AUX. TANK)
17 HEX FL SCREW M6X10 28 ASSY HEX SCREW M6X16
55
ENGINE
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
2.5
2.5
c
b
®
a 4.5
2.5
2.5
3.5
2.0
a
® b
3.0
SR. PART DESCRIPTION
NO.
01 LIFTING HOOK (FRONT)
02 HEX FL SCREW M8X18
03 ASSY.BRACKET ENG MTG. WITH STUDS 8.0
03-a BRACKET (FOR ENG.MTG.ARM)
03-b STUD BM10X50
03-c STUD BM10X60
SR. PART DESCRIPTION
04 HEX FL BOLT M10X40
NO.
05 HEX FL BOLT M10X70
06 ENGINE MTG.ARM (FRONT) 19 ASSY.BRACKET ENGINE STOPPER (FABRICATED)
07 HEX FL NUT AM10 20 HEX FL SCR M12X30
08 ASSY.ENGINE MOUNT-A(HYDRAULIC) 21 HEX FL BOLT M8X38
09 NYLOC NUT M10 22 ASSY.RUBBER STOPPER
10 BRIGHT WASHER 10.5 23 HEX NUT M12
11 ASSY.MOUNTING PLATE (B-MOUNT) 24 ASSY.C LINK & BODY MTG BKT COMPLETE
12 ASSY.STOPER(ON B-MOUNT PLATE) 24-a ASSY.MOUNT INTERMEMEDIATE LINK (REAR)
13 HEX FL BOLT M8X25 24-b ASSY.BODY MTG.BRACKET (FOR C-MOUNT)
14 ASSY.ENG.MOUNT-B (ON GEAR BOX) 25 HEX FL BOLT M10X55
15 NYLOC NUT M12X1.5 26 NYLOC NUT M10
16 WASHER (FOR B-MOUNT) 27 ASSY HEX SCR M12X1.25X30
17 .HEX FL NUT BM8 28 HEX FL BOLT M10X75
18 ASSY.ENGINE MOUNT-C (TC) 29 HEX FL NUT AM10
56
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
2.5
2.5 c
b
®
a
4.5
2.5
2.5
3.5
2.0
a
® b
3.0
SR. PART DESCRIPTION
NO.
01 LIFTING HOOK (FRONT)
02 HEX FL SCREW M8X18
03 ASSY.BRACKET ENG MTG. WITH STUDS 8.0
03-a BRACKET (FOR ENG.MTG.ARM)
03-b STUD BM10X50
03-c STUD BM10X60
SR. PART DESCRIPTION
04 HEX FL BOLT M10X40
NO.
05 HEX FL BOLT M10X70
06 ENGINE MTG.ARM (FRONT) 19 ASSY.BRACKET ENGINE STOPPER (FABRICATED)
07 HEX FL NUT AM10 20 HEX FL SCR M12X30
08 ASSY.ENGINE MOUNT-A(HYDRAULIC) 21 HEX FL BOLT M8X38
09 NYLOC NUT M10 22 ASSY.RUBBER STOPPER
10 BRIGHT WASHER 10.5 23 HEX NUT M12
11 ASSY.MOUNTING PLATE (B-MOUNT) 24 ASSY.C LINK & BODY MTG BKT COMPLETE
12 ASSY.STOPER(ON B-MOUNT PLATE) 24-a ASSY.MOUNT INTERMEMEDIATE LINK (REAR)
13 HEX FL BOLT M8X25 24-b ASSY.BODY MTG.BRACKET (FOR C-MOUNT)
14 ASSY.ENG.MOUNT-B (ON GEAR BOX) 25 HEX FL BOLT M10X55
15 NYLOC NUT M12X1.5 26 NYLOC NUT M10
16 WASHER (FOR B-MOUNT) 27 ASSY HEX SCR M12X1.25X30
17 .HEX FL NUT BM8 28 HEX FL BOLT M10X75
18 ASSY.ENGINE MOUNT-C (TC) 29 HEX FL NUT AM10
57
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Fig. 52
Fig. 53
58
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Fig. 56
59
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
60
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
61
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
FITMENT
SPAN
1. Install the belt over crankshaft and A. C. compressor
ENGINE pulleys.
2. Press the tensioner against the belt and tight the
tension bolt to specified torque.
3. Check belt tension.
BELT
4. The belt tension to be adjusted such that on the TENSIONER
ROLLER
span shown in Fig. 12, 200 +10/-5 Hz is measured by
CLAVIS gauge.
Alternately belt can be depressed by 11 to 13 mm
with thumb pressure applied. BELT TENSION
ADJUSTING SCREW
Fig. 61
62
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
engine.
l Remove alternator belt.
Inspection :
Engine with Alternator (without power steering)
l Inspect alternator belt for wear, cracks and signs of
failure. Replace, if necessary. 1. Alternator mounting bottom bolt
Fitment : 2. Alternator mounting upper bolt
l Install alternator belt over crank shaft, power steering 3. Clamping piece
pully and alternator pulleys (Fig. 61b). 4. Clamping bolt
Note : incase of vehicle without power steering, power 5. Adjusting nut
steering pulley will not be there Fig-61a). 6. Lock nut
l Pull alternator away from engine for specified tension
& tighten the nut to specified torque. Fig. 61a
l ALTERNATOR BELT TENSION IS CORRECT IF IT CAN BE
DEPRESSED BY 10-11 mm (for engine with alternator)
& 8-9 mm (for engine with A.C., Alternator and Power
steering) WITH THUMB PRESSURE (1O KG APPROX.)
APPLIED IN THE MIDDLE OF ITS LENGTH Fig. 61a & 61b.
l Tighten alternator top mounting screw and bottom
mounting bolt.
l Tighten banjo bolt connections on vacuum pump
A.C. COMPRESSOR BELT
REMOVAL
1. Loosen belt tensioner bolt. (Fig. 61b) on idler /
tensioner.
2. Release tension load on the belt and remove the belt
from the pulleys.
Alternator
INSPECTION Crankshaft Pulley
1. Inspect the A. C. compressor belt for wear cracks, and
signs of failures. Replace if necessary.
2. Inspect pulley grooves.
8-9 mm
FITMENT
1. Install the belt over crankshaft and A. C. compressor
pulleys.
2. Press the tensioner againsts the belt and tight the Compressor
tension bolt to specified torque. Tensioner Tensioner
8-9
3. Check belt tension. Bolt mm
Power Steering
4. A. C. Compressor belt tension is correcrt if it can be Pump
depressed by 8-9 mm with thumb pressure applied in
the middle of its length between compressor and Fig. 61b
crankshaft pulleys.
63
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
TIMING BELT :
Removal :
ENGINE
Remove alternator and AC belt
Unscrew the mounting screws & remove front timing gear
train cover Fig. 62.
Keep crank shaft rotating with socket spanner
simultaneously pressing camshaft timing pin till it locks
camshaft Fig. 63.
Fig. 62
Fig. 63
Fig. 64
64
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Ensure that timing pin is in flywheel locked position. Slacken the camshaft gear fixing bolt so that the camshaft
Check that the cam gear is “Just” freely rotating on the gear is “Just” freely rotating on camshaft. Fit the camshaft
camshaft with mounting bolt in hand loose gear washer lock plate as shown in Fig. 65
condition. Check now that both the flywheel and camshaft are in
locked in timing position.
Slacken all valve tappet clearance setting screws to
such an extent that the screw bottom radius is just Fit timing belt on Crank shaft gear, water pump, tensioner
riding on the valve tips & tighten the locknuts. roller and camshaft gear.
NOTE : Adjust the timing belt tension, by rotating tensioner roller
clockwise and tighten the mounting screw, while
This is to reduce the valve spring load on Camshaft, while tightening the mounting screw ensuring that the
rotating the camshaft. tensioner roller does not rotate further in clockwise
Using appropriate spanner on camshaft gear fixing bolt, direction. This will prevent overtensioning of timing
rotate camshaft in clockwise direction with timing pin belt.
placed on the cylinder head reference hole, until the Tighten the cam shaft gear fixing bolt to a lower tightening
camshaft is locked in timing position. (Fig. 116) torque of 1 mkg.
65
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
LOCK NUT
(VALVE TAPPET CL. SCREW)
ROCKER ARM Cylinder Head Ex-
ROCKER SCREW
SPRING RETAINER
ploded
LOCK
HALF
SPRING
VALVE
GUIDE
ROCKER
SHAFT
CYLINDER HEAD
CAM SHAFT
TIMING
GEAR
EXHAUST VALVE
INTAKE VALVE
Fig. 68
66
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Fig. 69
Remove
l Fuel pressure regulator
l Canister purge valve
l Bracket supporting fuel lines. Fig. 70
Fig. 70
Fig. 71
67
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
ENGINE
Fig. 72
Fig. 73
Fig. 74
68
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Fig. 75
Fig. 76
Fig. 77
69
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Also remove
l Timing belt Fig. 78
l Dip stick clamping screw
ENGINE
Fig. 78
Fig. 79
Fig. 80
70
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
NOTE :
1) To ease the dismantling of rocker shaft relieve
the valve spring load by slackening the tappet ENGINE
setting screws. In this condition do not attempt
to rotate the cam shaft, if you do so valve tips
will be damaged. (Fig. 81)
2) While pulling out Rocker arm shafts, take out
the rocker arm with springs & spring seats
carefully one by one. (Fig. 82)
Fig. 81
Fig. 82
Fig. 83
71
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
ENGINE Remove the fuel rail mtg. bolt on inlet manifold Fig. 84
Fig. 84
Fig. 85
Fig. 86
72
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
ENGINE
Fig. 87
Fig. 88
SPARK PLUG
l Remove Spark plugs Fig. 89
Spark Plug - Champion
Spark Plug no. - C9YC
Spark Plug Gap - 0.7 mm to 0.8 mm
73
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
ENGINE 3. Remove the spark plug with the help of box spanner
2702 5890 06 01 (Fig. 89)
4. Check and adjust the gap, it should be 0.7 mm to 0.8
mm. Fig. 90
5. Replace the spark plug if the gap is more than 0.8
mm.
6. Fix the spark plug and tighten it to the specified
torque (dry.)
7. Fit the spark plug cable.
Repeat the procedure for the other spark plugs.
Tighten the spark plug carefully. Overtightening can Fig. 90
damage the threads in the cylinder head. A loose spark
plug can affect combustion and cause engine damage.
Fig. 93
74
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Fig. 95
Fig. 96
75
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
ENGINE
Fig. 97
Fig. 98
Mating Surface :
Using a straight edge and feeler gauge, check cylinder
head mating surface with crank case, Fig. 99 & 100.
If unevenness exceeds, replace cylinder head.
Fig. 99
76
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Fig. 100
ROCKER SHAFT
ROCKER SCREW
ROCKER ARM
LOCK HALF
SPRING
VALVE GUIDE
INTAKE PORT
CYLINDER HEAD
77
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Check valve seat run out with respect to valve stem. Fig.
102. If it exceeds specified limit (0.030 mm both inlet &
exhaust) replace valve. No attempt should be made to
ENGINE
straighten bent valves. If valve is free from any other
defects except worn out seat, then only it can be
rematched on valve grinding machine as follows.
l Clamp valve on grinding machine jaws as close as
possible to valve head.
l Adjust grinding angle on graduated scale to achieve
correct valve seat angle.
l Feed valve slowly towards grinding wheel until wheel
just touches valve head.
l Grind at low feed until valve seat is just clean all
around.
NOTE : After grinding, valve head thickness should not Fig. 102
be less than 0.85 mm.
B
B
VALVE SEAT
C C C C
D
D A
0
A
45
VALVE SEAT ANGLE VALVE HEAD
Fig. 103
VALVE GUIDES :
In case of valve stem sticking in valve guide before or
excessive clearance between them, remove valve guide
from cylinder head using drift (2702 5890 0611) Fig. 104
Fig. 104
78
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Valve seat end distance from valve face D mm 2.65+0.1 2.82+0.1
Fig. 105
79
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Fig. 106
VALVE SEAT MUST BE ABSOLUTELY FAULTLESS AND suitable puller. In order to avoid damaging machined
WITHOUT ANY CHATTER MARKS cylinder head mating surface with crank case, place any
If necessary lap valve seats to a smooth and even finish by soft protective sheet metal under supports of puller.
using suitable hand pump grinder or a lapping paste and Measure valve seat insert bore in cylinder head & then
valve itself. select suitable insert after referring table on next page.
Smear valve seat with carbon blue. Install valve in guide
and turn it slowly under axial pressure.
CONTACT LINE ON VALVE SEAT MUST BE AROUND ENTIRE
CIRCUMFERENCE AT EQUAL WIDTH
Distance between narrow diameter of valve face to
contact line should be minimum 0.5 mm
Check for leakages through valve seat by pouring
gasoline on valve head. Gasoline must not seep past
valve seat.
VALVE SEAT INSERTS :
For removing valve seat inserts from cylinder head use
a suitable boring machine. Bore old insert thin (about
0.5 mm thickness) and then pry it out.
Alternatively use a suitable turning tool to cut an annular
groove into valve seat insert and then pull it out with a
Fig. 107
80
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
INLET
- Normal 38/38.03 38.13/38.155
- Normal 1 38.23/38.28 38.43/38.455
EXHAUST
- Normal 32.99/33.021 33.13/33.155
- Normal 1 33.29/33.321 33.43/33.455
Fig. 109
Fig. 110
82
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
PISTON GASKET
PROJECTION THICKNESS, Fig. 112
mm mm
Fig. 113
83
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
9 5 1 4 8
1 2 3 4
10 6 2 3 7
Fig. 114
centre to outwards.Then retighten screws to 5 mkg torque
in the same sequence - Then loosen each screw by quarter
turn and retighten to 7.5mkg. torque Fig. 115.
Valve clearance adjustment.
VALVE CLEARANCES SHOULD BE CHECKED ONLY WHEN
ENGINE IS COLD.
l Fit camshaft gear
Fitment :
Ensure that timing pin is in flywheel locked position.
Check that the cam gear is “Just” freely rotating on the
camshaft with mounting bolt in hand loose condition.
Slacken all valve tappet clearance setting screws to such
an extent that the screw bottom radius is just riding on
the valve tips & tighten the locknuts. (Refer fig. 68) Fig. 115
NOTE :
This is to reduce the valve spring load on camshaft, while
rotating the camshaft.
Using an appropriate spanner on camshaft fixing bolt,
rotate in camshaft in clock direction with timing pin placed
on the cylinder head reference hole, until the camshaft is
locked in timing position. Fig. 116
Slacken the fixing bolt so that the camgear is “Just” freely
rotating on camshaft. Fit the camshaft gear washer locking
plate. (Fig. 65)
Check now that both the flywheel and camshaft are in
locked timing position.
Fig. 116
84
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Fig. 117
Fig. 118
Fig. 119
85
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
INLET EXHAUST
Fig. 121
Fig. 122
86
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Fig. 124
CYLINDER BLOCK
(Cylinder head assembly removed)
Disassembly
Uniformly and evenly unscrew clutch pressure plate
mounting screws and remove clutch pressure plate and
clutch disc Fig. 125.
Fig. 125
87
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Remove :
l Vibration damper Fig. 126.
ENGINE
Fig. 126
Fig. 127
Fig. 128
88
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
ENGINE
Fig. 129
89
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Fig. 132
Fig. 133
Fig. 134
90
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Fig. 135a
Fig. 137
91
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
PISTON RINGS :
Type of ring Axial clearance Butt clearance
in piston groove in cylinder bore
1st Compression 0.03 / 0.07 mm 0.15 / 0.3 mm
ring Fig. 138
2nd Compression 0.02 / 0.06 mm 0.2 / 0.35 mm
ring
3rd Oil control - 0.2 / 0.6 mm
ring
92
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
93
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
94
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
NOTE :
Ensure that the identification numbers for connecting rod
& connecting rod bearing cap are matched & notches for ENGINE
bearing shells are on same side.
Check twist and bend of connecting rod by using new
piston pin in connecting rod small end bush.
Measure twist and bend of connecting rod with feeler
gauge with respect to vertical face of connecting rod
alignment gauge in vertical and horizontal plane at a
distance of 50 mm from the line joining centres of
connecting rod small end and big end bosses.
Fig. 144 & 145
If necessary, straighten the connecting rod in cold
condition. Since a slight clearance exists between Fig. 144
connecting rod bolts and corresponding connecting
rod bearing cap holes, it is possible that connecting
rod bearing cap once removed may be installed off
centre, by which dimension of connecting rod big end
parent bore will be different in different directions.
If difference is noticed in connecting rod big end
parent bore dimension, connecting rod bearing cap
can be centralised by lightly tapping it with mallet in
required direction after slightly loosening connecting
rod bearing cap mounting nuts.
Check connecting rod big end parent bore dimension.
Fig. 146
If connecting rod big end parent bore is slightly more
than maximum permissible limits, it is possible to
reclaim connecting rod provided the wear is confined
only to connecting rod bearing cap.
Fig. 145
Connecting rod bearing cap mating surface may be
slightly faced. Parent bore should then be finished on
a connecting rod boring machine.
ENSURE THAT CONNECTING ROD BIG END AND SMALL
END AXES ARE PARALLEL TO EACH OTHER WITHIN
SPECIFIED LIMITS. CENTRE TO CENTRE DISTANCE
BETWEEN CONNECTING ROD SMALL END AND BIG END
IS MAINTAINED WITHIN SPECIFIED LIMITS.
If one or more connecting rods are to be replaced, ensure
that difference in weight of connecting rod in an engine
is within permissible limits.
Install new pair of connecting rod bearing shell according
to size of crank pin journal diameter, making sure that
securing lugs of bearing shells are properly seated in
grooves of connecting rod and its bearing cap.
Fig. 146
95
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Fig. 147
Fig. 148
96
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Stage Crank case main bearing bore Crank shaft main bearing journal
diameter with bearing shell mm diameter mm ENGINE
End play of crank shaft 0.06 - 0.226 mm Pre-tension of main bearing shells 0.018-0.040 mm
Fillet radius of main bearing journals 2.5-0.5 mm Hardness of crank shaft main 50-60 HRC
bearing and crank pin journals
Fillet radius of crank pin journals 2.5-0.5 mm
Main bearing parent bore dia in 53.8 +0.019 mm
Width of 1st, 2nd, 3rd and 5th 24.0+0.2 mm
crank case + 0.00 mm
main bearing journals
Maximum permissible taper of 0.005 mm
Width of crank pin journals 24.0+0.2 mm
main bearing parent bore
Maximum permissible cylindricity 0.0025 mm
Maximum permissible ovality of 0.005 mm
Ovality of main brg. journal 0.005 mm main bearing parent bore.
Max. permissible ovality of crank pin 0.005 mm Crank shaft journal to main 0.026 / 0.085 mm
Maximum permissible run out of 0.02 mm bearing clearence
2nd, 3rd and 4th main bearing journals
when supported at 1st and 5th main
bearing journals
Maximum permissible out of parallelism 0.010 mm
between crank pin and main
bearing journal axis
97
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
4th main bearing journal
CRANK SHAFT :
Clean and carry out visual inspection of crankshaft for the
following
ENGINE
l Overheating of journals, which is indicated by bluish
brown colour.
l Scoring marks on journals.
l Cranks, which should be checked on magnetic crack
detector.
Check crank shaft run out by supporting it on V-block at
1st and 5th main bearing journals. Fig. 149
If run out exceeds permissible limits, straighten crank
shaft in cold condition on press carefully.
Similarly check lateral and radial run outs of flywheel
mounting flange. Fig. 149
Check crank shaft main bearing and crank pin journal
dimension.
If necessary, grind crank shaft main bearing and crank pin
journals to next under size.
MAINTAIN CORRECT FILLET RADII FOR JOURNALS
Care must be taken during grinding to ensure that width
of journals is not increased.
Should it be necessary to grind sides of 4th main bearing
journal, grind it to next over size.
Re-chamfer oil holes on journals to avoid scoring of new
bearing shells.
Finish journals by lapping them with 320 grit lapping cloth
of suitable width.
After grinding recheck main bearing and crank pin journal
dimensions.
Fig. 150
Also recheck run out of crank shaft.
Thoroughly clean crank shaft with kerosene. Use wire
brush for cleaning oil holes.
IT IS ESSENTIAL TO RECHECK CRANK SHAFT FOR CRACKS
AND BALANCE AFTER GRINDING
Apply grease to all machined surfaces, if crank shaft is
to be stored. Crank shaft must always be stored in
vertical position.
CYLINDER BLOCK
Check cylinder block for cracks by pressure testing
method.
Check crank case mating surface with cylinder head
for unevenness with help of straight edge and feeler
gauge. Fig. 150 & 151
Fig. 151
98
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Fig. 153
Fig. 154
99
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
ÞÞ
a flat surface plate as it can not be measured on engine
cylinder block because the main bearing caps are guided)
Fig. 155. If pre tension is not in range (0.018 - 0.040 mm), SURFACE PLATE
change & select new shell.
MAIN BEARING SHELLS ARE PRECISION FINISHED AND
SHOULD NOT BE BORED OR SCRAPED. Schematic Sketch : Main bearing shell pretension checking
Fig. 156a
100
NEXT NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
REMOVAL, INSTALLATION AND MACHINING OF approximately at 100-120 rpm and approx. 50 double
CYLINDER LINERS strokes per minute. Under these conditions leave about
0.02 mm materials for second stage honing. Anticlock
REMOVAL
wise direction of rotation of tool will be prefered if possible. ENGINE
101
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
102
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Check functioning of Pressure relief valve. If the Engine oil pressure with coolant temperature of 700 C at
performance of the pump is not satisfactory, then replace idling speed
the oil pump assembly. 800+50 rpm - 1 bar
Fit oil pump assembly with new gasket. at 5000 rpm - 3 bar
Flow rate measured against back pressure of 3kg/cm2 Oil Pressure Switch
should be as follows using SAE-30 oil. NC contact opening pressure : 0.9 /0.6 bar
MAINOIL
GALLERY
OILFILTER
OILPUMP
GASKET
OILSUMP
STRAINER
DRAINPLUG
Fig. 158
103
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE
104
Fig. 159
COOLING CIRCUIT
INDEX
RADIATOR VENT HOSE
AUXILIARY WATER TANK
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
INTEGRAL HOSE
RADIATOR
GROUP INDEX
WATER INLET ELBOW
BYPASSLINE
UPPERCOOLINGLINE CAB HEATER FEEDER HOSE
NEXT
THERMOSTATCOVER
WATER TEMP. SENSOR
PREVIOUS
THERMOSTATHOUSING
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Thermostat
l Start opening temperature - 87 0C ± 2
l Full open temperature - 93 0C ± 2
l By pass port closed at or before
l Leakage through main valve (including seepage
hole) at room temperature and pressure of 1 kg/
cm2 : 150-250 ltrs/hr
l Maximum leakage through by pass at full open
temperature or main flow rate of
130 + 5 lpm : 1.5 lpm
Fig. 161
Thermostat is installed in cooling system between cyl.
head & radiator inlet tank.
3. As the engine cooling temperature reaches
The working principle of thermostat : thermostat full open temperature, thermostat valve
1. For cold engine (immediately after starting) : opens fully and thermostat by-pass valve closes
Thermostat does not allow coolant to flow to radiator completely.Under such condition maximum quantity
(Thermostat valve in closed position) instead coolant of engine coolant flows to radiator Fig. 161.
flows through thermostat by-pass outlet to engine.
Thus short circuiting of radiator which helps for
attaining engine working temperature in very short
period. Fig. 160
2. As soon as the coolant temperature reaches opening
temperature of thermostat, the thermostat valve
starts opening gradually and water flow starts to
radiator. At the same time thermostat by pass starts
closing gradually.
105
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
106
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
ENGINE
Fig. 165
Install rear oil seal using drift 2702 5890 0608 in crank
case rear cover. Fig. 166
Clean the mating surfaces of crank case & rear cover.
Fig. 166
Fit crank case rear cover with new gasket Fig. 167
Locate flywheel on crank shaft rear flange.
Screw-in flywheel mounting screws.
Insert flywheel locking pin
Tighten flywheel mounting screws to specified torque.
Remove flywheel locking pin.
Remove the connecting rod bearing cap with shell.
Fig. 167
107
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Fig. 169
JET
LUGS
Fig. 170
108
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Fig. 171
Fig. 172
Fig. 173
109
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
ENGINE
Fig. 174
Fig. 175
Fig. 176
110
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
ENGINE
Fig. 177
Fig. 178
Fig. 179
111
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
ENGINE
Fig. 180
112
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR INTAKE SYSTEM
Fig. 182
AIRTEMPRATURESENSOR
INDEX
SNORKEL
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
T - HOSE
AIR FILTER
GROUP INDEX
RESONATOR BOX
INTAKEMANIFOLD
CYLINDERHEAD
NEXT
PREVIOUS
113
ENGINE
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
114
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
ACCELERATOR CABLE
ENGINE
9 11 10
1 ASSY.ACC.CABLE-RHD
2 CLIP
3 HOSE
4 GROMMET
5 HEX FL SCREW M6X10
6 CABLE TIE 4.7X110
7 BRACKET ACC. CABLE
8 TOP SIDE NUT
9 ACCELERATOR PEDAL
10 ACCELERATOR CABLE PLASTIC END
11 INNER CABLE END
Fig. 184
Removal : Installation :
1. Loosen the top side nut (8) from threaded end of 1. Insert accelerator cable plastic end (10) inside the
accelerator cable at throttle body end. firewall hole.
2. Remove Hex FL screws (5) & remove cable from clip 2. Insert inner cable end (11) in accelerator pedal.
(2).
3. Locate accelerator cable in clip (2). Ensure that rubber
3. Remove inner cable end from throttle body sector sleeve (3) on accelerator cable are located inside the
after disengaging the threaded end of the cable in clip.
throttle body bracket (7).
4. Loosen the top side nut (8) from threaded end of the
4. Remove inner cable end (11) from accelerator pedal cable. Engage the threaded end of the cable in body
(9). bracket (7). Insert inner cable end in throttle body
sector.
5. Remove accelerator cable plastic end (10) through
firewall hole. 5. Ensure tightness in inner cable by adjusting the nuts
on threaded end of cable.
6. Ensure that when accelerator cable (9) is fully
depressed, full travel of throttle sector is achieved.
115
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE
116
ASSY. FOOT CONTROL
INDEX
4.0
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
GROUP INDEX
3 ASSY CLUTCH PEDAL LEVER COMPLETE.
4 ASSY ACC PEDAL (RHD)
5 SLEEVE (FOR BRAKE & CLUTCH)
6 CLUTCH PEDAL ASSISTANCE SPRING
7 BRIGHT WASHER 10.5
8 HEX BOLT M10X125
9 ASSY BRAKE PEDAL LEVER COMPLETE
10 TORSION SPRING (FOR BRAKE PEDAL RETURN)
11 NYLOC NUT M10
12 TORSION SPRING FOR ACC.PEDAL RETURN.
13 BUSH
14 CIRCLIP E9X1.1
NEXT
15 STOP LIGHT SWITCH
16 CLUTCH PEDAL STOPPER
- Specified Torque in Kgm
17 HEX SCREW M8X45
PREVIOUS
18 HEX NUT M8 Fig. 185 ® -Non Reusable Part
19 RUBBER COVER (PEDAL PLATE)
20 RUBBER COVER (ACC.PEDAL)
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
ENGINE TESTING Allow engine to cool down for about 3 hours.Then remove
cylinder head cover.
After assembly of the engine, mount engine on test bed,
prepare engine for starting and testing in the following Loosen cylinder head mounting bolt by quarter turn and ENGINE
Slightly raise the engine speed and check for any oil,
fuel, coolant and air leakages. Rectify if any. Check
colour of the exhaust gas. Check for any unusual noise
from the engine.
800 5 0.0
2000 5 2.3
2500 5 4.6
3000 5 5.8
3500 5 4.9
2500 5 8.2
117
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
Fig. 186
118
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
8. TROUBLE SHOOTING
NOTE : BEFORE CHANGING ANY SENSOR PLEASE CHECK THE WIRING HARNESS CAREFULLY.
ENGINE
Sr. Problem Observed Probable Cause Action to be taken
no.
1. Engine not cranking Low battery voltage Clean and tighten the connectors
Jump start using another battery
Get battery charged or changed
Faulty starter Rectify or replace
Worn out piston rings/seized pistons Overhaul & replace affected parts
Faulty immobiliser Check and rectify
119
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
120
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ENGINE 475 SI MPFI
10. High fuel Low battery voltage Check and tighten connections
consumption
Jump start using good battery
Get battery charged/changed
Inlet manifold leakage/ Set valve timing /check & reset
vacuum connections Check and rectify
Incorrect tappet clearances Check and reset
Valve timing incorrect Set valve timing /check & reset
Worn out piston rings/seized pistons Overhaul /replace affected parts
Spark plugs defective Clean and check gap/replace if
necessary
Adultrated fuel Flush the system and refill
Faulty lambada signal Check and Replace
Clogged injectors Check and Replace
Faulty fuel regulator Check and Replace
Vacuum line to presure
regulator connections Check and tighten/replacet
Faulty firing order/ injector Check and rectify
(connection) order
121
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
FUEL FEED SYSTEM
NEXT
GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
FUEL FEED SYSTEM
FUEL
FEED
SYSTEM
INTRODUCTION : The fuel system consists of fuel tank, intank fuel pump,
fuel filter, fuel lines and fuel rail. The fuel in the tank is
pumped up by the fuel pump, filtered by the fuel filter
and fed under pressure to each injector. The fuel
pressure at the injector is always higher than the
intake manifold pressure. The fuel is injected into the
intake port of the cylinder head when the injector opens
according to the injection signal from ECU (Engine
Control Unit).
NEXT i
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
FUEL FEED SYSTEM
CONTENTS
FUEL
1. Technical Specification 1 FEED
SYSTEM
2. Exploded Views
a) Assembly Fuel Tank with Filler pipe 2
b) Schematic circuit for MPFI Fuel Lines Euro II 3
3. General operation of evaporative emission system 4
4. Fuel tank 5
5. Fuel tank purging procedure 8
6. Electric intank fuel pump 10
7. Fuel pressure regulator 11
8. Fuel level guage (tank unit) 12
9. Fuel level guage (dashboard) 13
10. Fuel filter 14
11. Fuel filler cap 16
12. Fuel hoses and lines 17
13. Fuel level warning light 18
14. Evaporative emission control system 19
a) Restrictor 19
b) Vapour separator 19
c) Tank pressure valve 20
d) Carbon canister 21
e) Canister purge valve 23
NEXT iii
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
FUEL FEED SYSTEM
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
2. Fuel pressure, after ignition key is switched off : minimum 2.0 bar for 6 minutes FUEL
FEED
3. Fuel filter type : Inline (BOSCH) SYSTEM
1
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
FUEL
FEED
SYSTEM
2
ASSEMBLY FUEL TANK WITH FILLER PIPE - Specified Torque in Kgm
INDEX
FUEL FEED SYSTEM
0.8 to 1.0
2.2
GROUP INDEX
SR. PART DESCRIPTION
NO. 13 ASSY FILLER NECK WITH BRACKET (22.7 DIA)
0.8 to 1.0
1 ASSY FUEL TANK COMPLETE (MPFI) 14 ASSY FUEL TANK CAP-NONVENTED
2 ASSY FUEL TANK WELDED (FOR MPFI VERSION) 15 ASSY.HOSE PIPE 26 ASSY NYLON LINE
3 SEALING PLUG AM18X1.5 16 HOSE CLAMP ( 53 DIA ) 27 PLUG (FOR VAPOUR LINE)
4 SEALING WASHER 18X22 IS3175 CU 17 ASSY BREATHER HOSE 28 SPRING CLIP (10)
5 ASSY INTANK FUEL PUMP 18 HOSE CLAMP ( 23 DIA ) 29 ASSY NYLON LINE (VAPOUR SEPARATOR TO TPV)
6 LOCKING RING 19 ASSY BRACKET (FUEL FILTER MOUNTING) 30 SPRING BAND CLAMP FORM A 12X14D
7 PUMP PACKING 20 RUBBER PACKING 31 SLEEVE ( VAPOUR SEPARATOR HOSE)
NEXT
8 HEX FLANGE SCREW M6X10 - 8.8 21 ASSY.FUEL FILTER (M/S BOSCH ) 32 CABLE TIE 8 0X300 BLACK
9 GASKET 22 HEX FLANGE SCREW M6X16 -8.8 33 WASHER A8 4 IS5370 - ST
10 ASSY TANK UNIT W/O LOW LEVEL SENSOR (INJ)-VDO 23 ASSY DELIEVERY LINE FROM PUMP TO FILTER 34 HEX FL BOLT M8X25 - 8.8
PREVIOUS
11 CR PAN HD SCREW M5X10 24 ASSY RETURN LINE ON TANK 35 CLAMP(PIPE 8X8)
12 SPRING WASHER B5 25 ASSY VAPOUR SEPERATOR 36 HEX FL SCREW M6X20 - 8.8
SCHEMATIC CIRCUIT FOR MPFI FUEL LINES EURO II - Specified Torque in Kgm
INDEX
SR. PART DESCRIPTION
NO.
1 ASSY DELIEVERY LINE FROM FILTER
2 ASSY CLUSTER ON ENGINE
(3 BUNDY TUBES) 0.8 0.8 0.8
3 SPRING BAND CLAMP FORM A 12X14D 0.8
4 ASSY RETURN LINE (FIREWALL
TO UNDERBODY)
5 ASSY PIPE
6 TANK PRESSURE CONTROL VALVE
7 RUBBER HOSE (TPV TO CANISTER)
FUEL FEED SYSTEM
8 ASSY.ACT.CARBON CANISTER
9 HOSE (BUNDY TO CANISTER)
10 RUBBER HOSE -CANISTER
TO CPV(380)
11 CANISTER PURGE VALVE
12 RUBBER HOSE-CPV TO
INTAKE MANIFOLD(240)
13 SPRING CLIP (10)
14 CLAMP (PIPE 8X8X4.75X4.75)
GROUP INDEX
15 CLAMPING PLATE
(FOR PLASTIC CLAMPS)
16 HEX FL NUT AM6 - 8
17 CLAMP (PIPE 4.75X4.75X8X8)
18 CLAMP(8X8X4.75X4.75)
19 BRACKET
20 CLAMP (PIPE 8X8X4.75X4.75)
21 CLAMPING PLATE
22 CLAMP(PIPE 8X4.75)
23 R CLAMP
(PARKING BRAKE CABLE)
NEXT
PREVIOUS
0.8
3
FUEL
FEED
SYSTEM
FUEL FEED SYSTEM
GENERAL OPERATION OF
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM:
The system operates when outdoor temperature is
higher, after the vehicle has been parked / standstill
for a long time, the fuel temperature increases and
brings about a pressure rise inside the tank. This
increase may occur with medium - low fuel levels or
with the tank full condition.
4
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
FUEL FEED SYSTEM
FUEL TANK :
The fuel tank is located under the rear seat of the
vehicle. The fuel pump and fuel level gauge are
assembled on the upper part of fuel tank. For
servicing the fuel level gauge the fuel tank must be FUEL
removed from the vehicle. Fig 2. FEED
SYSTEM
Fig 2.
Removal :
1. Remove fuel filler cap.
2. Drain the fuel from the fuel tank before removing
the tank from the vehicle via drain plug (Fig 3). Do
not drain or store fuel in an open container to avoid
possibility of fire or explosion. Put lid on container.
Fig 3.
Fig 4.
5
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
FUEL FEED SYSTEM
FUEL
FEED
SYSTEM
Fig 5.
5. Disconnect fuel filler hose from fuel hose. (Fig 6.)
Fig 6.
Fig 7.
6
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
FUEL FEED SYSTEM
7
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
FUEL FEED SYSTEM
Fig 11.
8
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
FUEL FEED SYSTEM
FUEL
FEED
SYSTEM
Fig 12.
9
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
FUEL FEED SYSTEM
On Vehicle Inspection :
1. Check fuel pump for operation as follows :
a) Remove fuel filler cap.
Fig 13.
b) Release the fuel system pressure as
mentioned above for removal of tank.
c) Turn ignition switch ON
d) Check whether fuel pump is running by
listening for sound at fuel filter inlet.
e) If no sound is heard, measure voltage between
fuel pump eletrical connector wire to chassis
ground. The voltage should be approx. 12V.
f) If voltage is not correct, check for fuel pump
relay and related wiring harness.
g) If you do not measure 12V, check for
continuity between fuel pump connector
terminal wires (battery) and (ground).
h) If there is no continuity, repair ground circuit
and again confirm for continuity.
Removal : Warning :
2 a) For fuel pump removal fold the rearseat and
Unless replacement is necessary, fuel pump, fuel level
open the plastic lid located under the floor
gauge should not be removed from the tank since the
carpet.
rubber parts i.e. gasket, seals etc. may get exposed
b) Disconnect electrical connectors. Release the to air, light and may become hard.
fuel system pressure as already explained in
fuel tank removal. Never apply an excessive force to the fuel pump nipple
or lead wire. This may result in bent or poor contact.
c) Disconnect the fuel lines (delivery and return).
d) Loosen fuel pump mountings screws. Take
the fuel pump out by pushing the ring aside.
Assembly :
e) Check fuel pump for evidence dirt and
contamination. If so, clean and check for Assemble the pump in reverse order of removal as
presence of dirt in fuel tank. explained in 2.e. (above)
10
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
FUEL FEED SYSTEM
Removal:
1. Disconnect the tube from inlet manifold to fuel
pressure regulator.
2. Disconnect the fuel hose from fuel filter to fuel
pressure regulator.
3. Loosen mounting bolts and remove fuel pressure
regulator from fuel rail.
Assembly :
VC PIPE AIR
CHAMBER
DIAPHRAGM FUEL IN
VALVE
11
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
FUEL FEED SYSTEM
Removal : FULL
WIRE SEAL
Refer procedure as mentioned in Fuel tank removal. VIOLET
3/4
FUEL BROWN
FEED Inspection :
SYSTEM
1. Use an ohmmeter to confirm that the 1/2
resistance of the fuel level sensor changes BRAZED
with the level of float position.Fig 14,14a &15. SOLODERED 1/4
2. The specified resistance values of the fuel
gauge are given below : EMPTY HIGH
EMPTY LOW
Fig 14.
64.5 9 1/4 50 ±4
Assembly :
METER
GAUGE
TERMINAL
(Violet)
TANK UNIT
TERMINAL
(BROWN)
12
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
FUEL FEED SYSTEM
13
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
FUEL FEED SYSTEM
FUEL FILTER :
The fuel filter is located under the body near the fuel
tank along the pipe carrying the fuel to fuel rail as
shown Fig 17, It is made up of an outer case and an
FUEL integral mount that holds a filter element with high
FEED
SYSTEM
filtering capacity. It filters the fuel being deliver under
pressure by the fuel pump. This is essential for
ensuring fuel injection operation since the injector is
extremely sensitive to foreign particles in the supply
circuit. Since it cannot be disassembled, it must be
replaced as an assembly at the recommended
intervals.
Removal :
1. Ref. Procedure as mentioned above from
(a) to (c).
2. Place fuel container under fuel filter.
3. Disconnect inlet and outlet hoses from fuel filter.
Collect fuel emerging during the operation in
suitable container.
14
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
FUEL FEED SYSTEM
Caution :
Assembly :
1. Assemble filter. The arrow stamped on the outer
case of the filter indicates the fuel flow direction.
2. Tighten the filter clamping screws to tightening
torque 0.8 - 1.0 kgm.
3. Connect inlet hose, outlet hose to filter. Ensure
that clampings are fitted properly.
4. Connect negative battery terminal.
5. With engine OFF condition and ignition switch
ON check for fuel leakage.
6. Start engine and check each joint of fuel
system for leakage. Rectify if necessary.
15
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
FUEL FEED SYSTEM
After the O ring on fuel filler cap and the fuel filler
neck flange contacts, the ratchet produces a loud
clicking sound, indicating the seal has been set.
Removal / Inspection :
1. Remove fuel filler cap.
2. Check O ring for even filler neck imprint.
3. Check O ring for any deterioration or any
damage. If found damaged replace fuel filler cap.
Note : In case of fuel filler cap, replacement to be
done with correct cap. Otherwise it may result in
critical malfunction of the system.
TAG
THIS IS TO BE ASSEMBLED
WITH FILLER NECK
CAP RETAINER
SEAL
THREADED CAP
TOP VIEW
Fig 18.
16
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
FUEL FEED SYSTEM
The vapour lines are made of rubber hoses and pipes FUEL
with clamps at joints. FEED
SYSTEM
Removal :
1. Ref. Procedure as mentioned for removal of fuel
tank.
2. To avoid damage to the vapour hoses while
disconnecting slide back the clamps then twist
the lines as you pull.
3. Disconnect clamps by pressing the two tabs.
Fig 19.
Fig 19.
Inspection :
1. Visually check all hoses and pipes connected via
clamps for leaks, loose connections, deterioration
or damage, hose crack etc. Replace if necessary.
2. Make sure that all clamps are secure.
3. If the pipe clamps found deformed, bent or broken,
replace with new one.
Assembly :
1. Do not tighten the clamps used on breather hose
/filler hose excessively to avoid damage to hoses.
Use suitable tool for fitment of clamp.
2. Fuel hoses to fuel pipe connections varies for each
type of pipe. Necessary care to be taken to
connect and clamp each hose correctly.
3. Ensure that clamps are fitted properly on to pipe,
filter, pump fittings.
4. Do not kink or twist hose / pipe when they are
routed.
5. Install fuel filler hose after fuel tank has been
mounted in place on vehicle otherwise this may
leads to leakage of fuel around hose connections.
6. Connect negative terminal at battery.
7. Turn ignition switch ON and run engine idle. Check
for fuel leakages.
17
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
FUEL FEED SYSTEM
18
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
FUEL FEED SYSTEM
20
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
FUEL FEED SYSTEM
Removal :
Fig 26.
21
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
FUEL FEED SYSTEM
Removal:
1. Disconnect hose ( from canister to purge valve).
2. When the air is blown into Tank port, there should
be no restriction of flow through Purge port and
Air port(i.e. canister bottom port).
FUEL
FEED
3. If the operation differs from the above description,
SYSTEM canister must be replaced.
4. Connect hoses to canister.
5. Ensure that hoses are clamped securely.
Warning : Purge
Do not suck air through canister port. Fuel vapours
inside canister is harmful.
Inspection :
1. Remove fuel filler cap.
Fig 27.
2. If check result is not satisfactory, check for vaccum
hose, purge valve, wire harness etc. Check
carbon canister for signs of damage and defects.
If defective, replace canister.
If OK, go to step 3
3. Warm up engine to normal operating temperature.
4. Disconnect purge end hose (from the canister to
purge valve)
5. a) Place finger against the end of disconnected
hoses. Check that vaccum is felt there when
engine is running at idle speed.
b) Also check that vaccum is felt when engine
speed is increased to higher than 2000/3000rpm.
6. Start engine and run it at idle speed. Disconnect
vaccum hose(from canister purge valve to
T Connector). Block the T connector port from
where the hose has been removed, with finger
placed against the hose disconnected. Check that
vaccum is applied. If it is not applied clean vaccum
passage by blowing compressed air.
Assembly :
22
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
FUEL FEED SYSTEM
23
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
EXHAUST
NEXT
GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
EXHAUST SYSTEM
EXHAUST
SYSTEM
INTRODUCTION :
i
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
EXHAUST SYSTEM
CONTENTS
iii
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
EXHAUST SYSTEM
EXHAUST
SYSTEM
1
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
EXHAUST SYSTEM
®
2.3
2.3
®
3.2
4.5
2
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
EXHAUST SYSTEM
GENERAL PRECAUTIONS :
To avoid the danger of being burnt, do not touch the
exhaust system when the system is hot. Any service
on the exhaust system should be performed when the
system is cool.
At every interval of periodic maintenance service, and
when vehicle is raised for other service, check exhaust
system as follows :
EXHAUST
Check rubber mountings for damage, SYSTEM
3
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
EXHAUST SYSTEM
EXHAUST
SYSTEM
EXHAUST PIPE
For replacement of exhaust pipe, be sure to hoist
vehicle and observe WARNING under Maintenance
and following.
CAUTION :
An exhaust pipe and catalytic converter should not
be exposed to any impulse.
Be careful not to drop it or hit it against something.
4
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
EXHAUST SYSTEM
5
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
CLUTCH
NEXT
GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
CLUTCH
CLUTCH
INTRODUCTION : The clutch in Indica is a single disc dry friction type with a
diameter of 190 mm. It is of diaphragm type and is
mechanically actuated by a cable connecting clutch pedal
and the clutch release lever.
No clutch pedal free play adjustment is required although
clutch pedal height from floor has to be adjusted as the
clutch lining wears.The clutch pedal height from the floor
keeps on increasing as the clutch lining wears.
i
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
CLUTCH
CONTENTS
1. Technical specifications 1
2. Tightening Torques 3
3. List of Special Tools 3
4. Theory of Diaphragm spring clutch 4
5. Constructional details 5
CLUTCH
6. Factors affecting clutch wear 5
7. Preliminary Inspection of clutch 6
8. Clutch cable
Removal, Inspection & Installation 7
9. Removal of clutch from the car 8
10. Inspection of components 9
11. Installation of clutch on the car 9
12. Procedure for clutch adjustment 10
13. Trouble shooting 11
iii
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
CLUTCH
Technical Specifications :
Type
Cover Assembly Single plate dry friction
Diaphragm spring type
Disc Assembly Predamper X (D) type
Non asbestos (F491) facings
Release bearing Assembly Self Centering Type
Clutch Disc : Fig. 1
CLUTCH
1. Outside Diameter 190 mm
2. Inside Diameter 134 mm
3. Thickness of Clutch disc with new
lining under 320 kg load 7 + 0.3 mm
4. Max. Permissible out of Perpendicularity of each
lining surface of clutch disc 0.4 mm at 186 mm dia.
5. Max. Permissible imbalance of clutch disc 15 gm-cm
6. Cushioning of Clutch disc 0.6 to 0.85 mm
7. Total Friction Area (Both sides) 285 sq.cm
1
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
CLUTCH
7+0.3
CLUTCH
TI ON
R EC
DI
N
TIO
OTA
R
DAMPENING
18.33 mm
[Minor dia]
18.2+0.5 O
SPRINGS *
25+0.5
190 O
134 O
DAMPENING SPRINGS
* THE CHARACTERISTICS OF DAMPENING SPRINGS FOR DIESEL AND PETROL CLUTCH DISCS ARE DIFFERENT.
2
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
CLUTCH
34 O
TRAVEL
WEAR
27.1 O
HEIGHT
FINGER
6.51
8+1 18.7+3.02
CLUTCH
RELEASE
TRAVEL
132 +1 O
190 -1.5 O
Fig. 2
Clutch Pressure Plate : Fig. 2
Tightening Torques :
Clutch Housing to Cylinder block - 4 to 5 mkg.
Clutch Pressure plate mounting bolts - 2.4 mkg.
3
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
CLUTCH
CLUTCH
Cover Assembly
Pressure Plate
Disc Assembly
Diaphragm Spring
Flywheel Face
4
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
CLUTCH
4
10
7
9
8 1) BACK COVER
6
2) ASSY. CLUTCH RELEASE YOKE
3) BUSH (LOWER)
4) TA65 MOUNTING BOLTS
5 5) COVER (INSPECTION WINDOW)
6) BUSH (UPPER)
7) CLUTCH RELEASE LEVER
8) HEX. FLANGED SCREW CLUTCH
11
1 4 9) HEX. FLANGED NUT
13 10) ASSY. BRACKET (ON TRANS AXLE)
11) CLUTCH RELEASE BEARING
12 12) CLUTCH DISC ASSEMBLY
13) COVER ASSEMBLY
2
14 14) FLANGED HEX SCREW
Fig. 4
1. CONSTRUCTIONAL DETAILS Fig. 4 i. Clutch riding
Clutch is the mechanism interposed between Using clutch pedal as foot rest by keeping foot
engine and the Transaxle which enables engine constantly on pedal while driving will cause
power as well as torque of the engine to be partial clutch disengagement. It will result in
transmitted at will to the transaxle through slipping of the clutch disc and premature failure
friction drive. When clutch pedal is depressed the of the clutch.
clutch is disengaged therefore motion and ii. Permitting the clutch to slip too long
power flow from engine to Transaxle and hence Half clutch driving and thereby permitting the
to road wheels is disconnected. clutch purposely to slip too long will have the
It is a single disc dry friction type clutch having same result as above.
190 mm dia. clutch disc. Clutch pressure plate iii. Permitting the clutch to jerk
assembly is diaphragm spring type. Clutch
actuation is through mechanical linkages (cable). Sudden clutch engagement at higher engine
speed specially while moving out the stuck car
2. FACTORS AFFECTING CLUTCH WEAR
will cause severe instantaneous clutch loading,
The clutch is designed to give maximum life resulting in clutch slippage and burning of the
under most severe conditions when handled lining locally. Starting the car in first gear under
carefully. However, while in operation, clutch such conditions will avoid such problem. Always
lining is subjected to wear. Apart from this the start the car in first gear.
extent of wear also depends on following.
iv. Restarting on gradient :
2a. DRIVING
While restarting the car on gradient, make use of
Following driving conditions will affect the parking brake. Half clutch driving while restarting
performance of the clutch. on the gradient will cause premature damage to
clutch.
5
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
CLUTCH
6
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
CLUTCH
4. CLUTCH CABLE
Control Mounting
Bracket
Clutch Pedal
Clutch cable
holding clip
Clutch Cable
Piot
CLUTCH
Clutch Cable
Silicon Rubber Sleeve
Exhaust Pipe
Centre of vehicle
50 Plastic straps
120
Release lever
Joint pin
Cable holding clamp
On fire wall stud
Cable nut
Fig. 5
Replace the cable if 6 Ensure the heat resistant sleeve is in front of the
exhaust front pipe.
a) there are any bends or kinks.
7
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
CLUTCH
4
10
7
9
6 8
1) BACK COVER
2) ASSY. CLUTCH RELEASE YOKE
3) BUSH (LOWER)
5 4) TA65 MOUNTING BOLTS
5) COVER (INSPECTION WINDOW)
6) BUSH (UPPER)
CLUTCH
7) CLUTCH RELEASE LEVER
11
1 4 8) HEX. FLANGED SCREW
13 9) HEX. FLANGED NUT
10) ASSY. BRACKET (ON TRANS AXLE)
12
11) CLUTCH RELEASE BEARING
12) CLUTCH DISC ASSEMBLY
2
14 13) COVER ASSEMBLY
14) FLANGED HEX SCREW
Fig. 6
7 Fix LH side cable holding clamp on firewall. Ensure l Unscrew the mounting bolts evenly (alternately and
that cable is free in the clamp. crosswise) in small steps Fig. 7
8 Adjust the pedal height according to specifications l Remove clutch pressure plate assembly and clutch
after the clutch cable nut is fastened on to the cable. disc along with the mandrel.
9 Finally check the clutch for proper functioning.
5 REMOVAL OF CLUTCH FROM THE CAR :
l Place chokes on wheels to prevent movement of
car.
l Disconnect battery and electrical connections of
the starter motor.
l Loosen mounting bolts and remove starter
motor. Disconnect and remove transaxle along
with housing from engine (for procedure refer
transaxle group)
l Remove clutch release bearing with sleeve (7)
Fig. 6
l Support clutch pressure plate and clutch disc MANDREL
with mandrel. PART NO. 2702 5890 2501
Fig. 7
8
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
CLUTCH
9
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
CLUTCH
Tension spring
Adjusting
Inner cable Nut
CLUTCH
Cable ties
Fig. 8
Note : 4. It should be possible to lift the clutch pedal by
There is no free play in the system and hence no clutch hand easily without much force. The pedal should
pedal free play adjustment is required. However, for have movement of 40 to 50 mm. If pedal lifting
ensuring the proper functioning of the clutch the force is high, (more than 0.9 kg.) then shift the
following procedures should be used. position of tension spring hook on holes 1, 2 and
3 for reducing tension Fig. 8
1. Clutch pedal height should be same as the brake
pedal height. (Brake pedal height is automatically
ensured by protrusion of booster push rod (refer
Brake pedal adjustment from Brake Group)).
2. The clutch pedal height from the floor keeps on
increasing as the clutch lining wears.
3. Clutch pedal height can be adjusted by setting the
nut provided on the clutch release lever. The
release lever is located on transaxle housing. Turn
the nut by hands so as to get clutch pedal height
same as brake pedal height, and cable is sufficiently
stretched. Press the clutch pedal 2/3 times and
confirm the height.
10
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
CLUTCH
9 TROUBLE SHOOTING
SR. IN THE VEHICLE THE COMOPONENT CAUSE REMEDY
NO.
Difficulty in changing Burrs thrown up around Due to poor alignment of the Care with the centering of
gear, following splines causing stiff gearbox on reassembly. driven plate; use an
replacement of clutch movement on input shaft. appropriate clutch aligning
tool.
The driven plate was Do not force the gearbox but
improperly aligned. rotate the flywheel or
Aggressive location of input gearbox shaft to line up with CLUTCH
Loss of drive and loud The centre hub of the The weight of the gearbox has Ensure that the gearbox shaft
clatter, only covered driven plate has ripped been hung on the centre and gearbox are not hung on
a few hundred out and possibly one or plate. This has distorted the the clutch driven plate by
kilometres. more of the springs have driven plate resulting in failure
using a pit jack or trolley jack
been pushed out. within a short period of use. to support the gearbox on
reassembly.
Very aggressive clutch control. Do not “boy race”
ie.“Racing starts” or when Educate the driver.
towing a heavily laden trailer.
3. Slipping Clutch
Clutch slip. The control The clutch friction There is an oil leak from the Carefully check the engine
system is in good material is contaminated engine or gearbox. and gearbox oil seals.
condition and correctly with oil. Replace seals if oil is present
adjusted. in bell housing.
Clutch judder on initial Oil or grease found on Excess grease applied Only use the correct amount
take up of torque. the middle of the clutch to input shaft splines. and the correct type of
driven plate. grease.
5. Loss of Drive
Loss of drive The friction material has Drive error - e.g. accidentally
come off from both changing from 5th to 2nd
sides (centrifuged). gear at 85 miles per hour.
The facings have
centrifugated. The
shattered linings are
lodged into cover
assembly and loose in
the bell housing. Some
parts of the driven plate
could be broken.
11
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
CLUTCH
Pedal vibration when The fingers of the The gearbox input shaft has Carefully guide in the
starting to declutch. diaphragm are out of line struck the fingers of the gearbox to avoid any knocks
and show signs of diaphragm on fitting. on fitting.
damage.
Metallic sounding Signs of rubbing on the Incorrect clutch adjustment Systematically check the
CLUTCH
noise affected by diaphragm fingers, in the excess travel. Automatic condition of the cable,
engine speed with area of contact with the adjuster is faulty. linkage and automatic
pedal fully depressed release bearings. adjuster.
Always refer to vehicle
workshop manual for correct
adjustment.
The pedal is hard to The tips of the diaphragm The pre-load on the release During clutch installation
depress. fingers are worn away bearing is too low or not thoroughly inspect all
This stiffness increases by the release bearing. existent.The pre-load spring linkages and joints. Ensure
over time. The bearing can appear is unhooked. that the clutch cable is smooth
to be in good condition. and free throughout its
movement.
Always
refer to vehicle
workshop manual for
correct adjustment.
The pre-load should be
minimum of 50 Newtons to
a maximum of 80 Newtons.
9. Noisy Clutch
The clutch is noisy and A location lug on the A lug has broken. An other Check the fork and the
the pedal can be slack. release bearing has fault in the mechanical guide sleeve and replace if
broken. operation of the clutch has signs of wear are present.
caused the lug to break. For Ensure components are
example, the fork is out of lubricated. Carefully check
shape or wrongly positioned at the clutch cable.
the time of assembly.
10. Horse Noise on Decltuching
A harsh whistling noise The movement of the The bearing has seized Systematically check the
can be heard either on release bearing is hard or was noisy from the start. clutch cable, linkages, joints
declutching or all the when rotated by hand. Or the bearing has overheated, fork bearings, pre-load
time. It varies according burning off the grease caused spring .
to the pressure applied by incorrect pre-load.
to the pedal.
12
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
CLUTCH
Permanent, loud The levers are badly Incorrect clutch adjustment Regularly check the clutch
noise. damaged and the release causing bearing failure. adjustment. Always refer to
bearing has seized. the vehicle workshop
manual for correct method
of clutch adjustment.
The clutch slips and The pressure plate shows Driver resting foot on pedals. Regularly correct clutch CLUTCH
eventually judders. burn marks. Incorrect clutch adjustment. adjustment. Always refer to
the vehicle workshop
manual for correct method
of clutch adjustment.
Educate the driver.
The clutch judders. Circular grooves can be The clutch has been replaced Systemically check the
seen on the friction when the flywheel has been condition of the flywheel.
material on the flywheel previously scored. Skim flywheel if necessary.
side.
Stiff pedal with the risk The guide tube is The release bearing jams If there are any signs of
of prolonged slipping corroded and worn. on the guide. irregular wear replace guide
after pulling away. Clutch wear is abnormal tube. Avoid excessive
taking into account the lubrication which could
amount of mileage. contaminate the friction
material.
13
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
NEXT
GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
TRANSAXLE
NEXT i
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
CONTENTS
1. Technical Specifications 1
2. Tightening Torques 2
3. List of special Tools 3
4. Exploded View of Gear Shift Linkage 4
5. Exploded View of Housing and Differential 5
5. Exploded View of Input shaft and Layshaft 6
7. Exploded View of Shifter shaft arrangement 7
8. Removal of Transaxle from the car 8 TRANSAXLE
NEXT iii
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS :
Type : Synchromesh on all forward gears and sliding mesh for reverse gear.
Gear shift : Floor mounted with international H pattern with first and reverse
inline.
1
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
TIGHTENING TORQUES :
2
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
6. Drift for removal of cylinderical roller bearing from layshaft front 2702 5890 2605
TRANSAXLE
7. Holder for removing input shaft rear bearing 2702 5890 2606
10. Fixture for holding gear on differential casing 2702 5890 2609
14. Drift for a) Lay shaft deep groove ball bearing 2641 5890 2601
b) Rear hub outer bearing seating on spindle
15. Drift for input shaft rear bearing, lay shaft rear bearing 2651 5890 3308
17. Puller for deep groove ball bearing (Front) Input shaft 2657 5890 2801
18. Drift for differental bearing outer race and speedo gear 2654 5890 3507
19. Puller for deep groove ball bearing (Rear) 2654 5890 3508
3
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
SPACER
BUSH (G.S.LEVER BALL SEAT)
PIN
ASSY EXTENSION ARM COLLAR BUSH
ASSY YOKE
RUBBER BOOT (G.S.LEVER GUIDE)
ASSY BKT ASSY PLATE (BELLOW/SUPPORT
HOLDER)
2.3
2.3
0.95
PIN ASSY HANGER
COLLAR BUSH
2.3
ASSY YOKE
4.6
2.1-2.9
2.5-4.0
2.3 PIN
4
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
RUBBER SEAL
21. - 2.5
BREATHER
3.0-4.1
LOCK PLATE
1.6-1.9
DETENT SPRING AND BALL
NEEDLE BUSH (SKEWED) GASKET
SPIDER
DIFFERENTIAL HOUSING
SPEEDO PINION EXT CIRCLIP
SPEEDO ADAPTOR
BEVEL PINION
O-RING
GEAR FINAL DRIVE
OIL SEAL
8.0-9.0
0.85-1.15
SIDE BEVEL GEAR
INTEGRAL OIL SEAL
SPEEDO GEAR
TAPER ROLLER BEARING
SHIM (DIFF. BEARING)
RUBBER
BELLOW
5
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
ENGAGING GEAR
(5th SPEED)
SYNCHROCONE
SUB ASSY 5th GEAR LAYSHAFT (3rd/4th/5th)
CIRCLIP
SYNCHROCONE (1st/2nd) 2nd GEAR LAYSHAFT
SYNCHROCONE (1st/2nd)
CIRCLIP
LAYSHAFT
INPUT SHAFT
CAP
6
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
DOUBLE DOWEL
SLEEVE
SPIRAL DOWEL
SHIFTER DOG
TRANSAXLE
SPIRAL DOWEL
SHIFTER FORK (1st/2nd)
PIN
LEVER (SE./SHIFTING)
2.5-4
0.85-1.05
2.1-2.9
7
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
Fig. 2
8
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
9
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
Fig. 9
10
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
Fig. 10 TRANSAXLE
Fig. 11
Fig. 12
11
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
TRANSAXLE Fig. 13
NEEDLE BEARING
BUSH
Fig. 14
Fig. 15
12
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
Fig. 16 TRANSAXLE
Fig. 17
Fig. 18
13
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
TRANSAXLE Fig. 19
Fig. 20
Fig. 21
14
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
Fig. 22 TRANSAXLE
Fig. 23
39. Unlock the lock nut M10 and unscrew and remove
the locking screw on lever (selection/shifting)
Fig. 24
40. Remove the differential assembly from the
housing front.
41. Pull out assembly shaft (selector/shifting) from
lever (selection/shifting) and bellow holder with
oil seal from housing front half.
42. Pry out the oil seal of shaft (selector/shifting) from
bellow holder and replace it with a new one while
assembling. DO NOT USE THE OLD OIL SEAL.
Fig. 24
15
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
TRANSAXLE Fig. 25
Fig. 26
Fig. 27
16
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
NOTE :
1 Apply anabond 112 on threads of all fasteners
2. Apply RTV silicon liquid gasket anabond 676 on
housing interface.
3. The chips collected by magnetic drain plug, are
to be removed at the time of every oil change.
4. Keep inner and outer races of taper roller bearing
in sets.
C
5. Use sealing anaerobic compound for all oil seals
outer diameter.
6. For oil seals of input drive shaft & bellows use
anabond 112.
ASSEMBLY
1. Fit clutch release fork shaft. Fit plastic bushes. TRANSAXLE
Fit lever on clutch release shaft and lock it by
grooved pin.
2. Fix delrin bush and rubber bush into assembly
shaft (selector/shifting). Ensure that delrin bush
B
17
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
TRANSAXLE Fig. 29
Fig. 30
Fig. 31
18
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
Fig. 32 TRANSAXLE
Fig. 33
Fig. 34
19
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
Fig.36
20
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
NOTE :
Apply liquid gasket (Anabond 90 or 3 bond 12S001)
with proper bead size on front half/ interface.
21. Fix the housing (rear half) and tighten the flanged
mounting bolts to specified torque. Fig. 37
22. Place lock plates of lay shaft bearing and input
shaft bearing and fix them by allen screws. Tap
the shaft in either direction if required.
23. Place spacer on lay shaft.
24. Put input shaft 5th gear on input shaft.
CAUTION :
Ensure ground face (5th gear I/S) towards the
bearing face. Fig. 37 TRANSAXLE
Fig. 38
31. Lock the input shaft from below. Engage any one
of the gears.
32. Tighten the lock nuts on both lay shaft and input
shaft by giving torque of 12.3-16.7 mkg
Fig. 39
Fig. 39
21
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
Stake the collar of both lock nuts on layshaft
and input shaft. Fig. 40
33. Check the correct positioning of shifter shaft by
moving the gear shifter shaft assembly in neutral.
é
34. Assemble speedo pinion with speedo adaptor.
Fix assembly speedo pinion. Fix assembly hex.
é
screw (speedo) lock plate) along with lock plate
(speedo gear).
35. Place assembly rear cover with rubber seal on
housing (rear half) and fix it by assembly hex.
screws (3Nos.).
CAUTION : ENSURE THAT TUBULAR PORTION OF
THE RUBBER SEAL IS SEATED PROPERLY
(WITHOUT ANY PINCHING ONTO THE CHANNEL IN
THE REAR COVER). Fig. 41
TRANSAXLE 36. Tighten the screws to specified torque. Fig.41a Fig. 41
CAUTION : USE PROPER GASKET AND SEALANT
Clean the front half and rear half interfaces/ so that no
cured and dried liquid gasket remained are left on the
machined surfaces.
36. Unlock the input shaft from below.
37. Fix reverse light switch on housing (rear half),
magnetic drain and filter plugs with new washers.
38. Fix the C-mount bracket on the gear box front
housing.
39. Fix the B-mount bracket in the correct orientation.
40. Unscrew 3 mounting bolts (M8) and dismount
the transaxle assembly from adaptor plate on
workstand.
DISASSEMBLY OF LAYSHAFT
1. Remove Deep groove Ball bearing from lay shaft
by using holder 2702 5890 2607 with puller Fig. 41a
2654 5890 3508 Fig. 42
Fig. 40 Fig. 42
22 NEXT
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
Fig. 43 TRANSAXLE
Fig. 46 Fig. 45
23
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
TRANSAXLE Fig. 47
Fig. 48
Fig. 49
24
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
Fig. 50 TRANSAXLE
Fig. 51
Fig. 52
25
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
TRANSAXLE Fig. 53
Fig. 54
Fig. 55
26
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
Fig. 56 TRANSAXLE
Fig. 57
Fig. 58
27
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
TRANSAXLE Fig. 59
Fig. 60
Fig. 61
28
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
Fig. 62 TRANSAXLE
Fig. 63
Fig. 64
29
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
TRANSAXLE Fig. 65
Fig. 66
ASSEMBLY :
1. Place and fit deep groove ball bearing (rear) on
input shaft using drift part no. 2651 5890 3308
with taper groove for Lock Plate in upward
direction.
2. Place Inputshaft upside down and press
deep groove ball bearing (front) by drift part
no. 2702 5890 2602. Fig. 67
Fig. 67
30
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY :
DISASSEMBLY:
1. Remove taper roller bearings by using puller
part no. 2702 5890 2604, and rest pad part
no. 2702 5890 2612N Fig. 67
2. Remove speedo gear using by puller part no. 2651
5890 3506 and rest pad part no. 2702 5890
2612N.
Fig. 68 TRANSAXLE
Fig. 69
Fig. 70
31
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
TRANSAXLE Fig. 71
Fig. 72
Fig. 73
32
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
Fig. 74 TRANSAXLE
Fig. 75
Fig. 76
33
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
TRANSAXLE Fig. 77
Fig. 78
34
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
IDENTIFICATION :
1. Engaging Gears :
i) 5th engaging gear is having smaller dia inner
spline for fitment on layshaft.
ii) 3rd & 4th engaging gear is similar in size
with 5th engaging gear but having bigger inner
splines to fit on layshaft.
iii) 1st & 2nd engaging gear is having inner spline
dia similar to 3rd/4th engaging gear but outer
dia is bigger to engage with 1st/2nd shifter
sleeve.
2. Shifter Forks :
i) 5th gear shifter fork has three prominent ribs
and dowel hole is approx. in the centre of Fig. 79 TRANSAXLE
Fig. 80
Fig. 81
35
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
TRANSAXLE Fig. 82
4. Shifter Sleeve :
i) 5th/3rd/4th shifter sleeves are identical and
are interchangeable. Fig. 83
Fig. 83
Fig. 84
36
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
SUB-ASSEMBLIES :
1. 5th Synchropack Assembly
i) Place needle roller bearing and bush in 5th
gear. Fig. 85
ii) Assemble the carrier 3/4/5 springs, balls
engaging gear and shifter sleeve.
Fig. 85 TRANSAXLE
NOTE :
The engaging gear can be put in either way.
iii) Place synchrocone on 5th gear layshaft.
iv) Place synchropack assembly with shifter sleeve
on 5th gear. Fig. 86
Ensure that slot or fork pad on shifter sleeve 3/4/
5 be in downward position.
Fig. 86
Fig. 87
37
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
TRANSAXLE Fig. 88
Fig. 89
Fig. 90
38
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
TRANSAXLE
Fig. 91
TRANSAXLE
Fig. 92
39
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DRIVESHAFT
NEXT
GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DRIVESHAFT
INTRODUCTION :
1
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DRIVESHAFT
CONTENTS
1. Special Tools 5
2. Exploded View 6
3. Driveshaft Parts 8
6. Driveshafts handling 21
DRIVE
SHAFT
3
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DRIVESHAFT
DRIVESHAFTS PARTS
INBOARD JOINT
OUTBOARD JOINT SMALL SEAL
RETAINING
CLAMP
AXLE SHAFT
DRIVE
LARGE SEAL TRIPOT SEAL LARGE SEAL
SHAFT
CV BOOT SEAL
RETAINING (INBOARD RETAINING
(OUTBOARD SEAL)
CLAMP(CV SIDE) SEAL) CLAMP
(TRIPOT SIDE)
CV JOINT
RETAINER RING BALL SPIDER TRIPOT OUTER
CV BOOT SEAL
ASSEMBLY HOUSING
AXLE SHAFT
RUBBER DAMPER
C.V. DEFLECTOR
RING LARGE SEAL TRIPOT
RETAINER TRIPOT
RETAINING CLAMP SMALL SEAL SEAL
RING RETAINER
(CV SIDE) RETAINING
RING
CLAMP
A = 418+50
LARGE SEAL
RETAINING
CLAMP
5
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DRIVESHAFT
EXPLODED VIEW
ABS RING CV JOINT INNER
CV BIG CLAMP
CV BALLS
CV JOINT BOOT
CLAMP
DRIVE CV SMALL CLAMP
SHAFT
AXLE BAR
DAMPER
ASM SPIDER
TRIPOT BOOT
RETAINING RING
MALE TRIPOT
HOUSING
RETAINING RING
RETAINING RING
-- NON-REUSABLE PART
6
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DRIVESHAFT
DRIVE
SHAFT
RUBBER DAMPER
ABS RING
CLAMP
DEFLECTOR RING
FOR RH ONLY
Fig.5 View of Rubber Damper Fig.6 View of Toner and Deflector ring
7
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DRIVESHAFT
CLAMPS :
8
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DRIVESHAFT
I. DISASSEMBLY PROCEDURE :
1. Hold the centre of the axle shaft in the vice as
shown in Fig.7 and clean the shaft thoroughly,
using cleaning solvent.
Important : Do not damage the sealing surface
of outer housing.
Fig.7
Fig.8
Fig. 9
9
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DRIVESHAFT
Fig. 10
Fig. 11
Fig. 12
10
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DRIVESHAFT
DRIVE
SHAFT
11
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DRIVESHAFT
Fig. 14
Fig. 15
Fig. 16
12
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DRIVESHAFT
2.6 mm
Fig. 17
Fig. 18
Fig. 19
13
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DRIVESHAFT
DISASSEMBLY PROCEDURE :
1. Clean the shaft thoroughly using cleaning sol-
vent and hold the shaft at the middle of the axle
shaft in the vice as shown in Fig.20
Fig. 20
Fig. 21
Fig. 22
14
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DRIVESHAFT
Fig. 23
Fig. 24
Fig. 25
15
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DRIVESHAFT
Fig. 26
DRIVE
SHAFT
16
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DRIVESHAFT
ASSEMBLY PROCEDURE :
1. Put a light coat of grease from service kit on the
ball grooves of the inner race and the outer race.
2. Hold the inner race 900 to the centreline of the
cage with the lands of the inner race aligned with
the windows of cage as shown in Fig. 27.
Insert the inner race into the cage.
Fig. 27
Fig. 28
Fig. 29
17
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DRIVESHAFT
Fig. 30
Fig. 31
18
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DRIVESHAFT
2.6 mm
Fig. 32
Fig. 33
Fig. 34
19
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DRIVESHAFT
CV JOINT SPIDER
RETAINER RING ASSEMBLY
BALL TRIPOT OUTER
CV BOOT SEAL
HOUSING
AXLE SHAFT
RUBBER
DAMPER
C.V. DEFLECTOR
RING LARGE SEAL TRIPOT TRIPOT
RETAINING CLAMP SMALL SEAL SEAL RETAINER RETAINER
(CV SIDE) RETAINING RING RING
CLAMP
DRIVE
SHAFT ‘A’ = 418 +50
LARGE SEAL
RETAINING
CLAMP
20
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DRIVESHAFT
DRIVESHAFT HANDLING :
Half shafts must be stored in their original shipping containers or Delphi approved fixtures until assembled into
vehicle. It is important to take all precautions to avoid stacking halfshafts on top of each other. The seals and
deflecting rings are extremely delicate and any cut, nick, or abrasion may reduce the performance of the driveshaft.
21
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DRIVESHAFT
22
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DRIVESHAFT
SYMPTOMS DIAGNOSIS
DRIVE
SHAFT
Noise accompanied by vibration of the brake pedal A. Vibration could be from the calipers and
& not from the drive shaft.
B. If there is NO vibration on the pedal, the
noise could be from the drive shaft.
23
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION
LEi & LSi
LX & LXi
NEXT
GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
i
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
CONTENTS
I) FRONT SUSPENSION :
1) Tightening Torques 1
2) List of Special Tools 1
3) Exploded Views 2
4) Removal & Installation of Anti-roll bar 6
5) a) Removal & Installation of strut assembly 7
b) Disassembly & Assembly of strut 8
6) a) Removal & Installation of wheel hub 10
b) Sub-assembly of knuckle/Hub 13
7) a) Removal & Installation of lower link assembly 14
b) Removal & Fitment of Rubber bushes 14
8) Procedure for checking the ball joint play on front suspension lower arm ball joints 15 SUSPENSION
iii
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
FRONT SUSPENSION (LEi & LSi - 75 PS)
SUSPENSION
LIST OF SPECIAL TOOLS
1. Rest pad for removing inner race of bearing from hub. 2702 5890 2612
2. Holder for hub assembly. 2702 5890 3301
3. Puller for pulling out the front hub. 2702 5890 3302
4. Clamp for removing inner race for hub. 2779 5890 3303
5. Striker for pulling out the hub. 2702 5890 3304
6. Drift for installing the brg. in knuckle. 2779 5890 3301
7. Puller for removing ball joint. 2702 5890 4602
8. Spring compression tool. 2702 5890 3202
9. Dolly for fitting front rubber bush in lower link. 2702 5890 0107
10. Puller for removing inner race from hub. 2654 5890 3508
11. Offset spanner. 2702 5890 3201
12. Puller for knuckle bearing 2779 5890 3302
13. Drift for fitting knuckle assembly on hub 2576 5890 4401
14. Handle for drift 2640 5890 3511
1
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
8.0
4.5 8.0
2
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ASSY. LOWER LINK
8.0
INDEX
®
8.0
4.6 8.0
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
GROUP INDEX
1.2
NEXT
2 LOWER LINK,FRONT 8 HEX NUT M10 IS1364P3-8-SS8451-8C
3 ASSY.PIVOT BUSH (INNER) 9 WASHER
10 MOUNTING PIN
PREVIOUS
4 ASSY. RUBBER BUSH (REAR)
5 ASSY. CLAMP (LOWER LINK REAR MTG. BKT.) 11 SPRING WASHER B14 IS3063 SS8451-8C ® -Non Reusable Part
6 ASSY. LOWER BALL JOINT 12 HEX NUT M14X1.5 IS13722-8-SS8451-8C
13 HEX FL SCREW M12
- Specified Torque in Kgm
3
SUSPENSION
SUSPENSION
4
FRONT ANTI ROOL BAR MOUNTING
8.0
INDEX
®
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
4.5
GROUP INDEX
®
NEXT
10 CLAMP
® -Non Reusable Part 5 RUBBER BUSH (ANTIROLL BAR MTG) 11 SPECIAL HEX.FL.SCREW
- Specified Torque in Kgm 6 CUP (FRONT ANTIROLL BAR) 12 WASHER A10.5
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
FRONT AXLE
SUSPENSION
Fig. 15
5
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF ANTI ROLL
BAR
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery terminals.
2. Apply parking brake and place wheel chokes at rear
3. Remove anti roll bar nuts, washers and rubber
cushions Fig.1
4. Remove anti roll bar mounting brackets Fig.2
5. Remove anti roll bar.
Fig. 1
INSTALLATION Fig. 3
1. For Installation proceed in reverse order of removal
1a. Apply silicon grease molycoate - 33 (medium) on
SUSPENSION antiroll bar over bearing width before fitment.
2. Assemble antiroll bar components but do not
tighten. Centralise anti-roll bar as shown in fig. 3.
Ensure the crank position is on the bottom side.
Fig. 2
CRANK
Fig. 3
6
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
3. Tighten rubber cushion bolt assembly on lower link,
maintaining bolt projection above the nyloc nut 9 +1mm
between 9-10 mm Fig. 4. ANTI ROLL BAR
Fig. 4
Fig. 5
Fig. 6
7
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
6. Open the engine bonnet, unscrew and remove nuts
of upper support using offset spanner
2702 5890 32 01. Fig. 7
7. Keep relays mounting bracket on LH side and
auxilliary tank bracket on its position.
8. Remove strut assembly from bottom.
INSTALLATION
1. Install strut assembly in reverse order of removal.
2. Fit bolts & nuts only as shown in Fig. 8.
NOTE :
First tighten top mounting bolt no.1 and then the bottom OFFSET SPANNER
DOWEL PIN PART NO. 2702 5890 3201
mounting bolt no. 2.
3. Tighten all bolts and nuts to specified torque. Fig. 7
4. Apply ADH thread locker wicking grade ANABOND
124 at nut end & bolt thread. Ensure that the threads
are free from oil/grease. FRONT OF VEHICLE
CAUTION :
SUSPENSION
1. Ensure that brake hose does not twist during
installation.
TOP ECCENTRIC BOLT
2. Strut colour having the same colour code mark
on the spring should be assembled on the left
hand and right hand side.
DIS-ASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY OF STRUT BOTTOM BOLT
DIS-ASSEMBLY :
1. Compress the spring with spring compression
tool part No. 2702 5890 3202 until the spring
tension is released (i. e. becomes free in its Fig. 8
seating place). Unscrew nut (1) and dismantle the
parts Fig.9.
Hold top stopper by spanner (A/F 60 mm) to stop
piston rotation during loosening of nut.
À
Fig. 9
8
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
ASSEMBLY (Fig. 11) :
Check the condition of the components and replace
if necessary. It is recommended that all the rubber
components should be replaced during the
overhauling.
1. Compress the spring with spring compression tool
part No. 2702 5890 3202 to reduce length as done
during dis-assembly as shown in Fig. 10.
Fig. 10
SUSPENSION
Fig. 11
9
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
2. Insert the compressed spring on the strut (ensure
that the spring end is located in the lower seat of
strut). Fig 12
3. Pull strut rod up as far as possible. SPRING SEAT SPRING SEAT
4. Insert bump stopper. LOWER UPPER
Fig. 14
10
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
5. Unscrew and remove tie rod ball joint nut Fig. 16.
5a. Remove tie rod ball joint using puller part no.
2702 5890 4602 Fig.17.
6. Support the lower link from bottom.
7. Hold hub assembly with holder part No
2702 5890 3301 Fig. 18.
8. Unstake and unscrew drive shaft nut and take
out the thrust washer.
9. Remove holder from the hub assembly.
10. Unscrew the calliper mounting bolts and remove
the calliper assembly alongwith the brake hose (Do
not disconnect the brake hose).
11. Unscrew the disc screws and remove the disc Fig. 17
Fig. 19
SUSPENSION
Fig. 18
Fig. 16 Fig. 19
11
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
12. Pull out the hub with the help of puller part No.
2702 5890 3302 and striker part No. 2702 5890 3304.
Fig. 20
13. Remove puller from the hub.
14. Remove strut mounting bottom bolts from the
knuckle assembly by supporting the drive shaft.
Fig. 21
15. Remove bottom ball joint from lower arm.
16. Remove knuckle.
16a. Remove the drive shaft. (if required).
17. Using clamp part No. 2702 5890 3303, puller part
No 2654 5890 3508 and rest part No. 2702 5890 2612
remove inner race of bearing from the hub Fig. 22.
Fig. 21
18. Remove circlip from knuckle Fig. 23.
19. Pull out knuckle bearing using puller part No.
2702 5890 3306. Fig. 24
SUSPENSION
PULLER
PART NO. 2654 5890 3508
REST PAD
PART NO. 2654 5890 2612
CLAMP
PART NO. 2654 5890 3303
Fig. 22
Fig. 20 Fig. 23
12
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
INSTALLATION :
Note :
High / Low point matching on Hub & Disc
Observe the condition of disc surface. If the disc surface is
smooth ensure that punch mark (Low Point) on disc and
hub (High Point) are aligned and assembled.
If the disc surface is uneven showing rough marks, grooves
- machine it to the specified limit, measure the run out on
dia 220 w.r.t. hub and disc resting face.
Punch mark around bolt hole where runout on dia 220 is
at low point.
While assembly align low point on disc and high
point on hub. Assemble with countersunk screws.
Fig. 24
1. Proceed in reverse order of removal.
2. Tighten drive shaft nut 26 +2 mkg torque and lock by
staking. Fig. 25
3. Ensure that oil seal in trans axle is not damaged while
fitting drive shaft. SUSPENSION
Fig. 26
13
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF LOWER
LINK ASSEMBLY
(Front wheel, Knuckle assembly and anti-roll bar already
removed)
1. Unscrew rear mounting bracket bolt and remove
the bracket Fig. 27.
1a. Unscrew nut connecting lower link pin and the tie
member and remove tie member.
2. Unscrew 3 bolts on lower link front bracket spindle
Fig. 28.
3. Unscrew mounting screws of the rear rubber bush
clamp.
4. Remove lower link assembly along with rear
mounting rubber bush and front bracket Fig. 29.
INSTALLATION
1. Proceed in the reverse order of removal. Fig. 28
2. Replace rubber bushes, worn damage parts.
3. Tighten the rear mounting bracket bolt to 8 mkg
torque.
4. Insert the tie member and tighten the nuts. Ensure
that the tie member offset is away from the transaxle
SUSPENSION flange i.e towards front of the vehicle (Fig. 28a).
5. Ensure that heat shield is assembled properly on
ball joint.
REMOVAL AND FITMENT OF RUBBER
BUSHES
1. Remove front bracket and bush from the lower link.
2. Remove rear rubber bush from Lower link.
3. Fit front rubber bush of lower link using dolly part
No. 2702 5890 0107. Apply soap water to bush,
inside surface of tool and bore of assembly lower
link before fitment.
4. Fit Rubber bush on the rear spindle of the Lower
link. Fig. 28a
DOLLY
PART. NO.
2702 5890 0107
RUBBER BUSH
LOWER LINK
Fig. 27 Fig. 29
14
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
PROCEDURE FOR CHECKING THE BALL JOINT PLAY
ON FRONT SUSPENSION LOWER ARM BALL JOINTS
It is recommended that the axial play on the ball joints
should be checked as per the procedure given below
before removal of the ball joints.
Note : Please check tightening torque of all nut & bolts on
the ball joint mounting bracket and ball pin nut before
checking the ball joint play.
The front lower arm ball joints play should be checked at
every 10,000 kms as per the procedure given below.
Procedure :
a) Apply the parking brakes and remove front wheel
by jacking up the car with the help of a floor jack or
by lifting it on a two pole hoist Fig. 29a
b) Mount the dial gauge with magnetic stand on the
brake disc as shown in Fig. 29a
Important : Note that the Dial Indicator plunger axis
should be perpendicular to the ball joint bottom face for
the correct reading. SUSPENSION
Fig. 29b
15
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
REAR SUSPENSION (LEi & LSi - 75 PS)
REPAIRS/ADJUSTMENT DATA
1. Hub bearing axial play 0.01-0.03 mm
2. Axial play adjusting shim thickness 0.05, 0.10, 0.15, 0.20, 0.25, 0.30,
available in steps of 0.4,0.5 & 1.0 mm
LUBRICANTS
1. Hub grease specifications Grease - Lithium IPOL IPLEXLC Grease-2
2. Quantity of grease (both hubs) 110 gms.
16
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
LIST OF SPECIAL TOOLS
1. Drift for installing inner race of outer brg. 2702 5890 2602
2. Spring compressor 2702 5890 3202
3. Holder for taking out the hub assembly from spindle. 2702 5890 3301
4. Puller for taking out the hub assembly from spindle. 2702 5890 3501
5. Puller for removing outer race of inner taper roller bearing. 2702 5890 3502
6. Puller for removing outer race of outer tapper roller brg. 2702 5890 3503
7. Drift for installing outer race of inner taper roller brg. 2702 5890 3504
8. Drift for fitting oil seal. 2702 5890 3505
9. Dolly for fitting rubber bush (inner) 2702 5890 0108
10. Dolly for fitting rubber bush (outer) 2702 5890 0109
11. Drift for installing outer race of outer taper roller brg 2651 5890 4602
SUSPENSION
17
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION
18
③ -Non Reusable Part
REAR SUSPENSION
- Specified Torque in Kgm
4.5
③
8.0
4.5
INDEX
③
③
③
8.0
③
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
8.0
8.0
③ ③
③
GROUP INDEX
③
SR. PART DESCRIPTION
NO.
6.0
1 ASSY.SEMI TRAILING ARM WITH BUSHES
2 ASSY. SEMI TRILING ARM- (WITH ABS)
2 ASSY.SEMI TRAILING ARM - LH/RH
3 SPINDLE
4 SPACER (FOR OIL SEAL) 12 REAR SPRING (SHOCK ABSORBER TOP MOUNTING)
5 ASSY.PIVOT BUSH (INNER) 13 DUST COVER (REAR SHOCK ABSORBER) 20 LOCK WASHER
6 ASSY PIVOT BUSH (SEMITRAILING ARM) 14 REAR BUMP STOPPER 21 NYLOC NUT M10
7 ASSY.INNER BRACKET- SEMI TRAILING ARM (POLYURETHANE) / (POLYURETHANE FOAM) 22 HEX FL NUT AM10
8 ASSY.OUTER BRACKET SEMI TRAILING ARM 15 ASSY.BUMP STOPPER CUP 23 RUBBER COVER (REAR SHOCK ABSORBER)
NEXT
9 HEX FLANGE BOLT M12x1.25x33 16 SPRING TOP RUBBER 24 HEX FL BOLT M10X70
10 ASSY REAR S/A COMP 17 BOTTOM RUBBER(SHOCK ABSORBER TOP MTG.) 25 NYLOC NUT M10
11 ASSY REAR SHOCK ABSORBER 18 ASSY.STRUT MOUNTING BRACKET_TOP 26 HEX BOLT M12 X 1.5 X 90
PREVIOUS
12 SPRING REAR SUSPENSION 19 TOP RUBBER 27 NYLOC NUT M12 X 1.5
ASSEMBLY REAR HUB
® -Non Reusable Part
- Specified Torque in Kgm
INDEX
® ®
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
4.5
®
10-12 ®
GROUP INDEX
4.5
NEXT
2 HUB CUM BRAKE DRUM (REAR) (180 DIA.) 6 SHIM (0.25 THK) 9 THIN CASTLE NUT M16X1.5
3 TAPER ROLLER BEARING-OUTER 6 SHIM (0.20 THK) 10 SPLIT PIN 4X32 IS549 SS8451-8C
4 OUTER BEARING 6 SHIM (0.15 THK) 11 HUB COVER
5 SPACER TUBE (BETWEEN BRGS OF REAR HUB) 6 SHIM (0.100 THK) 12 SPACER PLATE
PREVIOUS
6 SHIM (1.00 THK) 6 SHIM (0.05 THK) 13 HEX SCREW M10X28
6 SHIM (0.50 THK) 7 DOUBLE-LIP OIL SEAL 14 SPRING WASHER B10
6 SHIM (0.40 THK) 8 THRUST WASHER 15 HEX NUT M10
19
SUSPENSION
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
REMOVAL OF REAR HUB
1. Place wheel chokes at front wheels.
2. Loosen rear wheel mounting bolts Fig. 30.
3. Jack up the car.
4. Support the trailing arm and remove the wheel.
5. Take out hub cap.
6. Remove split pin on the castle nut.
7. Unscrew castle nut and take out thrust washer
Fig. 31.
8. Mount puller part No. 2702 5890 3501 over the
holder part No. 2702 5890 3301 on the hub and
take out the hub assembly from the spindle
Fig. 32. Fig. 31
Fig. 32
Fig. 30 Fig. 33
20
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
REAR HUB-DISMANTLING AND ASSEMBLY
DISMANTLING
1. Pry out rear oil seal.
2. Take out inner race of inner taper roller bearing.
3. Remove spacer tube along with the shims.
4. Remove inner taper roller bearing outer race, using
puller part No. 2702 5890 3502 Fig. 34.
5. Remove outer race of outer taper roller bearing using
puller part No. 2702 5890 3503 Fig. 35.
6. Remove old grease completely from hub bearing
etc.
SUSPENSION
REMOVAL OF INNER BEARING OUTER RACE REMOVAL OF OUTER BEARING OUTER RACE
Fig. 34 Fig. 35
21
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
INSPECTION
1. Check the taper roller bearings and the bearing
seating in the hub and check the spindle.
2. Check the contact surface for the radial seal on
the spacer.
3. Check the trust washer if necessary replace it.
4. Generally bearing can be reused if the running
surface and rollers show no visible damage or
wear. For perfect judgement bearings should be
cleaned in gasoline or trichloro-ethylene until all
contamination’s are washed out of bearings.
Bearing does not bind when rotated manually if
it is free of any contamination. For judging silent
running of bearings apply few drops of engine
oil to clean bearing and rotate. Fig. 36
Fig. 37a
22
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
2
10
Fig. 38
ASSEMBLY OF REAR HUB ON STUB AXLE SPINDLE may result in loss of lubricating power. Insufficient
Fig. 38. grease may prevent perfect lubrication of
bearings.
1. If removed, fit anchor plate assembly, connect
Parking brake cable, connect hoses. 5. Insert a shim of 1.5 mm thickness over the spacer
tube. For shim selection see page no. 20.
2. Fit hub assembly on the spindle. Make sure that
oil seal lip is not getting damaged during 6. Pack roller cage of outer bearing race with
assembly. recommended wheel bearing grease. Grease
quantity 5gm.
3. Assemble the spacer tube on the spindle.
4. Fill the space between two taper roller bearings
with 20 gm quantity of recommended grease.
Note : Recommended wheel bearing grease and
its quantity must be maintained. If grease in
excess, excessive heat can be generated and
23
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
7. Install inner race of outer bearing using drift part No.
2702 5890 26 02 Fig. 39 & 40
8. Install thrust washer.
9. Screw in castle nut and tighten to 10 to 12 kg-m
torque Fig. 41 When tightening the castle nut,
turn the rear hub constantly in either direction
and tap with a soft hammer to ensure correct
seating of bearings.
10. Pull/Push the hub for checking bearing play. Turn
the hub several times prior to any measurement
of play. Fit the dial gauge on the hub using
magnetic stand. The dial should have a pretension
of about 2 mm. Measure the hub play on the dial
gauge stem on the spindle Fig. 41a
The recommended hub play is between 0.01 - Fig. 40
0.06 mm. To achieve this hub play, shim may be
added or removed. For increasing the hub play
shims to be added and for reducing the hub play
shims may be removed. Before checking bearing
play ensure that the parking brake lever is in
SUSPENSION
released condition.
Fig. 41
24
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
PROCEDURE FOR SELECTION OF SHIM THICKNESS :
For example, if the measured hub play with 1.5 mm
shim as selected earlier (ref. point 5 as above) is 0.5
mm. Then correct size of shim for maintaining hub
play of 0.03 mm will be as follows-
1.5 mm shim (as selected earlier)
-0.5 mm (play observed)
+0.03 (required hub play)
=1.03 mm (Correct shim thickness required
instead of 1.5 mm shim thickness as
selected earlier)
11. Insert the new spilt pin in the castle nut and lock
the nut by bending the split pin. In case the spilt
pin hole in the spindle does not align with the
hole in the castle nut loosen / tighten castle nut
just enough so that spilt pin can be inserted.
Check the hub play once again it should be within
0.01 to 0.06 mm.
12. Fill the hub cap with recommended grease. SUSPENSION
Grease quantity 25 gm and fit the cap. While
fitting the hub cap, hammer lightly at several
locations on the collar of cap until collar comes
closely into contact with hub.
13. Fit the wheel and tighten the wheel mounting
bolts to recommended torque.
25
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
REMOVAL OF SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY
1. Place wheel chokes at front wheels.
2. Loosen rear wheel mounting bolts.
3. Jack up the car, allowing rear suspension to hang
freely.
4. Support the trailing arm.
5. Unscrew wheel mounting bolts and remove the
wheel.
6. Unscrew and remove bottom mounting bolt of
shock absorber Fig. 42.
7. Unscrew upper mounting flange nuts of the
shock absorber (which are accessible from
luggage compartment) and remove shock Fig. 42
absorber assembly Fig. 43.
INSTALLATION OF SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY
1. Proceed in reverse order of removal.
2. Tighten upper mounting flange nut to 4.5 kg-m
SUSPENSION
torque.
3. Tighten bottom mounting bolt to 6 kg-m torque.
Fig. 44
26
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
ASSEMBLY : Fig. 46
Check the condition of the components and replace
if necessary. It is recommended that all the rubber
components be replaced during the overhauling.
1. Compress the spring with spring compression tool
part No. 2702 5890 3202 to release length as done
during dis-assembly. Fig. 45
Insert the compressed spring on the Shock absorber
(ensure that the spring end is located in the spring
cup bottom of Shock absorber)
3. Pull shock absorber rod up as far as possible.
4. Insert rear bump stopper.
5. Fit dust cover on assembly bump stopper cup.
Fig. 45
1
5
SUSPENSION
4
3
1. LOCK WASHER
2. ASSEMBLY BUMP STOPPER CUP
2 6
3. ASSEMBLY STRUT TOP BRACKET
4. BOTTOM RUBBER (SHOCK ABSORBER MOUNTING)
9 5. TOP RUBBER (SHOCK ABSORBER MOUNTING)
6. RUBBER SEAT
7 7. OUTER COIL SPRING
8. BUMP STOPPER
9. DUST COVER
8
Fig. 46
27
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
6. Install assembly bump stopper cup along with dust
cover over the rear bump stopper.
7. Fit spring rubber seat on the spring properly locating
it with spring end.
8. Install bottom rubber and shock absorber mounting
bracket top.
9. Fit assembly sub mounting bracket.
10. Fit top rubber.
11. Insert lock washer over the Shock absorber rod.
12. Tighten nyloc nut to 4-4.5 mkg torque. Fig. 47
13. Remove spring compressing tool carefully.
DIS-ASSEMBLY/ASSEMBLY OF TRAILING
ARM (HUB REMOVED) Fig. 47
DIS-ASSEMBLY
1. Unscrew nyloc nut from front and rear mounting
pins Fig. 48 & 49.
2. Remove mounting pins and take out the arm
SUSPENSION assembly from the brackets.
3. Remove the rubber bushes from the trailing arm
Fig. 50.
ASSEMBLY
Fig. 48
1. Fit rubber bushes in trailing arm by using dolly
part No. 2702 5890 0108 (for inner bush) and
2702 5890 0109 (for outer bush).
2. Locate the trailing arm on the brackets and fit
the pins.
3. Tighten nyloc nut both front and rear to 8 mkg Fig. 49
torque.
DOLLY
PART. NO.
2702 5890 0108 /
2702 5890 0109
RUBBER BUSH
TRAILING ARM
Fig. 50
28
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LEi & LSi
INSPECTION OF SHOCK ABSORBER / STRUT Checks to be carried out after removal of
ON THE CAR shockabsorber & strut.
Noise due to loose brake hose 1. Look for signs for breakage such as piston rod
bent or heavy dents on the body. These are
1. Ensure that the brake hose is tightened fully, results of accident or abuse of suspension parts.
loose brake hose will give noise.
2. Discoloration & light scratch marks on working
Noise due to fouling parts : area of piston rod is normal and doesnot need
1. Ensure that the Strut components are not fouling replacement, unless leakage is noticed &
with any other parts near by. confirmed.
2. Ensure that the spring end is sitting securely on 3. Look for signs of suspected oil leakage such as
the spring seat at the correct place Fig. 51. oil patches or wet mud cakes on the damper
body. The presence of oil patch or mud cake can
3. Ensure the correct torque on the two bolts is also be result of oily sprayfrom road or
correct : 8 kgf-m of the strut mounting at the accidental spillage of oil during servicing.
bottom bracket. It may be noisy if there is any
play in the bolts. 4. Examine damper area near the seal. Presence of
oil here is sign of oil leakage.
INDICA rear suspension
SUSPENSION
1. Ensure that the torque for shock absorber lower
mounting bolt is correct : 8 mkg. if loose, there will
be a distinct noise. Ensure that the strut components
are not fouling with any other parts nearby any
fouling part is bound to give a noise.
LUG
LUG
Fig. 51
29
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION (LX & LXi)
INTRODUCTION :
The front and Rear suspension of Indica are Independent
SUSPENSION
type Suspension i. e. each wheel is a separately suspended
unit connected to body in such a way that the rise and fall
of one wheel does not affect the other wheel directly.
This helps each wheel to maintain a level position
regardless of influences on the other wheel.
The Front suspension is Mc pherson strut type and the
Rear suspension is of Independent semi-trailing arm type
with hydraulic shock absorber and coil spring mounted
co-axially.
i
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION (LX & LXi)
CONTENTS
Sr. No. Description Page No.
iii
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LX & LXi
TIGHTENING TORQUE
Fasteners Torque in Kg-m
1. Strut assembly upper mounting nuts 2.3
2. Strut mounting bolts on knuckle 8
3. Knuckle bottom ball joint clamping flange bolt 5.5
4. Drive shaft nut 26 +3
5. Lower link mounting on body hex bolt 8
6. Clamp hex screw on antiroll bar 4.5
7. Lower link front mounting pin & tie member clamping nut 12
8. Strut top nut 4 to 6
9. Ball joint to lower link 4.6
1. Reset pad removing inner race of bearing from hub 2702 5890 2612
3. Puller for pulling out the front hub 2702 5890 3302
4. Clamp for removing inner race for hub 2779 5890 3303
10. Dolly for fitting front rubber bush in lower link 2702 5890 0107
11. Puller for removing inner race from hub 2654 5890 3508
1
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LX & LXi
8.0 4.6 ®
5.5
8.0 8.0
®
8.0
12.0
2
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ANTI ROLL BAR MOUNTING
INDEX
®
4.5
SUSPENSION LX & LXi
8.0
GROUP INDEX
®
SR. PART DESCRIPTION
® NO.
1 ANTI ROLL BAR (FRONT SUSPENSION)
4.6 2 BALL JOINT ASSY,FRONT ARB
3 ASSY RUBBER MOUNTING.
4 CUP (FRONT ANTIROLL BAR)
NEXT
5 RUBBER BUSH (ANTIROLL BAR MTG)
6 CUP (FRONT ANTIROLL BAR)
7 NYLOC NUT M12X1.5
PREVIOUS
- Specified Torque in Kgm 8 NYLOC NUT M10
9 BEARING BLOCK (ANTI ROLL BAR-28 DIA.)
10 CLAMP (ANTIROLL BAR MTG BRACKET)
® - Non Reusable Part 11 SPECIAL HEX.FL.SCREW
3
SUSPENSION
SUSPENSION LX & LXi
FRONT SUSPENSION
SUSPENSION
4
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LX & LXi
INSTALLATION : (Fig. 2)
1. For installation proceed in reverse order of
removal.
2. Apply silicon grease molycoate - 33 (medium) SUSPENSION
on antiroll bar over bearing width before fitment.
3. Assemble antiroll bar components but do not
tighten. Ensure the crank is on the bottom side.
Align paint mark with bush face to centralise ARB
as shown in (Fig. 2).
Fig. 2
NYLOC NUT 6 to 7 mm
Fig. 3
5
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LX & LXi
Fig. 4
Fig. 5
OFFSET SPANNER
PART NO. 2702 5890 3201
Fig. 6
6
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LX & LXi
INSTALLATION :
1. Install strut assembly in reverse order of removal. APPLY THREAD LOCKER FRONT OF VEHICLE
ANABOND - 124
2. Fit bolts and nuts only as shown in Fig. 7.
NOTE :
First tighten top eccentric bolt and then the bottom TOP ECCENTRIC
mounting bolt. BOLT
3. Tighten all bolts and nuts to specified torque.
4. Apply ADH thread locker wicking grade
ANABOND 124 at nut end & bolt thread. Ensure BOTTOM
that the threads are free from oil/grease. BOLT
CAUTION :
1. Ensure that brake hose does not twist during
installation. Fig. 7
7
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LX & LXi
15 14 13 12
11
10
Fig. 9
ASSEMBLY (Fig. 9) :
Check the condition of the components and replace if
necessary.
1. Compress the spring with spring compression
tool part No. 2702 5890 3202 to reduce length
as done during dis-assembly as shown in
Fig. 10.
Fig. 10
8
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LX & LXi
Fig. 11
9. Fit spacer.
10. Fit top stopper
11. Fit spring washer and tighten hex nut to 4 to 6
kg.m torque. Set axial clearance for front struts SUSPENSION
0.05 to 0.1mm by selecting proper shims. Use
60 A/F spanner to hold top stopper during
tightening of nut (Fig. 12).
Note : The top cap should be free to rotate after
assembly. The maximum torque to rotate the cap
should not exceed 0.5 kgcm.
12. Remove spring compressing special tool carefully.
Note :
It is a good practice to replace bump stopper at every
30000 km / 18750 miles. Fig. 12
9
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LX & LXi
FRONT HUB
26.0
SUSPENSION
® ®
INTERNAL CIRCLIP
Fig. 13
10
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LX & LXi
Fig. 14
SUSPENSION
Fig. 15
Fig. 16
11
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LX & LXi
Fig. 17
Fig. 18
Fig. 19
12
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LX & LXi
20. Using clamp part No. 2779 5890 3303 puller part
No. 2654 5890 3508 and rest part No. 2702 5890
2612 remove inner race of bearing from the hub
(Fig. 20).
PULLER
REST PAD
CLAMP
Fig. 20
Fig. 21
INSTALLATION :
1. Proceed in reverse order of removal.
Note :High / Low point matching on Hub & Disc
Observe the condition of disc surface. If the disc surface
is smooth ensure that punch mark (Low Point) on disc
and hub (High Point) are aligned and assembled.
If the disc surface is uneven showing rough marks,
grooves - machine it to the specified limit, measure
the run out on dia 220 w.r.t. hub and disc resting face.
Punch mark around bolt hole where runout on dia
220 is at low point.
While assembly align low point on disc and high
point on hub. Assemble with dowel.
Fig. 22
13
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LX & LXi
PRECAUTION :
Use a new hub bearing and new circlip, oil the
Fig. 23
bearing housing in knuckle carrier and hub itself.
Old bearing, even if serviceable can not be
reused.
SUB ASSEMBLY - KNUCKLE / HUB :
Clean all the parts thoroughly and replace damage /
SUSPENSION
worn out parts.
1. With the help of drift part No. 2779 5890 3301
and 2640 5890 3511 fit bearing in the knuckle
(Fig. 24)
2. Fit circlip
3. Place the knuckle assembly over the hub. Using
drift part No. 2576 5890 4401 press the knuckle
assembly on the hub.
REMOVA L AND INSTALLATION OF
LOWER LINK ASSEMBLY : Fig. 24
1. Remove front wheel & disconnect anti roll bar at
lower link end.
2. Unscrew nut connecting lower link ballpin and
knuckle.
3. Unscrew rear mounting bracket bolt and remove
the bracket (Fig. 25).
4. Unscrew nut connecting lower link pin and the
tie member and remove tie-member.
5. Unscrew 3 bolts on lower link front bracket spindle
(Fig. 26).
5a. Unscrew mounting bolt of rear bush clamp.
Fig. 25
14
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LX & LXi
Fig. 26
Fig. 27
40
15
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LX & LXi
PRESS
SUSPENSION
PIVOT BUSH
Fig. 28a
16
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION LX & LXi
Fig. 29b
17
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION (LX & LXi)
LUBRICANTS SPECIFICATIONS
1. Hub grease specifications Grease Lithium IPOL IPLEXLC Grease-2
2. Quantity of grease (both hubs) 110 gms.
18
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION (LX & LXi)
1. Drift for installing inner race of outer brg. 2702 5890 2602
2. Spring compressor 2702 5890 3202
3. Holder for taking out the hub assembly from spindle. 2702 5890 3301
4. Puller for taking out the hub assembly from spindle. 2702 5890 3501
5. Puller for removing outer race of inner taper roller bearing. 2702 5890 3502
6. Puller for removing outer race of outer tapper roller brg. 2702 5890 3503
7. Drift for installing outer race of inner taper roller brg. 2702 5890 3504
8. Drift for fitting oil seal. 2702 5890 3505
9. Dolly for fitting rubber bush (inner) 2702 5890 0108
10. Dolly for fitting rubber bush (outer) 2702 5890 0109
11. Drift for installing outer race of outer taper roller brg 2651 5890 4602
SUSPENSION
19
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION
20
® -Non Reusable Part
REAR SUSPENSION
- Specified Torque in Kgm
4.5
®
8.0
4.5
INDEX
®
®
®
8.0
®
8.0
8.0
SUSPENSION (LX & LXi)
® ®
®
GROUP INDEX
®
SR. PART DESCRIPTION
NO.
6.0
1 ASSY.SEMI TRAILING ARM WITH BUSHES
2 ASSY. SEMI TRILING ARM- (WITH ABS)
2 ASSY.SEMI TRAILING ARM - LH/RH
3 SPINDLE
4 SPACER (FOR OIL SEAL) 12 REAR SPRING (SHOCK ABSORBER TOP MOUNTING)
5 ASSY.PIVOT BUSH (INNER) 13 DUST COVER (REAR SHOCK ABSORBER) 20 LOCK WASHER
6 ASSY PIVOT BUSH (SEMITRAILING ARM) 14 REAR BUMP STOPPER 21 NYLOC NUT M10
7 ASSY.INNER BRACKET- SEMI TRAILING ARM (POLYURETHANE) / (POLYURETHANE FOAM) 22 HEX FL NUT AM10
8 ASSY.OUTER BRACKET SEMI TRAILING ARM 15 ASSY.BUMP STOPPER CUP 23 RUBBER COVER (REAR SHOCK ABSORBER)
NEXT
9 HEX FLANGE BOLT M12x1.25x33 16 SPRING TOP RUBBER 24 HEX FL BOLT M10X70
10 ASSY REAR S/A COMP 17 BOTTOM RUBBER(SHOCK ABSORBER TOP MTG.) 25 NYLOC NUT M10
11 ASSY REAR SHOCK ABSORBER 18 ASSY.STRUT MOUNTING BRACKET_TOP 26 HEX BOLT M12 X 1.5 X 90
PREVIOUS
12 SPRING REAR SUSPENSION 19 TOP RUBBER 27 NYLOC NUT M12 X 1.5
ASSEMBLY REAR HUB ABS
® -Non Reusable Part
- Specified Torque in Kgm
INDEX
®
®
4.5
®
SUSPENSION (LX & LXi)
10-12
®
4.5
GROUP INDEX
4.5
NEXT
2 HUB CUM BRAKE DRUM (REAR)FOR ABS VERSION 6 SHIM (0.15 THK) 13 SPACER PLATE
3 TAPER ROLLER BEARING-OUTER 6 SHIM (0.100 THK) 14 ASSY. SENSOR MTG.PLATE & SENSOR LH/RH
4 OUTER BEARING 6 SHIM (0.05 THK) 15 HEX FL SCREW M6X12
PREVIOUS
5 SPACER TUBE (BETWEEN BRGS OF REAR HUB) 7 DOUBLE-LIP OIL SEAL 16 HEX SCREW M10X28
6 SHIM (1.00 THK) 8 TONER RING -REAR ON REAR BRAKE DRUM 16 HEX SCREW M10X25
6 SHIM (0.50 THK) 9 THRUST WASHER 17 SPRING WASHER B10
6 SHIM (0.40 THK) 10 THIN CASTLE NUT M16X1.5 18 HEX NUT M10
21
SUSPENSION
SUSPENSION (LX & LXi)
Fig. 32
Fig. 30 Fig. 33
22
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION (LX & LXi)
SUSPENSION
REMOVAL OF INNER BEARING OUTER RACE REMOVAL OF OUTER BEARING OUTER RACE
Fig. 34 Fig. 35
23
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION (LX & LXi)
INSPECTION
1. Check the taper roller bearings and the bearing
seating in the hub and check the spindle.
2. Check the contact surface for the radial seal on
the spacer.
3. Check the trust washer if necessary replace it.
4. Generally bearing can be reused if the running
surface and rollers show no visible damage or
wear. For perfect judgement bearings should be
cleaned in gasoline or tricholro-ethylene until all
contaminations are washed out of bearings.
Bearing does not bind when rotated manually if
it is free of any contamination. For judging silent
running of bearings apply few drops of engine oil
to clean bearing and rotate. Fig. 36
SUSPENSION ASSEMBLY
Absolute cleanliness is required during bearing
assembly in order to avoid entry of dirt, dust and foreign
particle.
1. Clean hub, bearings, spacer tube, shims, thrust
washer, and spindle diameter with gasoline.
2. Fit inner taper roller bearing outer race, using
drift part No. 2702 5890 35 04.
3. Pack roller cage of inner bearing race with
recommended wheel bearing grease. Grease
quantity 5gm. Fig. 37a
4. Fit inner race of inner taper roller bearing.
5. Fit outer race of outer Taper roller bearing using
drift Pt. No. 2651 5890 46 02. Fig.36
6. Press new oil seal with drift part No. 2702 5890
35 05 fig.No.37a.Coat the contact surface of oil
seal lip with recommended grease. The oil seal
should be pressed in the hub such that the sealing
lip and the spring faces towards the bearing
Fig.37. Whenever bearings are removed/replaced
use new oil seal and new grease.
Fig. 37
24
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION (LX & LXi)
1
2
15 1. Assembly Brake Drum
3 2. Toner Ring
14 3. Inner Taper Roller Bearing
13 4. Spacer Tube
5. Outer Taper Roller Bearing
4 16 6. Shims
5 7. Castle Nut
11 8. Hub Cap
12 9. Split Pin
7 17
10. Thrust Washer
6
11. Spacer for Oil Seal
8
12. Oil Seal
9 13. Sensor Mounting Plate
14. Wheel Speed Sensor
15. Anchor Plate SUSPENSION
Fig.38.
ASSEMBLY OF REAR HUB ON SEMI-TRAILING 5. Insert a shim of suitable thickness (e.g.1.5 mm)
ARM SPINDLE Fig.38. over the spacer tube so that recommended axial
play is achieved. For shim selection see
1. If removed, fit anchor plate assembly, connect page no. 27.
Parking brake cable, connect brake pipe.
6. Pack roller cage of inner and outer bearing race
2. Fit hub assembly on the spindle. Make sure that with recommended wheel bearing grease. Grease
oil seal lip is not getting damaged during assembly. quantity 5gm.
3. Assemble the spacer tube on the spindle. 7. Fill the hub cap with 25gm of recommended wheel
4. Fill the space between two taper roller bearings bearing grease before fitment.
with 20 gm quantity of recommended grease. 8. Install inner race of outer bearing using drift part
Note: Recommended wheel bearing grease and its No. 2702 5890 26 02 Fig.No.39 & 40.
quantity must be maintained. If grease in excess,
9. Install thrust washer.
excessive heat can be generated and may result
in loss of lubricating power. Insufficient grease
may prevent perfect lubrication of bearings.
25
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION (LX & LXi)
10. Screw in castle nut and tighten to 10 to 12
kg-m torque Fig.No. 41 When tightening the
castle nut, turn the rear hub constantly in
either direction and tap with a soft hammer to
ensure to correct seating of bearings.
11. Pull/Push the hub for checking bearing play.Turn
the hub several times prior to any measurement
of play. Fit the dial guage on the hub using
magnetic stand. The dial should have a
pretension of about 2mm. Measure the hub play
on the dial guage stem on the spindle. Fig.41a.
The recommended hub play is between 0.01 -
0.06mm.To achieve this hub play, shim may be
added or removed. For increasing the hub play
shims to be added and for reducing the hub play
shims may be removed.Before checking bearing Fig. 40
play ensure that the parking brake lever is in
released condition.
12. Insert the new spilt pin in the castle nut and lock
the nut by bending the split pin. In case the spilt
pin hole in the spindle does not align with the
SUSPENSION hole in the castle nut loosen / tighten castle nut
just enough so that spilt pin can be inserted.
Check the hub play once again it should be within
0.01 to 0.06 mm.
13. Fill the hub cap with recommended grease.
Grease quantity 25 gm and fit the cap. While
fitting the hub cap, hammer lightly at several
locations on the collar of cap until collar comes
closely into contact with hub.
14. Fit the wheel and tighten the wheel mounting bolts
to recommended torque.
Fig. 41
26
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION (LX & LXi)
PROCEDURE FOR SELECTION OF SHIMS
THICKNESS :
For example, if the measured hub play with 1.5
mm shim as selected earlier (ref. point 5 as
above) is 0.5 mm. Then correct size of shim for
maintaining hub play of 0.03 mm will be as
follows-
1.5 mm shim (as selected earlier)
-0.5 mm (play observed)
+0.03 (required hub play)
=1.03 mm (Correct shim thickness required
instead of 1.5 mm shim thickness
as selected earlier)
Fig. 42
REMOVAL OF SHOCK ABSORBER
ASSEMBLY
1. Place wheel chokes at front wheels.
2. Loosen rear wheel mounting bolts.
3. Jack up the car, allowing the rear suspension to SUSPENSION
hang freely.
4. Support the trailing arm.
5. Unscrew wheel mounting bolts and remove the
wheel.
6. Unscrew and remove bottom mounting bolt of
shock absorber Fig. 42.
7. Unscrew upper mounting flange nuts of the shock
absorber (which are accessible from luggage
compartment) and remove shock absorber
assembly Fig. 43. Fig. 43
INSTALLATION OF SHOCK ABSORBER
ASSEMBLY
1. Proceed in reverse order of removal.
2. Tighten upper mounting flange nut to 4.5 kg-m
torque.
3. Tighten bottom mounting bolt to 6 kg-m torque.
DIS-ASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY OF
SHOCK ABSORBER
DIS-ASSEMBLY :-
1. Compress the spring with spring compression
tool part No. 2702 5890 3202 until the spring length
is reduced such that load on upper and lower
cups is released. Unscrew nut(1) and dismantle
the parts Fig. 44.
Fig. 44
27
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION (LX & LXi)
SUSPENSION
1
5
4
3
1. LOCK WASHER
2. ASSEMBLY BUMP STOPPER CUP
2 6
3. ASSEMBLY STRUT TOP BRACKET
4. BOTTOM RUBBER (SHOCK ABSORBER MOUNTING)
9 5. TOP RUBBER (SHOCK ABSORBER MOUNTING)
6. RUBBER SEAT
7 7. OUTER COIL SPRING
8. BUMP STOPPER
9. DUST COVER
8
Fig. 46
28
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION (LX & LXi)
LOCK WASHER
TOP RUBBER
BOTTOM RUBBER
DUST COVER
BUMP
STOPPER AXIS OF TOP
MOUNTING
PINS
OPEN COILS
AT TOP SIDE
SPRING
AXIS OF TOP
MOUNTING
PINS
SHOCK ABSORBER
ELEMENT
SPRING SEAT
Fig. 46a
29
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION (LX & LXi)
TRAILING ARM
ASSEMBLY PIVOT
BUSH
SLEEVE INNER
Fig. 49
30
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
SUSPENSION (LX & LXi)
Front Suspension 1. Look for signs for breakage such as piston rod
bent or heavy dents on the body. These are
Noise due to loose brake hose results of accident or abuse of suspension parts.
1. Ensure that the brake hose is tightened fully, 2. Discoloration & light scratch marks on working
loose brake hose will give noise. area of piston rod is normal and doesnot need
replacement, unless leakage is noticed &
Noise due to fouling parts :
confirmed.
1. Ensure that the Strut components are not fouling
3. Look for signs of suspected oil leakage such as
with any other parts near by.
oil patches or wet mud cakes on the damper
2. Ensure that the spring end is sitting securely on body. The presence of oil patch or mud cake
the spring seat at the correct place Fig. 50. can also be result of oily sprayfrom road or
accidental spillage of oil during servicing.
3. Ensure the correct torque on the two bolts is
correct : 8 kgf-m of the strut mounting at the 4. Examine damper area near the seal. Presence
bottom bracket. It may be noisy if there is any of oil here is sign of oil leakage.
play in the bolts.
SUSPENSION
Rear suspension
LUG
LUG
Fig. 50
31
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
LX & LXi
NEXT
GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
i
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
CONTENTS
1. Technical Specification 1
2. Tightening Torques 2
3. Exploded Views :
a) Servo and tmc assembly (9 inch, ø22.22) 3
b) Caliper Assembly C - 54 4
c) Rear brake assembly (HASF ø200x30) 5
d) Parking brake system 6
e) Hydraulic lines - Non ABS Version - RHD 7
3. How does your car’s brake work 8
4. Front Brakes : 9
a) Salient Features 9
b) Caliper Operation 10
c) Front Brake Service 11
[Removal / Inspection / Installation of Pads, Calipers & Disc]
5. Rear Brakes :
a) Working of Hydraulic auto adjust service brake 21 BRAKE
b) Rear Brake Service 23
[Removal / Inspection / installation of Drum,
brake shoes, Back Plate, & wheel cylinder]
6. Bleeding of Hydraulic system 30
7. Tandem Master Cylinder(for Non - ABS version) 33
8. Vacuum Booster 36
a) Working Principle 37
b) Servicing 38
c) Check list for ensuring satisfactory functioning of vacuum booster 40
d) Vacuum Leak Test 41
9. Pressure Conscious Regulating Valve (PCRV) 42
10. Parking Brake 43
[Removal, Installation & Adjustment]
11. Troubleshooting of Brake system 46
iii
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATION
1
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
TIGHTENING TORQUES :
13. Rear brake hose / pipe mounting to wheel cylinder 1.4 - 1.8
15. Brake pipe line / parking brake cable clamps to shell 0.5 - 0.6
18. Parking brake cable clamp to long link bracket 0.8 - 1.0
19. Dowels to front disc with hub / rear brake drum 0.6 - 0.8
SPECIAL TOOL
2
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
(WITHOUT FLWI)
○
# * SEAL - RECUPERATING
SPRING WASHER
# STOP PIN # PLUNGER SECONDARY
# * WASHER
# PLUNGER ASSEMBLY
(STOP PIN)
PRIMARY
# STOP WASHER
# SPACER BRAKE
3
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
CALIPER ASSEMBLY C - 51
ANTIRATTLE CLIP
PAD ASSEMBLY
PAD SHIM
# PISTON
# * DUST CAP
@ # * SLIDING
PIN BOOT
@ SLIDING PIN
@ # * GREASE SACHET
# * SEALING RING @
2.2 to 3.2
- SPECIFIED TORQUE IN Kgm # - MAJOR REPAIR KIT * - MINOR REPAIR KIT @ - SLIDING PIN KIT
4
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
1.0 to 1.3
BLEEDING
SCREW
# * DUST COVER
PIN
* PLUNGER
# * GLAND SEAL
BRAKE
5
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
CENTRAL LOCATOR
EQUILISER
HAND BRAKE
SWITCH
ASSEMBLY PARKING 0.8 to 1
BRAKE LEVER COMPLETE EXTENSION
SLEEVE
0.8 to 1
CLAMP
R CLAMP
0.6 to 0.8
ASSEMBLY PARKING
BRAKE CABLE
CLAMP
CLIP
6
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
NOTE : ALL COUPLING NUT TORQUE - 1.4 TO 1.6 Kgm - SPECIFIED TORQUE IN Kgm
7
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
3 7
1
8 9
4
10
2
5
11
9
8
8
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Fig. 2
6
4
3
7
2
5
9 11
1 10
12
7
5
BRAKE
9
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
PISTON
HYDRAULIC PRESSURE ‘ON’
Fig. 4
10
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
REMOVAL OF PADS
Apply the parking brake lever.
Keep the gear shift lever in neutral position.
Jack up front of the car ; support with stands and remove
both front wheels.
Visually inspect pads for wear and caliper for brake fluid
leakage.
If they are found to have worn, proceed as follows to
replace them.
Loosen and remove bottom sliding pin bolt with 12 mm
spanner. Fig. 5
Swing up the caliper and hold with one hand. Remove
both the pad assy one by one. Fig. 6 Fig. 5
NOTE :
If you find any difficulty in swinging the caliper up, after
removing the sliding pin retaining bolt, it may be necessary
to push the caliper piston back along with the pad, using a
screwdriver.
BRAKE
Fig. 6
11
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
INSPECTION OF PADS :
Measure pad thickness (with lining) with a Vernier and
if the thickness is found to be less than 6 mm any
CALIPER PAD ASSEMBLY
where in the pad, it is time to replace them Fig. 7
Caution :
Do not polish the pads with sand paper or emery
paper. If the pads are polished with emery or
sand paper, hard particles of sand paper will be
deposited in pad and may damage the disc.
Whenever pads require correction, replace them with
new ones.
Always use genuine recommended pad for
replacement. Do not contaminate the pad surface
with grease or oil.
Fig. 7
Thoroughly clean the disc. If it is scored exessively,
replacement of new pads alone do not give optimum
performance and service life. Hence follow instructions ANTIRATTLING
as given to recondition the disc. CLIPS
Fig. 8
12
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Fig. 9
CAUTION :
Apply brake couple of times with the engine started
before taking the vehicle for a road test.
Before applying an emergency brake, it is advisable
to apply the brake gently several times at 50 kms per
hour speed to allow the brakes pads to align.
BRAKE
Heavy braking or prolonged braking should be avoided
in the initial 100-150 kms of run until the new pads are
bedded.
Fig. 10
13
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
DISMANTLING OF CALIPER :
Apply the parking brake and keep the gear shift lever
in neutral lever.
Jack up the front of the vehicle, support on stands and
remove wheels. Remove brake hose banjo bolt from
the caliper. Fig. 11
Collect the brake fluid from the brake hose / caliper in
a clean container. Block the bundy pipe using a dust
cap to prevent loss of brake fluid and prevent
contamination.
As explained in fitment of new pads, remove pads by
swinging the caliper.
Unscrew the carrier mounting bolts and remove the
caliper assembly. Fig. 11
Clean the caliper assembly externally with a rug.
Separate the carrier from the caliper housing. The
housing can be taken out from the carrier by sliding it
out while releasing the sliding pin boot from the carrier.
Take out the remaining sliding pin left in the carrier by
releasing the sliding pin boot from the carrier. Remove DUST BOOT
hose from Caliper body. COMPRESSED AIR PISTON
COMPRESSED
Fig. 13
14
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Fig. 15
15
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Fig. 16
Fig. 17
INSTALLATION OF CALIPER :
FITMENT OF SEALING RING
Smear the sealing ring with fresh brake fluid and fit it
on to the groove in the caliper pot and work around
with fingers until it is properly seated. Fig. 18
Smear fresh brake fluid to the piston surface.
Fit dust boot in to the caliper groove.
Fig. 18
16
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
BOOT
SLIDING PIN
Fig. 21
17
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Swing back the caliper to its place and fit sliding pins
bolt and tighten to recommended torque (Fig. 22). Fit
bleed screw.
Connect the hose with caliper housing. Ensure new
gaskets are used to ensure proper sealing. Before
fully tightening make sure that the hose should be
free from twists.
Assemble front brake hose to caliper feed port as
shown and tighten the banjo bolt to the specified
torque.
Connect bundy pipe nuts to the female end of the hose
after removing the dust cap from the bundy tube fitted
earlier and tighten to specified torque. SLIDING PIN
BOLT
DISC REMOVAL :
Fig. 22
Jack up the front of the car and remove the wheel by
removing the wheel mounting bolts.
Remove the caliper assembly by loosening the carrier
bolts (2 Nos.).
Remove Brake disc counter sunk screw connecting
the brake disc to the hub. Fig. 23
Pull the brake disc off by using two M8 bolts.
Fig. 23
18
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
19
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Fig. 25a
Fig. 26
bleeding
nipple
Fig. 26a
20
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
REAR BRAKES :
27 26 24
25
16 15
21 22 23
7
65
4
20 2
14 9
8
18
19
11
12 13
10
BRAKE
17
3
WORKING OF HYDRAULIC AUTO ADJUST To maintain the shoes square with the drum, both
SERVICE BRAKE (WITH FORWARD PULL HAND the rims rest on pads formed at suitable place on
BRAKE) Fig. 27 the back plate.
The hydraulic Auto adjust brake is simple in design, The shoe is held against the backplate by means
robust in construction with one trailing and leading of a shoe hold down clip. Mechanical lever
shoe with bonded linings. The brakes self adjust during mechanism is incorporated for normal hand brake
brake operation. operation, but the feature of the brake is that the
The shoe return spring are fitted from shoe to shoe to automatic adjustment of the lined shoes takes place
provide a positive shoe retraction thus avoiding any when the service brake is applied.
possibility of brake "hanging on".
21
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
22
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
23
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Fig. 33
24
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Fig. 35
Fig. 36
25
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
26
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
WHEEL CYLINDER
4
5 3
7
6
2
1
1. Dust cover
2. Plunger
3. Gland Seal
4. Dust Cap
5. Bleed Screw
6. Wheel Cyl. Body
7. Spring
BRAKE
Fig. 39
27
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
28
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Fit the back plate to the stub axle and tighten the
back plate bolts to the specified torque.
Before installing brake drum maximize the drum to
brake shoe clearance. (Follow the procedure as
mentioned in the brake drum removal).
Install the brake drum. Ensure the inside surface of
the brake drum and brake shoes are free from dirt and
oil.
Put the brake shoe hold down spring back to its original
position as shown.
Install inner race of the outer bearing, washer, spindle,
castle nut and split pin and assemble the wheel cap.
Fit the wheel and tighten the wheel mounting bolts to
the specified torque.
Flushing Brake Hydraulic System
It is always recommended that entire hydraulic system
be thoroughly flushed with clean brake fluid whenever
new parts are installed in the hydraulic system.
Periodical change of brake fluid is also recommended.
BRAKE
29
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Brake
Pedal
Fig. 46a
31
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Fig. 48
32
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
FILLER CAP
FLUID RESERVOIR
SEAL
O-RING
BACK SEAL
SPRING
BRAKE
ASSEMBLY PRIMARY
ASSEMBLY SECONDARY PLUNGER
PLUNGER
33
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Fig. 52
34
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Clean the cylinder bore in fresh brake fluid or alcohol round-ended rod. Press it down fully and whilst
and blow with compressed air. Be sure that the Three holding, screw in the stop pin with a new gasket and
holes visible through the primary and secondary inlet tighten to the specified torque. Slowly let the
ports) in the cylinder body are clean, by blowing dry secondary plunger back till it touches the stop screw.
compressed air.
Now insert the new primary plunger assembly as
Do not poke the holes with sharp instrument. shown in Figure (3) into the bore.
CAUTION : First fit the stop washer on to the primary plunger
Do not use kerosene (or) petrol (or) any other shaft. Fit the washer primary back seal followed by
mineral oils to clean the cylinder and its internal spacer and back seal on to the primary plunger shaft.
parts. As it will lead to contamination and Now fit the circlip by using circlip plier.
damage of rubber part wash all disassembled NOTE
parts with brake fluid only.
While fitting the primary back seal, make sure
INSPECTION OF TANDEM MASTER CYLINDER : that the lip of the seal is facing forward.
Examine the bore of the master cylinder. If it is not Actuate the primary plunger assembly for couple of
scored, ridged or corroded and is smooth to touch, times and check for the quick return of the plungers.
the master cylinder assembly can be rebuilt using the
Fit a new 'O' ring into the groove on the spigot of the
appropriate parts from the genuine repair kit.
body. Fit new grommet into both the inlet ports by
If there is a slight doubt about the condition of the liberally lubricating the same with fresh brake fluid.
bore like having deep grooves or pit marks etc., fit a
Fit the fluid reservoir by positioning the same into the
new master cylinder assembly.
grommets and by slightly rocking them on to either
If contamination is observed on the removed seals side, press it home. Fit the locking pin as shown in
(Normally they would have swollen and can be Figure.
compared with new seals from the kit, which will show
NOTE BRAKE
clearly that the size is enlarged). The entire rubber
parts in the system including both front and rear hoses It is essential that the reservoir filler cap must be
must be discarded and the entire system should be removed.
flushed with fresh brake fluid. Clean the filter. Refit the filler cap. Clean the filter.
ASSEMBLING THE TANDEM MASTER CYLINDER : Replace the sealing ring the filter cap during overhaul.
Refit the filler cap.
Absolute cleanliness has to be maintained and clean
fresh brake fluid must be used. Never use the brake Now the master cylinder is ready for fitment on to the
fluid bled from the system as it is aerated. Servo. Fit the master cylinder to servo using nuts
along with spring washer and tighten to the specified
To facilitate easy assembly, smear the cylinder bore
torque.
with fresh brake fluid liberally. Dip the plungers and
all seals in fresh brake fluid. Fit the secondary back Connect the outlet pipes to the master cylinder.
seal in the secondary plunger groove such that the Tighten the coupling nut to the specified torque. Fill
seal lip faces the primary plunger assembly. the reservoir with recommended brake fluid and bled
the system. Check for brake fluid leakage.
Fit the seal shim and recuperating seal on the stem
side of the secondary plunger in such a way that the NOTE
lip of the seal faces towards the secondary spring. Do not alter the stand out of the output rod of the
Fit the seal retainer in correct position as shown in servo unit.
figure and fit the secondary spring with the smaller dia Make sure that Vaccum Booster output rod is correctly
coil coming on to the plunger stem. assembled into the primary plunger bore.
Clamp the cylinder body with its mouth pointing Make sure that the primary outlet is connected to the
upwards in a vice fitted with soft jaws. Insert secondary front left and rear right and secondary outlet to the
plunger assembly into the bore with the secondary rear left and front right brakes.
spring leading into the bore.
Do not polish bore of the tandem master cylinder.
Then slowly push the plunger down the bore with a Never use cloth to clean or dry the master cylinder.
35
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
VACCUM BOOSTER
36
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
WORKING PRINCIPLE
BRAKE OFF Fig. 54
The diaphragm is fully retracted and is held against
the rear shell by the diaphragm return spring. The
input rod assembly is also fully retracted by the brake
pedal return spring, as far as the stop key, or valve
retaining plate will allow. With the input rod in this
position, the vacuum port is open and there is vacuum
on both the sides of the diaphragm.
BRAKE APPLIED Fig. 55
When the brake pedal is depressed, the input rod assy
moves forward inside the diaphragm plate until the
control valve closes the vacuum port; at this juncture
vacuum is still present on both the sides of the Fig. 54
diaphragm. As the input rod continues to move forward,
the control plunger moves away from the control valve,
opening the atmospheric port, which is formed between
these two parts. Air enters the rear shell behind the
diaphragm and the effect of atmospheric pressure
assisted by the valve rod helps in pushing the
diaphragm plate forward and thus the output rod
actuates the Master Cylinder Plunger.
BRAKE HELD ON Fig. 56 BRAKE
Fig. 56
37
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Fig. 59
38
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
39
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Engine Off : Depress and release brake pedal several times to remove vacuum from the system.
Depress pedal and hold with light pressure (7-12 kg) and start engine.
If vaccum booster is operative, pedal will fall slightly and then hold. Less pressure will be needed to hold
pedal down, than with the engine in 'off'' condition.
40
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Run the engine to medium speed. Release the accelerator and turn the engine off. This builds up vacuum.
Wait 90 seconds and apply the brakes. Two or more applications should be vaccum booster assisted.
Blow air through the hose. The valve is defective if air passes through.
BRAKE
If the non-return valve is defective install a new If the non return valve is OK, the vaccum booster
non-return valve and repeat the vacuum leak is leaking. Replace the vaccum booster with a
test. new kit.
41
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
42
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
PARKING BRAKE
BRAKE
BRAKE DRUM
BRAKE DRUM SEMITRAILING ARM LH
SEMITRAILING ARM RH
Fig. 63
PARKING BRAKE
The parking brake arrangement is cable operated This is a safety device so designed that the parking
console mounted mechanical type brake acting on rear brake does not get released accidentally.
wheels.
To release parking brake, lift the handle slightly and
The hand brake lever situated in the cab operates it. keeping release button pressed, push down the lever
When the hand brake lever is pulled up, the parking fully.
brake lever arrangement in the rear brake assembly
When release button is pushed as above, pawl rod
inside the rear brake drum brake is also pulled through
also gets pushed, disengaging pawl from ratchet, thus
the cable system.
releasing the parking brake.
This action expands the rear brake shoes against the
REMOVAL OF PARKING BRAKE LEVER
drum, thus applying the rear brakes. Fig. 63
Place wheels chocks at the rear wheels.
PARKING BRAKE HANDLE CONSTRUCTION
Fig. 64
43
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Fig. 66
44
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
After adjustment check for dragging of rear brake drum. Fig 68.
INSPECTION OF PARKING BRAKE :
Pull the parking brake lever at its centre by 20 kg
force, with this force the travel should not exceed 5th
notch position. Fig. 68
Check both the wheels are locked in this condition
and release the lever (i.e. take it to the notch) and
check for free rolling of the wheels.
For counting the notches easily, listen to the click
sound from the ratchet while pulling the parking brake
lever without pressing the button. A click sound
pertaining to each notch movement.
45
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
SPONGY BRAKE PEDAL1. Air in hydraulic system 1. Bleed the system and top up.
2. Soft or weak hose 2. Check and Replace
3. Poor quality brake fluid 3. Flush the system and refill with
recommended grade of brake fluid.
4. Excessive worn / Weak drums 4. Replace
in Rear
BRAKE ROUGH OR 1. Excessive lateral run out in disc or 1. Repair if possible or replace the
CHATTER ON parallelism disc. not within specification.
APPLICATION
2. Rear drum out of round 2. Check runout, repair or replace
drum as necessary.
3. Broken anti-rattle clip 3. Replace
4. Incorrect parking brake 4. Check and adjust as per
adjustment specifications.
5. Seized caliper pistons 5. Overhaul Calipers
6. Damaged or loose wheel bearing 6. Replace wheel bearing
7. Distorted steering knuckle or rear 7. Replace knuckle or rear wheel
wheel spindle spindle
46
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
BRAKE NOISE 1. Glazed shoe linings or foreign 1. Repair or replace shoe linings.
matters stuck on linings
2. Worn or distorted shoe linings 2. Replace shoe linings or pads
3. Loose front wheel bearings 3. Replace wheel bearing
4. Distorted backing plate or loose 4. Replace or retighten
mounting bolts.
EXCESSIVE PEDAL
TRAVEL 1. Incorrect pedal free play 1. Adjust as per specification.
2. Partial brake system failure either 2. Identify and repair by replacing
in dual circuit or in Master Cylinder necessary parts.
3. Air in system (pedal soft / spongy) 3. Bleed and top up with
recommended brake fluid.
4. Soft or bulging hose 4. Replace
5. Excessive clearance between 5. Check auto adjuster mechanism
lining and drum in rear brakes due
to malfunctioning of auto adjusters.
6. Lining pad knock back caused by 6. Adjust or replace faulty parts as
loose or worn wheel bearing or necessary. BRAKE
GRABBING OR
PULLING OF CAR 1. Incorrect type pressure (or) 1. Inflate both front tyres to the
inflated unequally. recommended pressure.
2. Wrong wheel alignment. 2. Check and adjust as per
recommended procedure
3. Loose suspension parts 3. Check all suspension mountings
and tighten
4. Incorrect parking brake 4. Check and adjust to correct
adjustment on rear brake. specification.
Note : If the above problems are not there then proceed further
with the checking of brakes for grabbing.
47
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
BRAKE WARNING LIGHT 1.Parking brake lever in applied 1. Release parking brake and check
LIGHTS AFTER ENGINE condition. that brake warning light turns off.
START
2. Brake fluid level very low. 2. Add brake fluid
BRAKE WARNING LIGHT 1. Leakage of brake fluid. 1. Investigate and correct leaky point.
TURNS ON WHEN BRAKE Add brake fluid.
IS APPLIED
2. Brake fluid level very low. 2. Add brake fluid.
BRAKE WARNING LIGHT 1. Brake warning light circuit faulty 1. Repair circuit or Replace bulb.
FAILS TO TURN ON EVEN
WHEN PARKING BRAKE
IS APPLIED.
48
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
i
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
CONTENTS
1. Technical Specification 1
2. Tightening Torques 2
3. Exploded Views :
a) Servo and tmc assembly (9 inch, ø22.22) 3
b) Caliper Assembly C - 54 4
c) Rear brake assembly (HASF ø200x30) 5
d) Parking brake system 6
e) Hydraulic lines - Non ABS Version - RHD 7
3. How does your car’s brake work 8
4. Front Brakes : 9
a) Salient Features 9
b) Caliper Operation 10
c) Front Brake Service 11
[Removal / Inspection / Installation of Pads, Calipers & Disc]
5. Rear Brakes :
a) Working of Hydraulic auto adjust service brake 21 BRAKE
b) Rear Brake Service 23
[Removal / Inspection / installation of Drum,
brake shoes, Back Plate, & wheel cylinder]
6. Bleeding of Hydraulic system 30
7. Tandem Master Cylinder(for Non - ABS version) 33
8. Vacuum Booster 36
a) Working Principle 37
b) Servicing 38
c) Check list for ensuring satisfactory functioning of vacuum booster 40
d) Vacuum Leak Test 41
9. Pressure Conscious Regulating Valve (PCRV) 42
10. Parking Brake 43
[Removal, Installation & Adjustment]
11. Troubleshooting of Brake system 46
iii
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATION
1
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
TIGHTENING TORQUES :
13. Rear brake hose / pipe mounting to wheel cylinder 1.4 - 1.8
15. Brake pipe line / parking brake cable clamps to shell 0.5 - 0.6
18. Parking brake cable clamp to long link bracket 0.8 - 1.0
19. Dowels to front disc with hub / rear brake drum 0.6 - 0.8
SPECIAL TOOL
2
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
(WITHOUT FLWI)
○
# * SEAL - RECUPERATING
SPRING WASHER
# STOP PIN # PLUNGER SECONDARY
# * WASHER
# PLUNGER ASSEMBLY
(STOP PIN)
PRIMARY
# STOP WASHER
# SPACER BRAKE
3
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
CALIPER ASSEMBLY C - 54
ANTIRATTLE CLIP
PAD ASSEMBLY
PAD SHIM
# PISTON
# * DUST CAP
@ # * SLIDING
PIN BOOT
@ SLIDING PIN
@ # * GREASE SACHET
# * SEALING RING @
2.2 to 3.2
- SPECIFIED TORQUE IN Kgm # - MAJOR REPAIR KIT * - MINOR REPAIR KIT @ - SLIDING PIN KIT
4
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
1.0 to 1.3
BLEEDING
SCREW
# * DUST COVER
PIN
* PLUNGER
# * GLAND SEAL
BRAKE
5
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
CENTRAL LOCATOR
EQUILISER
HAND BRAKE
SWITCH
ASSEMBLY PARKING 0.8 to 1
BRAKE LEVER COMPLETE EXTENSION
SLEEVE
0.8 to 1
CLAMP
R CLAMP
0.6 to 0.8
ASSEMBLY PARKING
BRAKE CABLE
CLAMP
CLIP
6
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
NOTE : ALL COUPLING NUT TORQUE - 1.4 TO 1.6 Kgm - SPECIFIED TORQUE IN Kgm
7
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
3 7
1
8 9
4
10
2
5
11
9
8
8
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Fig. 2
6
4
3
7
2
5
9 11
1 10
12
7
5
BRAKE
9
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
PISTON
HYDRAULIC PRESSURE ‘ON’
Fig. 4
10
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
REMOVAL OF PADS
Apply the parking brake lever.
Keep the gear shift lever in neutral position.
Jack up front of the car ; support with stands and remove
both front wheels.
Visually inspect pads for wear and caliper for brake fluid
leakage.
If they are found to have worn, proceed as follows to
replace them.
Loosen and remove bottom sliding pin bolt with 12 mm
spanner. Fig. 5
Swing up the caliper and hold with one hand. Remove
both the pad assy one by one. Fig. 6 Fig. 5
NOTE :
If you find any difficulty in swinging the caliper up, after
removing the sliding pin retaining bolt, it may be necessary
to push the caliper piston back along with the pad, using a
screwdriver.
BRAKE
Fig. 6
11
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
INSPECTION OF PADS :
Measure pad thickness (with lining) with a Vernier and
if the thickness is found to be less than 6 mm any
CALIPER PAD ASSEMBLY
where in the pad, it is time to replace them Fig. 7
Caution :
Do not polish the pads with sand paper or emery
paper. If the pads are polished with emery or
sand paper, hard particles of sand paper will be
deposited in pad and may damage the disc.
Whenever pads require correction, replace them with
new ones.
Always use genuine recommended pad for
replacement. Do not contaminate the pad surface
with grease or oil.
Fig. 7
Thoroughly clean the disc. If it is scored exessively,
replacement of new pads alone do not give optimum
performance and service life. Hence follow instructions ANTIRATTLING
as given to recondition the disc. CLIPS
Fig. 8
12
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Fig. 9
CAUTION :
Apply brake couple of times with the engine started
before taking the vehicle for a road test.
Before applying an emergency brake, it is advisable
to apply the brake gently several times at 50 kms per
hour speed to allow the brakes pads to align.
BRAKE
Heavy braking or prolonged braking should be avoided
in the initial 100-150 kms of run until the new pads are
bedded.
Fig. 10
13
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
DISMANTLING OF CALIPER :
Apply the parking brake and keep the gear shift lever
in neutral lever.
Jack up the front of the vehicle, support on stands and
remove wheels. Remove brake hose banjo bolt from
the caliper. Fig. 11
Collect the brake fluid from the brake hose / caliper in
a clean container. Block the bundy pipe using a dust
cap to prevent loss of brake fluid and prevent
contamination.
As explained in fitment of new pads, remove pads by
swinging the caliper.
Unscrew the carrier mounting bolts and remove the
caliper assembly. Fig. 11
Clean the caliper assembly externally with a rug.
Separate the carrier from the caliper housing. The
housing can be taken out from the carrier by sliding it
out while releasing the sliding pin boot from the carrier.
Take out the remaining sliding pin left in the carrier by
releasing the sliding pin boot from the carrier. Remove DUST BOOT
hose from Caliper body. COMPRESSED AIR PISTON
COMPRESSED
Fig. 13
14
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Fig. 15
15
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Fig. 16
Fig. 17
INSTALLATION OF CALIPER :
FITMENT OF SEALING RING
Smear the sealing ring with fresh brake fluid and fit it
on to the groove in the caliper pot and work around
with fingers until it is properly seated. Fig. 18
Smear fresh brake fluid to the piston surface.
Fit dust boot in to the caliper groove.
Fig. 18
16
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
BOOT
SLIDING PIN
Fig. 21
17
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Swing back the caliper to its place and fit sliding pins
bolt and tighten to recommended torque (Fig. 22). Fit
bleed screw.
Connect the hose with caliper housing. Ensure new
gaskets are used to ensure proper sealing. Before
fully tightening make sure that the hose should be
free from twists.
Assemble front brake hose to caliper feed port as
shown and tighten the banjo bolt to the specified
torque.
Connect bundy pipe nuts to the female end of the hose SLIDING PIN
BOLT
after removing the dust cap from the bundy tube fitted
earlier and tighten to specified torque.
DISC REMOVAL :
Fig. 22
Jack up the front of the car and remove the wheel by
removing the wheel mounting bolts.
Remove the caliper assembly by loosening the carrier
bolts (2 Nos.).
Remove Brake disc dowels (2 Nos.) connecting the
brake disc to the hub. Fig. 23
Pull the brake disc off by using two M8 bolts.
Fig. 23
18
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
19
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Fig. 25a
Fig. 26
Fig. 26a
20
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
REAR BRAKES :
1
13
18
12 15
10
16
20
19
14
17 5
4
6
3
2
7
11 8
BRAKE
WORKING OF HYDRAULIC AUTO ADJUST To maintain the shoes square with the drum, both
SERVICE BRAKE (WITH FORWARD PULL HAND the rims rest on pads formed at suitable place on
BRAKE) Fig. 27 the back plate.
The hydraulic Auto adjust brake is simple in design, The shoe is held against the backplate by means
robust in construction with one trailing and leading of a shoe hold down clip. Mechanical lever
shoe with bonded linings. The brakes self adjust during mechanism is incorporated for normal hand brake
brake operation. operation, but the feature of the brake is that the
The shoe return spring are fitted from shoe to shoe to automatic adjustment of the lined shoes takes place
provide a positive shoe retraction thus avoiding any when the service brake is applied.
possibility of brake "hanging on".
21
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
22
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
23
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Fig. 33
24
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Fig. 35
Fig. 36
25
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
26
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
WHEEL CYLINDER
4
5 3
7
6
2
1
1. Dust cover
2. Plunger
3. Gland Seal
4. Dust Cap
5. Bleed Screw
6. Wheel Cyl. Body
7. Spring
BRAKE
Fig. 39
27
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
28
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Fit the back plate to the stub axle and tighten the
back plate bolts to the specified torque.
Before installing brake drum maximize the drum to
brake shoe clearance. (Follow the procedure as
mentioned in the brake drum removal).
Install the brake drum. Ensure the inside surface of
the brake drum and brake shoes are free from dirt and
oil.
Put the brake shoe hold down spring back to its original
position as shown.
Install inner race of the outer bearing, washer, spindle,
castle nut and split pin and assemble the wheel cap.
Fit the wheel and tighten the wheel mounting bolts to
the specified torque.
Flushing Brake Hydraulic System
It is always recommended that entire hydraulic system
be thoroughly flushed with clean brake fluid whenever
new parts are installed in the hydraulic system.
Periodical change of brake fluid is also recommended.
BRAKE
29
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Brake
Pedal
Fig. 46a
31
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Fig. 48
32
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
FILLER CAP
FLUID RESERVOIR
SEAL
O-RING
BACK SEAL
SPRING
BRAKE
ASSEMBLY PRIMARY
ASSEMBLY SECONDARY PLUNGER
PLUNGER
33
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Fig. 52
34
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Clean the cylinder bore in fresh brake fluid or alcohol round-ended rod. Press it down fully and whilst
and blow with compressed air. Be sure that the Three holding, screw in the stop pin with a new gasket and
holes visible through the primary and secondary inlet tighten to the specified torque. Slowly let the
ports) in the cylinder body are clean, by blowing dry secondary plunger back till it touches the stop screw.
compressed air.
Now insert the new primary plunger assembly as
Do not poke the holes with sharp instrument. shown in Figure (3) into the bore.
CAUTION : First fit the stop washer on to the primary plunger
Do not use kerosene (or) petrol (or) any other shaft. Fit the washer primary back seal followed by
mineral oils to clean the cylinder and its internal spacer and back seal on to the primary plunger shaft.
parts. As it will lead to contamination and Now fit the circlip by using circlip plier.
damage of rubber part wash all disassembled NOTE
parts with brake fluid only.
While fitting the primary back seal, make sure
INSPECTION OF TANDEM MASTER CYLINDER : that the lip of the seal is facing forward.
Examine the bore of the master cylinder. If it is not Actuate the primary plunger assembly for couple of
scored, ridged or corroded and is smooth to touch, times and check for the quick return of the plungers.
the master cylinder assembly can be rebuilt using the
Fit a new 'O' ring into the groove on the spigot of the
appropriate parts from the genuine repair kit.
body. Fit new grommet into both the inlet ports by
If there is a slight doubt about the condition of the liberally lubricating the same with fresh brake fluid.
bore like having deep grooves or pit marks etc., fit a
Fit the fluid reservoir by positioning the same into the
new master cylinder assembly.
grommets and by slightly rocking them on to either
If contamination is observed on the removed seals side, press it home. Fit the locking pin as shown in
(Normally they would have swollen and can be Figure.
compared with new seals from the kit, which will show
NOTE BRAKE
clearly that the size is enlarged). The entire rubber
parts in the system including both front and rear hoses It is essential that the reservoir filler cap must be
must be discarded and the entire system should be removed.
flushed with fresh brake fluid. Clean the filter. Refit the filler cap. Clean the filter.
ASSEMBLING THE TANDEM MASTER CYLINDER : Replace the sealing ring the filter cap during overhaul.
Refit the filler cap.
Absolute cleanliness has to be maintained and clean
fresh brake fluid must be used. Never use the brake Now the master cylinder is ready for fitment on to the
fluid bled from the system as it is aerated. Servo. Fit the master cylinder to servo using nuts
along with spring washer and tighten to the specified
To facilitate easy assembly, smear the cylinder bore
torque.
with fresh brake fluid liberally. Dip the plungers and
all seals in fresh brake fluid. Fit the secondary back Connect the outlet pipes to the master cylinder.
seal in the secondary plunger groove such that the Tighten the coupling nut to the specified torque. Fill
seal lip faces the primary plunger assembly. the reservoir with recommended brake fluid and bled
the system. Check for brake fluid leakage.
Fit the seal shim and recuperating seal on the stem
side of the secondary plunger in such a way that the NOTE
lip of the seal faces towards the secondary spring. Do not alter the stand out of the output rod of the
Fit the seal retainer in correct position as shown in servo unit.
figure and fit the secondary spring with the smaller dia Make sure that Vaccum Booster output rod is correctly
coil coming on to the plunger stem. assembled into the primary plunger bore.
Clamp the cylinder body with its mouth pointing Make sure that the primary outlet is connected to the
upwards in a vice fitted with soft jaws. Insert secondary front left and rear right and secondary outlet to the
plunger assembly into the bore with the secondary rear left and front right brakes.
spring leading into the bore.
Do not polish bore of the tandem master cylinder.
Then slowly push the plunger down the bore with a Never use cloth to clean or dry the master cylinder.
35
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
VACCUM BOOSTER
Fig. 53 Exploded view of TMC assembly & Vaccum Booster Assembly (LSC65 + ø22.22AS/AS)
There is a mechanical vaccum booster unit fitted on operates the master cylinder. Should a vacuum failure
the car. The above unit is designed to provide controlled occur, the two push rods act as a single rod and the
power assistance to the effort applied by the driver's brakes will work in the conventional manner, but more
foot to the brake pedal. pedal effort will be required and the fatigue of the driver
Vacuum supplied to the booster unit is obtained from will increase.
the vacuum created in the engine inlet manifold in case
of petrol engine and Vacuum generated by vacuum
pump in case of diesel engine. The vacuum is applied
to both the sides of a diaphragm and by admitting
atmospheric pressure to one side of the diaphragm
the power is obtained.
The unit is connected to the brake pedal and the master
cylinder. The vaccum booster input push rod is
connected to brake pedal while the output push rod
36
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
WORKING PRINCIPLE
BRAKE OFF Fig. 54
The diaphragm is fully retracted and is held against
the rear shell by the diaphragm return spring. The
input rod assembly is also fully retracted by the brake
pedal return spring, as far as the stop key, or valve
retaining plate will allow. With the input rod in this
position, the vacuum port is open and there is vacuum
on both the sides of the diaphragm.
BRAKE APPLIED Fig. 55
When the brake pedal is depressed, the input rod assy
moves forward inside the diaphragm plate until the
control valve closes the vacuum port; at this juncture
vacuum is still present on both the sides of the Fig. 54
diaphragm. As the input rod continues to move forward,
the control plunger moves away from the control valve,
opening the atmospheric port, which is formed between
these two parts. Air enters the rear shell behind the
diaphragm and the effect of atmospheric pressure
assisted by the valve rod helps in pushing the
diaphragm plate forward and thus the output rod
actuates the Master Cylinder Plunger.
BRAKE HELD ON Fig. 56 BRAKE
Fig. 56
37
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Fig. 59
38
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
39
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Engine Off : Depress and release brake pedal several times to remove vacuum from the system.
Depress pedal and hold with light pressure (7-12 kg) and start engine.
If vaccum booster is operative, pedal will fall slightly and then hold. Less pressure will be needed to hold
pedal down, than with the engine in 'off'' condition.
40
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Run the engine to medium speed. Release the accelerator and turn the engine off. This builds up vacuum.
Wait 90 seconds and apply the brakes. Two or more applications should be vaccum booster assisted.
Blow air through the hose. The valve is defective if air passes through.
BRAKE
If the non-return valve is defective install a new If the non return valve is OK, the vaccum booster
non-return valve and repeat the vacuum leak is leaking. Replace the vaccum booster with a
test. new kit.
41
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
42
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
PARKING BRAKE
BRAKE
BRAKE DRUM
BRAKE DRUM SEMITRAILING ARM LH
SEMITRAILING ARM RH
Fig. 63
PARKING BRAKE
The parking brake arrangement is cable operated This is a safety device so designed that the parking
console mounted mechanical type brake acting on rear brake does not get released accidentally.
wheels.
To release parking brake, lift the handle slightly and
The hand brake lever situated in the cab operates it. keeping release button pressed, push down the lever
When the hand brake lever is pulled up, the parking fully.
brake lever arrangement in the rear brake assembly
When release button is pushed as above, pawl rod
inside the rear brake drum brake is also pulled through
also gets pushed, disengaging pawl from ratchet, thus
the cable system.
releasing the parking brake.
This action expands the rear brake shoes against the
REMOVAL OF PARKING BRAKE LEVER
drum, thus applying the rear brakes. Fig. 63
Place wheels chocks at the rear wheels.
PARKING BRAKE HANDLE CONSTRUCTION
Fig. 64
43
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
Fig. 66
44
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
After adjustment check for dragging of rear brake drum. Fig 68.
INSPECTION OF PARKING BRAKE :
Pull the parking brake lever at its centre by 20 kg
force, with this force the travel should not exceed 5th
notch position. Fig. 68
Check both the wheels are locked in this condition
and release the lever (i.e. take it to the notch) and
check for free rolling of the wheels.
For counting the notches easily, listen to the click
sound from the ratchet while pulling the parking brake
lever without pressing the button. A click sound
pertaining to each notch movement.
45
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
SPONGY BRAKE PEDAL1. Air in hydraulic system 1. Bleed the system and top up.
2. Soft or weak hose 2. Check and Replace
3. Poor quality brake fluid 3. Flush the system and refill with
recommended grade of brake fluid.
4. Excessive worn / Weak drums 4. Replace
in Rear
BRAKE ROUGH OR 1. Excessive lateral run out in disc or 1. Repair if possible or replace the
CHATTER ON parallelism disc. not within specification.
APPLICATION
2. Rear drum out of round 2. Check runout, repair or replace
drum as necessary.
3. Broken anti-rattle clip 3. Replace
4. Incorrect parking brake 4. Check and adjust as per
adjustment specifications.
5. Seized caliper pistons 5. Overhaul Calipers
6. Damaged or loose wheel bearing 6. Replace wheel bearing
7. Distorted steering knuckle or rear 7. Replace knuckle or rear wheel
wheel spindle spindle
46
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
BRAKE NOISE 1. Glazed shoe linings or foreign 1. Repair or replace shoe linings.
matters stuck on linings
2. Worn or distorted shoe linings 2. Replace shoe linings or pads
3. Loose front wheel bearings 3. Replace wheel bearing
4. Distorted backing plate or loose 4. Replace or retighten
mounting bolts.
EXCESSIVE PEDAL
TRAVEL 1. Incorrect pedal free play 1. Adjust as per specification.
2. Partial brake system failure either 2. Identify and repair by replacing
in dual circuit or in Master Cylinder necessary parts.
3. Air in system (pedal soft / spongy) 3. Bleed and top up with
recommended brake fluid.
4. Soft or bulging hose 4. Replace
5. Excessive clearance between 5. Check auto adjuster mechanism
lining and drum in rear brakes due
to malfunctioning of auto adjusters.
6. Lining pad knock back caused by 6. Adjust or replace faulty parts as
loose or worn wheel bearing or necessary. BRAKE
GRABBING OR
PULLING OF CAR 1. Incorrect type pressure (or) 1. Inflate both front tyres to the
inflated unequally. recommended pressure.
2. Wrong wheel alignment. 2. Check and adjust as per
recommended procedure
3. Loose suspension parts 3. Check all suspension mountings
and tighten
4. Incorrect parking brake 4. Check and adjust to correct
adjustment on rear brake. specification.
Note : If the above problems are not there then proceed further
with the checking of brakes for grabbing.
47
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BRAKES
BRAKE WARNING LIGHT 1.Parking brake lever in applied 1. Release parking brake and check
LIGHTS AFTER ENGINE condition. that brake warning light turns off.
START
2. Brake fluid level very low. 2. Add brake fluid
BRAKE WARNING LIGHT 1. Leakage of brake fluid. 1. Investigate and correct leaky point.
TURNS ON WHEN BRAKE Add brake fluid.
IS APPLIED
2. Brake fluid level very low. 2. Add brake fluid.
BRAKE WARNING LIGHT 1. Brake warning light circuit faulty 1. Repair circuit or Replace bulb.
FAILS TO TURN ON EVEN
WHEN PARKING BRAKE
IS APPLIED.
48
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
NEXT
GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
NEXT i
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
CONTENTS
1. Technical Specification 1
2. Wheel Slip 2
3. How ABS works 3
4. Braking without ABS 6
5. Braking with ABS:
a) Description of operation 6
- Pressure Maintaining phase 7
- Pressure Reduction phase 8
- Pressure Increase phase 9
6. ABS Components
a) Tandem Master Cylinder 10
b) Wheel speed sensor 11
d) Electronic Control Unit 12
- EBD control necessity 14
- Principle 15
- Action 16
- Effect 16
- Safety 16
7. Workshop Testing 18 ABS
NEXT iii
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATION
Type of Motor DC
1
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
The vehicle can stop in relation to how well the tire 1: Dry Asphalt
contact surface grips the road.At 0% slip, the tyre 2: Wet Concrete
rotates freely and at 100% slip, the tire and wheel are 3. Snow
locked and the weight of the vehicle pushes the locked 4. Polished Ice
tires along the road surface. In this situation, vehicle
Fig 1.
stability and steerability will be lost.
2
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
Fig 2.
ABS
It is capable of rapid adaptation to changes in surface the Front Left and the Rear Right brake while the
traction. ( Dry road with patches of ice) and capable of secondary connects Front Right and Rear Left brake
slowing down the yaw effect on the vehicle when through connectors.
vehicle is driven on a µ split track, so that even an
average driver can initiate compensatory counter steer. Anti lock braking system ABS 5.3 is a 4-channel
diagonal (X) split system consists of an ECU attached
ECU continually monitors the operating status of ABS. to hydraulic unit and 4 wheels speed sensors (one at
Incase of ABS failure driver will be alerted and each wheel).The ECU controls the hydraulic unit. Each
conventional braking will still be operational without of the four wheels has one individual pair of inlet and
ABS. outlet solenoid valves to control each wheel speed
individually.
HOW ABS WORKS : Fig. 2 and Fig. 3
3
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
HYDRAULIC UNIT
MC2 MC1
D2 O1 D1
O2
RP2 M RP1
A2 A1
NRV1
NRV4
LRAV RFAV LFAV RRAV
ABS
LR RF LF RR
Fig 3.
MC1 & MC2 : Primary & Secondary brake M : Motor for driving recirculating
circuits pumps
D1 & D2 : Damping chambers.
RREV & RRAV : Inlet & outlet solenoid valves of O1 & O2 : Orifices
Rear Right wheel
LFEV & LFAV : Inlet & outlet solenoid valves of NRV1, NRV2, : Non return Valves of Rear left,
Front Left wheel NRV3 & NRV4 Front right, Front left & Rear
RFEV & RFAV : Inlet & outlet solenoid valves of right wheels respectively.
Front Right wheel
LREV & LRAV : Inlet & outlet solenoid valves of
Rear Left wheel
4
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
5
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
HYDRAULIC UNIT
MC2 MC1
D2 O1 D1
O2
RP2 M RP1
A2 A1
NRV1
NRV4
LRAV RFAV LFAV RRAV
ABS
LR RF LF RR
Fig 4.
Incase of brake operation without ABS, when driver DESCRIPTION OF OPERATION OF THE ANTI-LOCK
presses the brake pedal, brake pressure developed in BRAKING SYSTEM
the TMC reaches each wheel through HU. During this
phase, both inlet & outlet solenoid valves are not On the basis of the signals received from the rpm
switched ON (or excited) by ECU. Hence the inlet sensors located on the front and rear wheels, the
valve is open and outlet valve remains closed. electronic control unit instructs the hydraulic unit, so
as to vary the pressure of the brake fluid delivered to
When the driver releases the brake pedal, the brake the brake calipers, passing through the three stages
fluid flows back from the respective wheel, through described on next page:
the respective NRV (Non Return Valve) & reaches TMC.
In this way, the whole brake system functions just
like in a vehicle with normal hydraulic brake system
(without ABS system).
6
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
7
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
ECU activates both Inlet & Outlet solenoid valves. The ACCUMULATOR
closed Inlet solenoid valve shuts the liquid channel
from master cylinder. The outlet valve opens and
connects the wheel circuit to the secondary circuit. OUTLET VALVE INLET VALVE
Brake fluid gets discharged into the accumulator. The (OPEN) (CLOSED)
recirculation pump (which is driven by a motor which
is not shown in the figure) pumps the brake fluid back
to the master cylinder through the damping chamber.
The damping chamber avoids the pulsations of the
returning brake fluid from getting transferred to the Fig 6.
drivers foot. The pressure reduction is continued
till the wheel speed recovers to the vehicle
reference speed.
8
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
DAMPING
Pressure increase Phase : Fig. 7 CHAMBER
Fig 7.
9
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
ABS Components :
Fig 8.
ABS
Removal :
Fig 9.
10
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
Wheel Speed Sensor : Fig.10 and Fig.11 signal whose frequency is proportional to wheel
rotational velocity.
Electromagnetic pulse pick up with toothed wheels The ECU derives the wheel speeds from the signal
mounted directly to the rotating components of the sent by the wheel speed sensor. Inductive wheel speed
drive train or wheel hubs. These devices provide a digital
FRONT
ELECTRICAL WIRE
OVERMOULD
PERMANENT MAGNET
COIL
POLE PIECE
TARGET WHEEL
REAR
Fig 10.
ABS
TEETH
P1 P2 P1 P2 P1 P2 P1 P2
POLE PIECES
MAGNETIC DISPERSION
Vmin COIL
TIME t
TARGET WHEEL
V max
PERMANENT
MAGNET
VOLTAGE V
VELOCITY
USEFUL MAGNETIC FLUX
Fig 11.
11
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
12
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
HYDRAULIC UNIT
MC2 MC1
D2 O1 D1
O2
RP2 M RP1
A2 A1
NRV1
NRV4
LRAV RFAV LFAV RRAV
ABS
LR RF LF RR
Fig 13.
MC1 & MC2 : Primary & Secondary brake M : Motor for driving recirculating
circuits pumps
D1 & D2 : Damping chambers.
RREV & RRAV : Inlet & outlet solenoid valves of O1 & O2 : Orifices
Rear Right wheel
LFEV & LFAV : Inlet & outlet solenoid valves of NRV1, NRV2, : Non return Valves of Rear left,
Front Left wheel NRV3 & NRV4 Front right, Front left & Rear
RFEV & RFAV : Inlet & outlet solenoid valves of right wheels respectively.
Front Right wheel
LREV & LRAV : Inlet & outlet solenoid valves of
Rear Left wheel
Brake Pressure / Hydraulic Modulator : operational. EBD warning lamp is turned on in case
of error in the EBD system. EBD failure does not
This is an Electro-hydraulic device for reducing, necessarily mean ABS failure.
holding & restoring pressure to one or more wheel
cylinders, independent of the brake pedal effort EBD (Electronic Brake-force Distribution) Con-
applied by the driver. It consists of a Return Pumps, trol Necessity
Solenoid Valves, Damping Chamber, Accumulator,
Non-Return Valve and Motor. It forms the link between 1. During braking, whenever the rear axle wheels
the TMC and the foundation brakes. It implements the lock before the front axle wheels, the vehicle
commands issued by the ECU by using solenoid valves will loose its control & it may start to spin.
to control the pressure at the foundation brakes. This is because, braking is always associ-
ated with a certain weight transfer from rear
There are four pairs (4-channel system) of Inlet and axle onto the front axle wheels. Due to this
Outlet valves and are located in the upper section of drift of the vehicle weight, there will be lesser
the modulator. Solenoid valves are responsible for normal force acting on the rear axle when
modulating the pressure in the brake cylinder during compared to the front axle. Due to lesser
active ABS control. normal force, rear axle wheels can support
lesser brake pressure. In a passenger car,
The Return Pump element is installed in the center of as a counter measure to this problem, the
the modulator and is driven by an electric Motor. The brake circuit for the rear axle will be fitted
pump transfers the brake fluid emerging from the wheel with PCRV (Pressure conscious regulating
brakes through the accumulator on its way back to valve). This PCRV allows only the predeter-
the TMC through damping chamber. The pump mined max. pressure to the rear axle wheels
actuation can be felt on the foot pedal as pulsations. & hence avoids the locking of rear axle wheels
In order to prevent damage to the TMC primary seals before the front axle wheels.
from the compensating port, the design of TMC is
changed to central valve type (CV/CV)
2. But PCRV is a mechanical vehicle component
ABS Accumulator and Damping Chambers are Located in and it cannot result in ideal brake force
the lower section of the hydraulic modulator. The distribution for the rear axle wheels.
accumulator absorbs the surge in brake fluid that
accompanies the pressure reduction phase. The
Damping Chamber suppresses pressure oscillations 3. PCRV because of its design limitation, can-
within the hydraulic system, preventing them from being not allow higher brake pressure onto the
propagated back to the brake pedal and reduces noise rear axle wheels, when the vehicle is driven
levels in the system. in full load condition on a high friction sur-
face like Asphalt. This results in lesser brake
ELECTRONIC BRAKE FORCE force onto the rear axle wheels than the ideal
brake force & hence less efficient braking.
DISTRIBUTION (EBD) : This is viewed as a problem.
EBD substitutes Pressure conscious reducing valves
(PCRV). Its function is not determined by the brake 4. The brake force required for optimum braking
pressure or the weight transfer but by the amount of maybe different for each wheel. This is
wheel slip. EBD function is an additional program to depending on the road surface, the condition
the conventional ABS program. It reduces the of the friction material of brake lining/ pad &
pressure at the rear depending upon the wheel slip also the condition of the tyres (old/ new). With
and pressure reduction is carried out after certain PCRV, when the same brake force reaches
pressure-maintaining phase. It maintains the brake both the rear axle wheels, ideal braking can-
pressure to both the rear wheels same. If any of the not be achieved by the rear axle wheels.
rear wheels is still over braked, ABS becomes
14
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
Outlet Pressurev
deviate/spin (depending on the brake force lines
applied by the driver) from the intended driving
direction.
Unladen
6. In this vehicle with ABS system, the ECU
incorporates a special function by name EBD Cut-in point
(Electronic Brake force Distribution). With this
EBD, the conventional mechanical PCRV has
been eliminated from the rear brake circuit.
EBD results in ideal pressure distribution for the rear Inlet Pressure
axle wheels. With EBD, the rear axle wheels either
lock along with front axle wheels during partial Fig 14. With PCRV
braking OR the rear axle wheels may lock after the
front axle wheels. EBD never allows the rear axle
Laden
wheels to lock before the front axle wheels.
Unladen
Principle : Fig.14 and Fig.15
Outlet Pressure
15
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
Action : Effect :
1. Just before rear wheel tends to lock preceding to 1. Braking distance is decreased as rear brake force
front wheel, the EBD function of ABS ECU is enhanced in comparison with existing PCRV
actuates the inlet solenoid valve & closes it, so
2. Stability is secured at time of partial braking,
that the brake oil pressure from TMC is blocked
since the right and left rear wheel liquid
at HU only instead of reaching that particular
pressures are controlled independently from each
wheel cylinder & hence the locking is prevented.
other.
Some times, EBD also actuates outlet solenoid
valve & opens it for very short intervals of time, 3. Stable braking effect can be achieved because
so that locking of the rear wheels is avoided. front brake pad abrasion and temperature rise
etc. are decreased as braking effect of rear brake
2. Soon after the rear wheels recover from locking
is increased at braking time.
phase, the inlet & outlet solenoid valves are
switched OFF, so that the brake pressure 4. PCRV can be eliminated.
applied at MC be transmitted to the rear wheel
cylinder / caliper.
3. Motor pump does not act at this time.
At time of failure When it is transferred to ordinary brake, please drive slowly because of the
chances of generation of spin, since there is no PCRV. Restrain from beha-
vior of taking a sudden brake; go to Service center at once to take measures.
ABS
Safety
I. Even if ABS fails EBD continues to control even lamp which is nothing but the parking brake lamp
in the following situations : will glow indicating the driver about the failure. Now
the driver should drive carefully till the authorized
1) One wheel speed sensor failure. workshop to set right the problem.
2) Motor pump failure.
3) Failure by low voltage of battery (Minimum voltage
for EBD functioning 6.5 V)
16
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
Low voltage of battery does not operate operate(at > 6.5V ) ON OFF
ABS
17
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
18
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
0.3
GROMMET
19
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
3. Remove the sensor cable anchorage on the front FROM STEERING KNUCKLE
strut & on suspension tower. Fig 21.
Fig 22.
20
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
SENSOR
SENSOR MOUNTING PLATE
Fig. 23
1. Clean speed sensor and its mounting surface. 6. Make sure that the sensor cable connector is fully
seated and locked into vehicle wiring harness
2. Check the sensor mounting plate for rusting, and connector.
damage. Replace it with new one if found damaged.
7. Insert the sensor into the sensor mounting plate
3. Anchor both the sensor grommets to the strut and and fit it to the front steering knuckle by butting it
single grommet to shell. Route the sensor cable against the face on the knuckle and tighten the
as shown in Fig. 20-22. bolt to the specified torque.
4. Insert the sensor cable connector through the hole 8. Check the air gap between the face of the wheel
in the suspension tower, ensure that the cable is speed sensor and the top surface of the toner
routed with a loop as shown in the Fig. 20. wheel.
5. Install the wiring harness connector with wheel Air gap: 0.3 to 1.2 mm
speed sensor cable.
9. Road test vehicle to ensure proper operation of the
basic and ABS brake system.
21
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
ABS
SENSOR
MOUNTING SEMI TRAILING ARM
PLATE MOUNTING PLATE
Fig 25.
Fig 26.
22
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
2. Steer the wheel to extreme steering locks position 1. Jack the vehicle removes the wheels.
so that the Tone ring on the drive shaft is easily 2. Remove the brake drum.
seen.
3. Closely inspect the tone ring and remove the dust
and mud/iron particles in between teeth.
3. Closely inspect the tone ring by slowly rotating the 4. Check for any damaged teeth. (Rear tone ring has
wheel and remove the dust and mud/iron particles got 42 teeth) Fig. 28
in between teeth.
5. Replace tone ring if teeth are missing or damaged
23
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
ABS
24
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
THREADED HOLE
FOR POWER
STEERING ABS
RESERVOIR
MOUNTING
CENTRAL DOWEL
FOR LOCATING ECU
25
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS
26
HYDRAULIC LINES - ABS VERSION - RHD
ABS
INDEX
VACUUM BOOSTER CV/
CV TYPE
PRIMARY
LR
RF
ABS
MC2
ELECTRONIC/HYDRAULIC SECONDARY
ECU CONTROL UNIT
HU
ASSEMBLY VACUUM
LF
RR
MC1
REAR WHEEL CYL. RH
PIPE - MPFI - RHD
FRONT CALIPER LH
HOSE CLAMP 20
ASSEMBLY TUBE -
CONNECTOR RH TO
FRONT BR. HOSE RH
FRONT CALIPER LH
ASSEMBLY TUBE - REAR LH ASSEMBLY TUBE - BRAKE
CONNECTOR (1) TO REAR LH HOSE REAR LH TO WH CYL
CONNECTOR (2) REAR LH
GROUP INDEX
2.3 to 2.5
NEXT
- SPECIFIED TORQUE IN Kgm
NOTE : ALL COUPLING NUT TORQUE - 1.4 TO 1.6 Kgm
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
LX & LXi
NEXT
GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
i
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
CONTENTS
1. Specifications 1
2. Tightening Torques 1
3. List of Special Tools 1
4. Exploded view :
a) Steering System 2
5. General Description 3
6. Steering Wheel & Column 5
a) Removal & Installation of steering wheel 5
b) Removal & Installation of combination switch 5
c) Removal & Installation of steering column 6
d) Removal & Installation of steering lock cum Ignition switch 7
6. Removal & Installation of Rack & Pinion assembly 8
7. Procedure for Wheel Alignment 9
8. Wheel Alignment Values 10
9. Disassembly of Rack & Pinion 11
a) Inspection 12
b) Assembly of Rack & Pinion 13
10. Trouble shooting 17
MECHANICAL
STEERING
iii
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
SPECIFICATIONS
1. No. of turns (lock to lock) : 4.27
2. Free pinion rotation torque : 8-15 kg-cm .
Lubrication : Pinion to be lubricated with sterak grease.
Lubrication
Sterak Grease @ Rack, Pinion, Bearing & Rack Bush : 20 grams
Silicon Grease @ Bellow lip Inner Ball Joint : Smear
TIGHTENING TORQUES
NEXT 1
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
2.5
1.0
2.5
5.0
5.0
2
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
MECHANICAL
STEERING
COMBI SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
NEXT 3
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
BALL BEARING
CAPSULE
COLUMN BUSH
4
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
REMOVAL : Fig. 2
NEXT 5
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
INSTALLATION :
Proceed in reverse order of removal.
Ensure that side levers are fitted in their respective
place and correct connectors are connected. Fig. 5
CAUTION : Fig. 5
When tightening upper tray cover, ensure that combination
switch wires are not caught between covers. For installing
steering wheel refer STEERING WHEEL INSTALLATION
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF STEERING
COLUMN :
REMOVAL :
1 Disconnect battery cables.
2 Remove steering wheel (Ref. STEERING WHEEL
REMOVAL).
3 Remove combiswitch (Ref. COMBINATION
SWITCH REMOVAL) Remove instrument cluster
& dash board.
4 Disconnect wires & connectors from ignition
switch. Fig. 6
5 Mark the location of electrical connector and
remove them from the panel.
6 Remove the Ignition switch (For procedure refer ahead)
7 Remove steering column mounting nuts ( Top and
Bottom) Fig. 7
8 Unscrew rubber bellow locking ring.
9 Unscrew lower U joint bolt and remove the
steering column by prying out the U joint with a
screw driver.
CAUTION :
The steering column is of collapsible type. Hence
hammering of it or application of thrust in axial direction
of the column should be avoided as it will damage the
shear pins.
Fig. 7
6
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
INSTALLATION :
1 Proceed in reverse order of removal.
2 Tighten all fasteners to specified torque Fig. 8 &
9
Fig. 8
Fig. 9
INSTALLATION :
1 Proceed in reverse order of removal.
2 Use new mounting screws.
3 Tighten mounting screws to 1.5 mkg torque. Fig.10
Fig. 10
NEXT 7
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
REMOVAL
(Steering wheel, combi. switch and steering column
already removed)
1 Apply parking brake and place wheel chocks at
the rear or put the car on the hoist.
2 Loosen wheel nuts of front wheels Fig.11
3 Remove the front wheels
4 Raise the hoist to Jack up.
Fig. 11
Fig. 12
Fig. 13
8
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
PRECAUTIONS :
Fig. 14
Replace damaged/worn out parts
Adjust tie rod length to a nominal value of 1266 + 15
mm and lock it by lock nuts Fig. 15
Replace Nyloc nuts
LOCK NUT
Tighten steering gear box mounting screws (both RH
& LH) to 5 mkg torque
Tighten ball joints of tie-rod in steering knuckle to (4-5
mkg torque). Clamp the clutch cable with new cable
1266 + 1
tie. 5 mm.
NEXT 9
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
First adjust the camber While removal & re-fitment of steering rack and pinion
1. Loosen the two strut mounting bolts. assembly or replacing the tie rods on the vehicle,
the following procedure should be followed before
2. Rotate the eccentric pin on Top of the strut till going in for the actual wheel alignment as given
required camber value is achieved (For the values, above.
see next page)
If not check eccentric pin for excessive wear. If 1. Steering rack & pinion gear comes with 1266 mm
so, replace with new one. (nominal) length between centres of the ball joints
at the end. Ensure that number of threads of outer
3. First tighten the eccentric pin flanged nut to 8
ball joint exposed out of the tie rod tube are equal
mkg torque & then tighten the bottom bolt to 8
on both sides of the tube.
mkg torque.
2. Fix the steering rack & pinion gear on the fire
4. Apply 2 drops of Anabond 124 at nut end.
wall. Assemble the steering column with steering
Now adjust the toe out wheel. (Do not tighten the steering wheel to full
torque.)
1. Loosen the tie rod end check nuts.
3. Bring the front tyre in straight ahead position.
2. Adjust the toe out values by rotating the tie rod
ends. While adjusting toe out, adjust the length of 4. Rotate steering gear from lock to lock. Measure
both the tie rods by rotating them in the opposite 4.27 number of turns approx (Mech.stg.) Bring
direction such that their lengths remain equal at the steering gear to the centre by rotating through
all times (For the values, see next page). half of the total number of turns (measured).
NOTE : 5. Fix the outer ball joints into the steering arm of
steering knuckle.
If toe is excessively out of limit, first adjust toe, then
the camber and then adjust toe again. Step 3,4,5 are particularly useful in centralisation of
Not following the sequence i.e. first camber and then steering linkages and could be even adopted during
toe out will lead to incorrect wheel alignment even normal wheel alignment process in case values are
though individual adjustments are done correctly. not achieved or excessive wheel lock angle is
observed.
WHEEL ALIGNMENT VALUES
(Unladen condition) 6. If steering wheel spokes are not centralised,
FRONT WHEELS: remove the steering wheel & refit, so that spokes
& mascot are correctly positioned. Tighten the
Parameter Power Steering steering wheel nut to specified torque.
Castor 10 30’ to20 30’ Further carry out the camber & toe in adjustments as
(Inbuilt) (Inbuilt) explained above.
Camber 45’ to ± 15’
i.e. 30’ to 60’ (+ve)
Difference between LH & RH is 20’
Toe-out 0’ to -15’ on each
wheel or
0 to 3 mm
(-ve) (Total toe)
REAR WHEELS:
Wheel alignment is also required for the rear wheels.
Rear camber (Inbuilt) 10 + 30’
Toe in (per wheel) 00 to 30’
10
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
INDEX
OIL
BELLOW STRAP (PINION)
OUTER BALL JOINT SEAL
21 OUTER BALL JOINT 20
20 14
PINION BELLOW BELLOW CLIP
BELLOW CLIP COVER RETAINER STRAP 23
23 13 RING (SUPPORT)
9 22
PINION
BEARING
8
LOCK NUT
LOCK NUT BELLOW (SUPPORT)
BELLOW 18
NYLOC NUT (PINION)
DISASSEMBLY OF RACK & PINION
25 17 NYLOCK NUT
PINION
25
7
B HOUSING RACK TUBE RACK BUSH
MECHANICAL STEERING
A 1 2 15
C
GROUP INDEX
19
BUSHING, RUBBER
MOUNT RUBBER MOUNT YOKE
BRACKET (SUPPORT END) 6
4 11
24
YOKE COVER
12
SPRING
COLLAR GEAR 16
MOUNT
5 SECTION - CC SECTION - AA
NEXT
SECTION - BB
PREVIOUS
11
STEERING
MECHANICAL
MECHANICAL STEERING
12
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
TO REASSEMBLE :
• Clean all components before use.
Fig. 17
Fig.18
3 SLOTS
RACK BUSH 3 EARS
(15)
GENTLE
BLOW
Fig. 19
NEXT 13
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
Fig. 21
Fig. 22
14
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
Fig. 23
SPRING (16)
YOKE (11)
MECHANICAL
STEERING
Fig. 24
Fig. 25
NEXT 15
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
BELLOW (17)
BELLOW WIRE (21)
Fig. 26
Fig. 27
16
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
8. Lost Motion (Lash) at the steering wheel Steering wheel loose on the shaft
Loose connection between the steering gear and
steering column.
Steering gear lose on firewall
Components in steering linkage loose or worn.
Steering gear improperly adjusted.
NEXT 17
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
i
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
CONTENTS
1. Specifications 1
2. Tightening Torques 1
3. List of Special Tools 1
4. Exploded view :
a) Steering System 2
5. General Description 3
6. Steering Wheel & Column 5
a) Removal & Installation of steering wheel 5
b) Removal & Installation of combination switch 5
c) Removal & Installation of steering column 6
d) Removal & Installation of steering lock cum Ignition switch 7
6. Removal & Installation of Rack & Pinion assembly 8
7. Procedure for Wheel Alignment 9
8. Wheel Alignment Values 10
9. Disassembly of Rack & Pinion 11
a) Inspection 12
b) Assembly of Rack & Pinion 13
10. Trouble shooting 17
MECHANICAL
STEERING
iii
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
SPECIFICATIONS
1. No. of turns (lock to lock) : 4.27
2. Free pinion rotation torque : 8-15 kg-cm .
Lubrication : Pinion to be lubricated with sterak grease.
Lubrication
Sterak Grease @ Rack, Pinion, Bearing & Rack Bush : 20 grams
Silicon Grease @ Bellow lip Inner Ball Joint : Smear
TIGHTENING TORQUES
NEXT 1
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
2.5
1.0
2.5
5.0
5.0
2
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
MECHANICAL
STEERING
COMBI SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
NEXT 3
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
BALL BEARING
CAPSULE
COLUMN BUSH
4
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
REMOVAL : Fig. 2
NEXT 5
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
INSTALLATION :
Proceed in reverse order of removal.
Ensure that side levers are fitted in their respective
place and correct connectors are connected. Fig. 5
CAUTION : Fig. 5
When tightening upper tray cover, ensure that combination
switch wires are not caught between covers. For installing
steering wheel refer STEERING WHEEL INSTALLATION
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF STEERING
COLUMN :
REMOVAL :
1 Disconnect battery cables.
2 Remove steering wheel (Ref. STEERING WHEEL
REMOVAL).
3 Remove combiswitch (Ref. COMBINATION
SWITCH REMOVAL) Remove instrument cluster
& dash board.
4 Disconnect wires & connectors from ignition
switch. Fig. 6
5 Mark the location of electrical connector and
remove them from the panel.
6 Remove the Ignition switch (For procedure refer ahead)
7 Remove steering column mounting nuts ( Top and
Bottom) Fig. 7
8 Unscrew rubber bellow locking ring.
9 Unscrew lower U joint bolt and remove the
steering column by prying out the U joint with a
screw driver.
CAUTION :
The steering column is of collapsible type. Hence
hammering of it or application of thrust in axial direction
of the column should be avoided as it will damage the
shear pins.
Fig. 7
6
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
INSTALLATION :
1 Proceed in reverse order of removal.
2 Tighten all fasteners to specified torque Fig. 8 &
9
Fig. 8
Fig. 9
INSTALLATION :
1 Proceed in reverse order of removal.
2 Use new mounting screws.
3 Tighten mounting screws to 1.5 mkg torque. Fig.10
Fig. 10
NEXT 7
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
REMOVAL
(Steering wheel, combi. switch and steering column
already removed)
1 Apply parking brake and place wheel chocks at
the rear or put the car on the hoist.
2 Loosen wheel nuts of front wheels Fig.11
3 Remove the front wheels
4 Raise the hoist to Jack up.
Fig. 11
Fig. 12
Fig. 13
8
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
PRECAUTIONS :
Fig. 14
Replace damaged/worn out parts
Adjust tie rod length to a nominal value of 1249 + 15
mm and lock it by lock nuts Fig. 15
Replace Nyloc nuts
LOCK NUT
Tighten steering gear box mounting screws (both RH
& LH) to 5 mkg torque
Tighten ball joints of tie-rod in steering knuckle to (4-5
mkg torque). Clamp the clutch cable with new cable
1249 + 1
tie. 5 mm.
NEXT 9
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
First adjust the camber While removal & re-fitment of steering rack and pinion
1. Loosen the two strut mounting bolts. assembly or replacing the tie rods on the vehicle,
the following procedure should be followed before
2. Rotate the eccentric pin on Top of the strut till going in for the actual wheel alignment as given
required camber value is achieved (For the values, above.
see next page)
If not check eccentric pin for excessive wear. If 1. Steering rack & pinion gear comes with 1249 mm
so, replace with new one. (nominal) length between centres of the ball joints
at the end. Ensure that number of threads of outer
3. First tighten the eccentric pin flanged nut to 8
ball joint exposed out of the tie rod tube are equal
mkg torque & then tighten the bottom bolt to 8
on both sides of the tube.
mkg torque.
2. Fix the steering rack & pinion gear on the fire
4. Apply 2 drops of Anabond 124 at nut end.
wall. Assemble the steering column with steering
Now adjust the toe in wheel. (Do not tighten the steering wheel to full
torque.)
1. Loosen the tie rod end check nuts.
3. Bring the front tyre in straight ahead position.
2. Adjust the Toe in values by rotating the tie rod
ends. While adjusting Toe in, adjust the length of 4. Rotate steering gear from lock to lock. Measure
both the tie rods by rotating them in the opposite 4.27 number of turns approx (Mech. stg.) Bring
direction such that their lengths remain equal at the steering gear to the centre by rotating through
all times (For the values, see next page). half of the total number of turns (measured).
NOTE : 5. Fix the outer ball joints into the steering arm of
steering knuckle.
If toe is excessively out of limit, first adjust toe, then
the camber and then adjust toe again. Step 3,4,5 are particularly useful in centralisation of
Not following the sequence i.e. first camber and then steering linkages and could be even adopted during
Toe in will lead to incorrect wheel alignment even though normal wheel alignment process in case values are
individual adjustments are done correctly. not achieved or excessive wheel lock angle is
observed.
WHEEL ALIGNMENT VALUES
(Unladen condition) 6. If steering wheel spokes are not centralised,
FRONT WHEELS: remove the steering wheel & refit, so that spokes
& mascot are correctly positioned. Tighten the
Parameter Power Steering steering wheel nut to specified torque.
Caster 10 + 45’ Further carry out the camber & toe in adjustments as
(Inbuilt) explained above.
Camber -10’ to +40’
Difference between LH & RH is 20’
Toe-in 1’ to16’ on each
wheel or 0 to 3.7mm (total)
REAR WHEELS:
Wheel alignment is also required for the rear wheels.
Rear camber (Inbuilt) 00 + 30’
Toe in (per wheel) 00 to 30’ (+ve)
10
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
INDEX
OIL
BELLOW STRAP (PINION)
OUTER BALL JOINT SEAL
21 OUTER BALL JOINT 20
20 14
PINION BELLOW BELLOW CLIP
BELLOW CLIP COVER RETAINER STRAP 23
23 13 RING (SUPPORT)
9 22
PINION
BEARING
8
LOCK NUT
LOCK NUT BELLOW (SUPPORT)
BELLOW 18
NYLOC NUT (PINION)
DISASSEMBLY OF RACK & PINION
25 17 NYLOCK NUT
PINION
25
7
B HOUSING RACK TUBE RACK BUSH
MECHANICAL STEERING
A 1 2 15
C
GROUP INDEX
19
BUSHING, RUBBER
MOUNT RUBBER MOUNT YOKE
BRACKET (SUPPORT END) 6
4 11
24
YOKE COVER
12
SPRING
COLLAR GEAR 16
MOUNT
5 SECTION - CC SECTION - AA
NEXT
SECTION - BB
PREVIOUS
11
STEERING
MECHANICAL
MECHANICAL STEERING
12
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
TO REASSEMBLE :
• Clean all components before use.
Fig. 17
Fig.18
3 SLOTS
RACK BUSH 3 EARS
(15)
GENTLE
BLOW
Fig. 19
NEXT 13
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
Fig. 21
Fig. 22
14
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
Fig. 23
SPRING (16)
YOKE (11)
MECHANICAL
STEERING
Fig. 24
Fig. 25
NEXT 15
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
BELLOW (17)
BELLOW WIRE (21)
Fig. 26
Fig. 27
16
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
MECHANICAL STEERING
TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
8. Lost Motion (Lash) at the steering wheel Steering wheel loose on the shaft
Loose connection between the steering gear and
steering column.
Steering gear lose on firewall
Components in steering linkage loose or worn.
Steering gear improperly adjusted.
NEXT 17
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
LX & LXi
NEXT
GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
INTRODUCTION : Power steering fitted on Indica LEi & LSi MPFI is for
lighter steering effort and easy manoeuvrability.
POWER
STEERING
NEXT i
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
CONTENTS
1) Technical Specifications 1
2) List of Special Tools 2
3) Layout Of Power Steering Assembly 3
4) Exploded Views :
a) Hydraulic power steering lines 4
b) Rack and Pinion Assembly 5
c) Assembly power steering pump 6
d) Power steering reservoir 7
5) Power Rack & Pinion Steering System 8
6) Power Rack & Pinion Steering Gear - Operation 9
7) Procedure for filling and bleeding Hydraulic System 12
8) Minor repairs on Power Rack & Pinion Steering Gear 13
a) Replacement of Outer Ball Joint (OBJ) assembly 13
b) Replacement of Bellows 14
c) Replacement of Inner Ball Joint (IBJ) Assembly 15
d) Replacement of Feed Pipes 16
e) Replacement of Input Shaft Seal 17
9) On car Service - Inspection and Maintenance 18
10) Power Steering Gear - Exploded View 19
11) Power Steering System - Hydraulic tests using Diagnostic gauge 20 POWER
STEERING
12) Trouble shooting guide 22
NEXT iii
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Type : Transparent Plastic Reservoir with replaceable filter cartridge(for non ABS)
Metallic Reservoir with replaceable filter cartridge (for ABS)
Capacity : At Max. level - 375 ml At Max. level- 320 ml (for non ABS)
At Min. level - 300 ml At Min. level - 250 ml (for non ABS) POWER
STEERING
Hydraulic fluid : Automatic Transmission Fluid
Lubricants :
Sterak Grease @ Rack & Pinion & Rack Bush : 10 grams
Silicon Grease @ Bellow LIP-IBJ : Smear
1
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
1) Fixture to position steering gear assembly firmly during repair 2779 5890 46 02 N
3) Bellow dolly (2 nos.) to assemble new bellows in to the housing/rack 2779 5890 46 04 N
5) Peening punch to stake the IBJ against a notch on both ends of rack 2779 5890 46 06 N
6) Feed pipe torque wrench to loosen / tighten the flare nut of feed pipe 2779 5890 46 07 N
2
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
STEERING
WHEEL
STEERING
COLUMN
COMBI SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
POWER
STEERING
3
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
22
1.0
21
0.8
1.0
16
14
17
15
2.5
6
18 12
12
19
15
3.5
16
11
10
18
1
3
1.0
4
2
LIST OF PARTS 9 ASSY. RETURN PIPE LINE
10 ASSY.HIGH PRESSURE HOSE (COMPLETE)-RHD
No. Description 11 SEALING WASHER 14X20 IS3175 - CU
1 RUBBER HOSE (SUCTION LINE) 12 PIPE UNION BOLT 10 M14X1.5
1 RUBBER HOSE (SUCTION)-(ABS) 14 O’ RING (HP LINE)
2 SPRING BAND CLAMP FORM-A 15X23D 15 SLEEVE
3 CLAMP 16 CLAMP (FOR 10 DIA PIPE)
4 HEX FL SCREW M6X10 - 8.8 17 HEX FL NUT AM6
5 ASSY.RETURN LINE (P/STG)-RHD (ABS) 18 HEX FL SCREW M6X12 - 8.8
5 ASSY RETURN LINE (POWER STG) 19 ASSY.BRACKET (HP LINE CLAMPING)
6 SPRING BAND CLAMP FORM A 15X19D 21 SPRING WASHER B8 IS3063 SS8451-8C
22 HEX SCREW M8 X 14 - 8.8
Fig.(i)
4
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
BELLOW KIT
RUBBER MOUNT
5.0
BELLOW CLIP
-- SPECIFIED TORQUE IN Kgm
Fig.(ii)
5
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
6
Fig.(iii)
INDEX
POWER STEERING
GROUP INDEX
ITEM NO DESCRIPTION 10 DOWEL PIN (QTY/KIT - 2) 21 RETAINING WASHER
11 VANES (QTY/KIT - 10)
22 SHAFT
12 ROTOR (QTY/KIT - 1)
1 ASSY.POWER STEERING PUMP 13 CAM(QTY/KIT - 1) 23 BALL BEARING
2 HOUSING ASSY. 14 END COVER ASSY.(QTY/KIT - 1) 24 RETAINING RING
3 HOUSING SUB ASSY.(QTY/KIT - 1) 15 SEAL KIT
4 FLOW CONTROL SPRING (QTY/KIT - 1) 25 O’ RING 20 X 2 NITRILE
16 DOUBLE LIP SEAL (QTY/KIT - 1)
26 SUCTION HOUSE CONNECTOR
NEXT
17 O’ RING (FOR PR PLATE ID,QTY/KIT - 1)
5 VALVE ASSY.QTY/KIT - 1) 27 SPRING WASHER B8 IS3073
6 O’ RING (QTY/KIT - 1) 18 O’ RING (FOR PR PLATE ID,QTY/KIT - 1)
19 GASKET (QTY/KIT - 1) 28 THIN HD.CAP SCREW M8 X 16
7 PRESSURE PORT CONNECTOR (QTY/KIT - 1)
PREVIOUS
8 CARTRIDGE ASSY. 20 BOLT FOR END COVER
9 PRESSURE PLATE (QTY/KIT - 1)
Fig.(iv)
INDEX
POWER STEERING
GROUP INDEX
NEXT
PLASTIC RESERVOIR 7 SCREW METALLIC RESERVOIR FOR ABS
1 PLASTIC RESERVOIR & MOUNTING STRAP ASSY. 8 STAINER 1 RESERVOIR ASSY.
2 SHELL 9 ...O-RING 2 SHELL
PREVIOUS
3 FILTER AND END COVER ASSY. 10 ...RESERVOIR CAP 3 FILTER
4 VALVE SEAT 11 COVER TIE STRAP 4 CAP ASSY.
5 SPRING (FOR BY PASS VALVE) 12 MOUNTING STRAP
6 WASHER
7
POWER STEERING
ALTERNATOR
BELT
TENSIONER
BOLT
STEERING WHEEL 1
RESERVOIR
COLUMN ASSEMBLY JOINT 7
PRESSURE LINE 8 SUCTION LINE
8
PULLEY PUMP
INTERMEDIATE ENGINE
LINE
RETURN
JOINT
5
2
9
POWER RACK & LOCK
PINION STG. NUT
6
GEAR
The power steering offers the following advantages :- Pump is driven by engine 5PK poly ‘V’ belt.
• Reduces steering effort and driver fatigue The Power Steering Pump provides the hydraulic
assistance for the Power Steering Gear to operate.
• Provides precise steering control.
8
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
BEARING
ROLLER BELLOW
BELLOW CLIP PINION ASSEMBLY INNER BALL
BELLOW STRAP JOINT ASSY
PINION
BALL- BEARING RACK ASSY
RACK TUBE
(CYLINDER)
OUTER BALL JOINT
POWER RACK & PINION STEERING and pinned on housing and the Piston swaged
GEAR Fig. 3 to the Rack. The bore of the steel tube is honed
The Power Rack & Pinion Steering Gear comprise of : for smooth Piston movement.
Manual steering mechanism The two sides of the Cylinder (RH & LH) are
1. Manual steering mechanism is based on proven, connected to the Rotary Control Valve by external
reliable, smooth and lashfree Rack & Pinion feed pipes.
mechanism. OPERATION
The Pinion is supported on Ball & Needle Roller What happens during steering manoeuvre ?
POWER
STEERING
Bearings and the Rack on anti friction bush to
ensure high efficiency and smooth operation and When the driver turns the steering wheel, he transmits
the mechanism is designed to operate manually force from the wheel to steering gear input shaft.
in the event of hydraulic power failure. Input shaft rotation is transmitted to the Pinion through
Rotary control valve (Hydraulic control valve) Torsion bar which is pinned at one end to the Input
2. The Rotary Control Valve combines simplicity of shaft and pressed firmly into the Pinion at the other
construction with desirable performance end.
characteristics that provides responsive steering The Pinion tends to push the Rack linearly through
control. the Rack tube bore.
The input shaft and the valve sleeve constitute But the linear movement of the Rack which is connected
the two members of the Rotary Control Valve. to the steered road wheels through link mechanism is
Power cylinder (Rack Tube) all in a single resisted by the load on the steered wheels.
compact package.
3. Power Cylinder : The built in hydraulic cylinder
is constituted by the strong steel tube press fitted
9
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
OIL IN
LH ROTARY VALVE
CYLINDER RH POSITION
RH CYLINDER
CYLINDER INPUT SHAFT
TORSION BAR
OIL IN
VALVE SLEEVE NEUTRAL
LH
LH
CYLINDER
CYLINDER
RH CYLINDER SHORT FEED PIPE LONG FEED PIPE
OIL IN
TO RH CYLINDER TO LH CYLINDER
SECTION - M VALVE ASSY
(ENLARGED)
OIL IN A A
OIL OUT BELLOW
IBJ
RACK TUBE
RACK (CYLINDER)
Fig. 4
PRESSURE
OIL IN RIGHT TURN
PRESSURE
OIL IN
CW
ROTATION
PRESSURE
OIL IN
RETURN OIL
Fig. 5
10
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
PRESSURE
OIL IN ROTARY VALVE
POSITION
PRESSURE
OIL IN
LEFT TURN
PRESSURE
OIL IN
CCW
ROTATION
PRESSURE
OIL
RETURN OIL
Fig. 6
This resistance offered by the steered wheels on the
Pinion, leads to a definite twist on the Torsion bar
depending on the input torque level.
The Torsion bar twist disturbs the neutral position of
the Rotary Control Valve (input shaft and valve sleeve).
The disturbed Rotary Control Valve directs the oil flow
from the pump to the appropriate side of the cylinder.
POWER
STEERING
The Piston Rack pressurised by the oil, moves in the
required direction overcoming the resistance offered
by the steered wheels and produces the steering
action.
The resistance in the rotation direction of Pinion is
relieved by movement of Piston Rack by hydraulic force
and the reaction of Torsion bar returns the rotary valve
to its neutral position.
The oil flow diagram in neutral, right turn and left turn
positions of the steering gear are shown in. Fig. 4, 5 &
6.
11
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
Raise the front wheel clear off the ground and support
with safety stand.
CAUTION :
Do not allow the oil to run down significantly or run out
of the reservoir. This may induce air into the system.
CAUTION :
Don’t load the system until it is bled properly. Severe
damages could occur otherwise.
12
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
STEERING ARM
BALL PIN NUT
SPANNER
LOCATION
Fig. 7
MINOR REPAIRS ON POWER RACK & REMOVAL OF OUTER BALL JOINTS Fig. 7
PINION & PINION STEERING GEAR Raise the front of the car and support it on a safety
STEERING GEAR stand in the proper location.
This section covers only minor repairs that do not Remove the front wheels
require complete dismantling of steering gear Unscrew the ball pin nut of the Outer ball joint (RH
assembly. side & LH side) and using puller part no. 2702 5890
CAUTION : 4602, remove the Outer ball joint from the steering
arm (knuckle arm). POWER
The minor repairs should be handled only by proper STEERING
trained personnel who have proper equipment, tools, Hold the Inner ball joint with 14mm spanner and loosen
instructions and know-how and authorised to perform the lock nut with 17mm spanner to free the ball joint.
the work properly and safely. Now unscrew the Outer ball joint out of the Inner ball
REPLACEMENT OF OUTER BALL JOINT (OBJ) joint (Tie rod) assembly
ASSEMBLY. Discard the Outer ball joint assembly.
NOTE : ASSEMBLY OF OUTER BALL JOINTS
The outer ball joint assemblies must be replaced if Screw in the new Outer ball joint assembly on the
either of the following conditions are detected. Inner ball joint (Tie rod)
1. Any binding in articulation of the ball pin. Align the steering gear in mid position to straight ahead
2. Any axial play between the ball and cup of Outer position (SAP) of the steered wheels.
ball joint Assy, more than 0.1 mm at + 100 gms. Connect the Outer ball joints with the steering arm
The replacement of Outer ball joint can be done on Tighten the ball nut to specified torque.
the vehicle itself without removing the steering gear Install the front wheels and lower the front of the car.
from the vehicle as explained below : Carry out wheel alignment. Now tighten the outer ball
joint lock nut to specified torque.
13
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
ASSEMBLY OF BELLOW
BELLOW STRAP
BELLOW CLIP
HOUSING
BELLOW
DOLLY
PULL OUT
Fig. 8
REPLACEMENT OF BELLOWS : Fig. 8 Pull out the bellows away from the ends of the steering
gear box along with clip.
For better access and convenience to replace the
bellows properly, remove the steering gear assembly Discard the bellow/strap & clip.
from the car as per procedure in the Mechanical
Clean the outer surface at the ends of the steering
Steering Group of this Manual.
gear and Inner ball joint assembly.
CAUTION :
ASSEMBLY OF BELLOWS
1. Plug the ports tight with protective caps in the
steering gear. Clean the outer surface of the dolly (Taper guide tool)
and insert it on the Inner ball joint Assy.
2. Use only Special Tools and do not hammer to
remove outer ball joints from steering arm Apply grease (dow corning) on the groove of both the
(knuckle arm) tie rods.
3. Take care to avoid damage to bellows, feed pipes Assemble the bellow clip on the small end of the
and input shaft when drawing out the steering bellow.
gear assembly from the car. Keeping the rack in mid gear position slide the bellows
Mount the steering gear on a mock up bracket. on the dolly big end first till the small end of bellow
locates on the greased groove.
REMOVAL OF BELLOWS
Assemble the big end of the bellows over the ends of
Remove the Outer ball joint assembly after loosening the steering gear (Housing & Rack tube) ensuring no
the lock nut. Unscrew out the lock nut (Refer twist to the bellows.
Replacement of Outer ball joint for removal procedure).
Using the strapping gun, strap the big end of the bellow
Remove the bellows straps and discard. firmly to ensure proper sealing.
14
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
RACK
SPUTNIC WRENCH
ASSEMBLY OF IBJ
Fig. 9
Slide the rack to right and left by turning the Input CAUTION :
shaft to be certain that the bellows are not deformed 1. Plug the ports tight with protective caps in the
or twisted. steering gear.
POWER
Screw in the lock nut and Outer ball joint assembly 2. Use only Special Tools and not hammer to remove STEERING
on the Inner ball joint. Dismount the steering gear Outer ball joints from steering arm (knuckle arm)
assembly from the mock up bracket.
3. Take care to avoid damage to bellows, feed pipes
Reinstall the steering gear on the car. and input shaft When drawing out the steering
REPLACEMENT OF INNER BALL JOINTS gear assembly from the car.
ASSEMBLY (IBJ’S). WARNING :
NOTE : Improper tightening of Inner ball joint assemblies will
The Inner ball joint assembly must be replaced if either cause accident.
of the following conditions is detected. Mount the steering gear assembly on a mock up
1. Any binding in articulation of the Ball rod (tie rod) bracket.
2. Any axial play between the ball and cup of Inner Remove the outer ball joints and bellows on the LH
ball joint assembly, more than 0.1 mm at + 100 side and RH side of the steering gear (Refer
gms. Replacement of Outer ball joint / Bellows for removal
procedure).
15
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
FEED PIPE
LONG
FEED PIPE
SHORT
FLARE NUT
A/F 11
Fig. 10
Hold the rack suitably to take care not to damage the same and replace with new ones only.
rack surface. Using sputnik wrench, unscrew the Inner
Remove the steering gear assembly from the car.
ball joint assembly from the ends of the rack.
CAUTION :
Discard the Inner ball joint assembly.
1. Plug the ports tight with protective caps in the
ASSEMBLY OF INNER BALL JOINT
steering gear.
Screw in the new Inner ball joint assembly to the ends
2. Use only Special Tools and not hammer to remove
of the rack by hand.
Outer ball joints from steering arm.
Hold the rack suitably taking care not to damage the
3. Take care to avoid damage to bellows, feed pipes
surface. Using Sputnik wrench, tighten the Inner ball
and Input shaft when drawing out the steering
joint assembly to 8 kg-m torque.
gear assembly from the car.
Stake the Inner ball joint (RHS & LHS) using a punch
Carefully unscrew the flare nuts at the ends of
against the notch on both the ends of the rack.
the short/long feed pipes connected to housing
Reassemble the bellows and Outer ball joint (Refer and rack tube ends using 11 mm spanner.
Replacement of Outer ball joint/Bellows).
Discard the feed pipes.
Dismount the steering gear from the mock up bracket.
Blow clean the inside of the new feed pipes (short/
Reinstall the steering gear on the car.
long) with compressed air.
REPLACEMENT OF FEED PIPES (SHORT/
Install the feed pipes (short/long) by screwing
LONG) Fig. 10
the flare nuts at the ends to housing and rack
CAUTION : tube by hand.
Do not attempt to repair any bent or damaged feed Now tighten the flare nuts to 1.7 kg-m torque.
pipes. Whenever feed pipes are removed discard the
Reinstall the steering gear assembly on the car.
16
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
PRESSURE PORT
RETURN PORT
Fig. 11
REPLACEMENT OF INPUT SHAFT SEAL Disconnect the air pressure supply as soon as the
Fig. 11 seal is out.
Remove the steering gear assy. from the car. Discard the seal.
Caution : Wipe the seal bore with a clean cloth.
1. Plug the ports tight with protective caps. Determine by inspection that seal bore is in good
condition.
2. Use only Special Tools and not the hammer for
POWER
removing the outer ball joints from knuckle. Clean the seal guide tool and insert it on the input STEERING
shaft covering the serration.
3. Take care to avoid damage to bellows, feed pipe
and input shaft when taking out the steering gear Apply power steering fluid on the input shaft seal and
from the car. slide it down the seal guide tool into the housing bore
with lip facing down. Using seal pressing tool part no.
Mount the steering gear assy. on a mock up bracket 2702 5890 46 05, press the seal till it butts on the
with Input shaft facing upwards. bearing face.
Using circlip plier remove the input shaft seal retaining Using circlip plier compress and engage the circlip in
ring. the bore of the housing. Now remove the circlip plier
Unplug the return port and hold the clean cloth around and using a drift, press the circlip until it locates in the
the input shaft and apply air pressure to the return groove of the housing bore.
port. Reinstall the steering gear on the car.
The air pressure will force out the input shaft seal to
come out of the gear and some fluid will leak out of
the gear.
17
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
PUMP 8
RETURNLINE
PULLEY
INTERMEDIATE ENGINE
JOINT
5
LOCK 9
POWER RACK &
2 NUT
PINION STG. GEAR
1. Looseness in Stg. Joints / Links Check for any interference (or) condition that may
cause the gear to distort due to improper mounting
2. Yoke adjustment in stg. gear. / tightness. Correct if required.
18
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
Fig. 13
19
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
Diagnostic Gauge
Suction line
Intermediate Joint
Return Line
Engine
Fig. 14
GENERAL 2. Steering Gear - Internal leakage
The Diagnostic Gauge is designed to conduct on PREPARATION OF HYDRAULIC SYSTEM
vehicle hydraulic tests in Power Steering System for
a detailed trouble shooting when all other aspects Install Diagnostic Gauge in the pressure line (fluid
checked prove satisfactory. supply line from Pump to Steering Gear).
The Diagnostic Gauge comprises of a PRESSURE Check and top up oil in Reservoir. Bleed the system
GAUGE, FLOW METER, SHUT OFF VALVE AND as per procedure (Refer page 6).
HOSES provided with quick coupling for easy Place a thermometer in the Reservoir to record
connection. Fig. 14 temperature. With the shut off valve of Diagnostic
Using this Diagnostic Gauge, we can check the Gauge fully open, warm up the hydraulic system by
following and compare to specification of the system. partially closing the shut off valve until the pressure
gauge reads 100 PSI (7 bar). When the temperature
1. Pump Performance Check reads 51.70 C and 57.20 C open the valve.
a. Flow The system is now warmed up and ready for
b. Relief Pressure conducting the hydraulic test.
c. Pump response
20
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
21
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
• First key to diagnose a steering problem is to understand exactly what the problems is
• Save a lot of time and work by talking to the customer/driver, understand and verify the problem reported.
• Walk around the vehicle, looking for anything that may be an obvious cause of the problem.
COMMON
COMPLAINTS
22
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
Sensitive to steering Air drawn in due to insufficient fluid Add fluid and bleed the system
wheel speed. per filling and bleeding procedure
More prevalent when Air being sucked in through cracks Replace/correct the crack/
steering fast or loose fittings/hose / pipes in loose fitting , hoses, pipes in
suction line suction line fill and bleed the
system as per procedure
Flow From the pump is less than Repair (or) replace the Pump.
minimum recommended for
steering gear.
Present only in one Unequal tyre pressure Inflate both steered wheels to
direction of turn equal specified pressure. POWER
STEERING
Feed pipe to concerned cylinder is Replace the deformed feed pipe
deformed
Present in both the Low tyre pressure Inflate both steered wheels to
direction of turn equal specified pressure.
Low hydraulic fluid Check and rectify external leak if
any. Top up the oil and
23
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
Present as intermittent Pump drive belt slip or worn out Adjust belt tension or replace belt
loss of power belt and adjust as required
assistance
24
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
Prevalent when Engine idling speed low/erratic Adjust the engine speed for steady
turning at low speeds, tending to stall when the steering idling rpm.
particularly at rough wheel is turned affecting steady
roads or turning at minimum flow from pump.
engine idle speed while
car is stationery. Air in the system or Power If oil level is too low, look for
Steering oil too low. external leak. If any, correct & fill
oil and bleed the system.
Looseness or lash in steering Determine by inspection from
system that may be drifting under steering wheel to steered wheels,
load when turning. links/joints/mountings for
looseness/wear/ crack. Renew/
replace the affected part (s).
Improperly adjusted Steering Gear. Adjust the Rack guide to
May be Rack guide (Yoke) has Specification. If problem is not
backed off excessively or worn. corrected, replace the Steering gear.
Front shock absorber/ Replace the defective shock
suspension strut malfunctioning. absorber/suspension strut.
Vibration / shock / kick Pump stops momentarily due to Adjust the belt tension to
felt when turning the belt slipping on drive pulley. specification.
steering wheel to lock.
POWER
COMPLAINT AS MAY BE NARRATED BY THE CUSTOMER STEERING
REDUCED WHEEL TURN • Very high turning • Not enough turn from centre to lock
radius required
• Wheel cut restricted • Unequal number of turns from centretolock
25
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
26
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
Resistance or binding Poor tyre condition/uneven tyre Replace with good recommended
felt preventing wear/mismatched tyres tyres, inflate to specified pressure
smooth/quick return
of steered wheels
Tyre pressure low or unequal Correct tyre pressure to
specification
Improper wheel alignment Correct wheel alignment to
specification
Binding in steering column Determine by inspection after
disconnecting column from
Steering Gear, the cause for
binding and correct / renew
affected components
Rubbing/interference of any part Determine by inspection the cause
with any other part during steering for rubbing/interference and
movement. correct the same
Improper mounting causing Remove the Steering gear and
distortion to Steering gear. determine by inspection what
interference or condition is causing
the gear to distort and correct the
problem.
Deformed/damaged Feed pipes Replace the Feed pipes
on Steering Gear
Input torque high due to improper Remove the Steering gear. Check POWER
STEERING
adjustment of Steering gear. and adjust Rack guide adjustment
to specification. If the problem is not
corrected, replace the Steering gear.
Binding in Steering axle (Upper/ Determine by inspection and
lower links) renew/replace Steering axles/
links/bushes / ball joints
Insufficient oil flow to steering Repair or replace the Pump if flow
gear for adequate steering speed. is less.
27
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
Determine by inspection,
possibility of air suction through
loose pipe fittings, hose clamping.
Tighten or replace as necessary.
Check Pump shaft seal for
leakages, if any. Fill and bleed the
system.
Squealing noise from Low belt tension or worn out belt Tighten the belt or replace as
pump necessary
Abnormally loud Pump internals excessively worn out or Replace the pump
noise from pump damaged
Rattling or chattering Loose pump pulley Tighten or replace the pulley. If
noise shaft is found damaged, replace
the Pump
Loose or worn steering columns/ Tighten or replace the parts as
intermediate joints necessary
Loose inner or outer ball joints Tighten to replace the parts as
necessary
Rack guide adjustments improper Adjust to specification if not
or disturbed. corrected, replace the Steering
gear
Clicking noise heard Some component is loose and Determine by inspection, tighten or
during a turn or when shifting under load replace if necessary
changing direction
Vibrating Noise Unclamped/Rubbing/damaged/ Determine by inspection and
deformed pipe lines correct or replace if necessary
28
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
29
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
POWER
STEERING
NEXT i
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
CONTENTS
1) Technical Specifications 1
2) List of Special Tools 2
3) Layout Of Power Steering Assembly 3
4) Exploded Views :
a) Hydraulic power steering lines 4
b) Rack and Pinion Assembly 5
c) Assembly power steering pump 6
d) Power steering reservoir 7
5) Power Rack & Pinion Steering System 8
6) Power Rack & Pinion Steering Gear - Operation 9
7) Procedure for filling and bleeding Hydraulic System 12
8) Minor repairs on Power Rack & Pinion Steering Gear 13
a) Replacement of Outer Ball Joint (OBJ) assembly 13
b) Replacement of Bellows 14
c) Replacement of Inner Ball Joint (IBJ) Assembly 15
d) Replacement of Feed Pipes 16
e) Replacement of Input Shaft Seal 17
9) On car Service - Inspection and Maintenance 18
10) Power Steering Gear - Exploded View 19
11) Power Steering System - Hydraulic tests using Diagnostic gauge 20 POWER
STEERING
12) Trouble shooting guide 22
NEXT iii
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Type : Transparent Plastic Reservoir with replaceable filter cartridge(for non ABS)
Metallic Reservoir with replaceable filter cartridge (for ABS)
Capacity : At Max. level - 375 ml At Max. level- 320 ml (for non ABS)
At Min. level - 300 ml At Min. level - 250 ml (for non ABS) POWER
STEERING
Hydraulic fluid : Automatic Transmission Fluid
Lubricants :
Sterak Grease @ Rack & Pinion & Rack Bush : 10 grams
Silicon Grease @ Bellow LIP-IBJ : Smear
1
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
1) Fixture to position steering gear assembly firmly during repair 2779 5890 46 02 N
3) Bellow dolly (2 nos.) to assemble new bellows in to the housing/rack 2779 5890 46 04 N
5) Peening punch to stake the IBJ against a notch on both ends of rack 2779 5890 46 06 N
6) Feed pipe torque wrench to loosen / tighten the flare nut of feed pipe 2779 5890 46 07 N
2
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
STEERING
WHEEL
STEERING
COLUMN
COMBI SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
POWER
STEERING
3
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
22
1.0
21
0.8
1.0
16
14
17
15
2.5
6
18 12
12
19
15
3.5
16
11
10
18
1
3
1.0
4
2
LIST OF PARTS 9 ASSY. RETURN PIPE LINE
10 ASSY.HIGH PRESSURE HOSE (COMPLETE)-RHD
No. Description 11 SEALING WASHER 14X20 IS3175 - CU
1 RUBBER HOSE (SUCTION LINE) 12 PIPE UNION BOLT 10 M14X1.5
1 RUBBER HOSE (SUCTION)-(ABS) 14 O’ RING (HP LINE)
2 SPRING BAND CLAMP FORM-A 15X23D 15 SLEEVE
3 CLAMP 16 CLAMP (FOR 10 DIA PIPE)
4 HEX FL SCREW M6X10 - 8.8 17 HEX FL NUT AM6
5 ASSY.RETURN LINE (P/STG)-RHD (ABS) 18 HEX FL SCREW M6X12 - 8.8
5 ASSY RETURN LINE (POWER STG) 19 ASSY.BRACKET (HP LINE CLAMPING)
6 SPRING BAND CLAMP FORM A 15X19D 21 SPRING WASHER B8 IS3063 SS8451-8C
22 HEX SCREW M8 X 14 - 8.8
Fig.(i)
4
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
BELLOW KIT
RUBBER MOUNT
5.0
BELLOW CLIP
-- SPECIFIED TORQUE IN Kgm
5
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
6
Fig.(iii)
INDEX
POWER STEERING
GROUP INDEX
ITEM NO DESCRIPTION 10 DOWEL PIN (QTY/KIT - 2) 21 RETAINING WASHER
11 VANES (QTY/KIT - 10)
22 SHAFT
12 ROTOR (QTY/KIT - 1)
1 ASSY.POWER STEERING PUMP 13 CAM(QTY/KIT - 1) 23 BALL BEARING
2 HOUSING ASSY. 14 END COVER ASSY.(QTY/KIT - 1) 24 RETAINING RING
3 HOUSING SUB ASSY.(QTY/KIT - 1) 15 SEAL KIT
4 FLOW CONTROL SPRING (QTY/KIT - 1) 25 O’ RING 20 X 2 NITRILE
16 DOUBLE LIP SEAL (QTY/KIT - 1)
26 SUCTION HOUSE CONNECTOR
NEXT
17 O’ RING (FOR PR PLATE ID,QTY/KIT - 1)
5 VALVE ASSY.QTY/KIT - 1) 27 SPRING WASHER B8 IS3073
6 O’ RING (QTY/KIT - 1) 18 O’ RING (FOR PR PLATE ID,QTY/KIT - 1)
19 GASKET (QTY/KIT - 1) 28 THIN HD.CAP SCREW M8 X 16
7 PRESSURE PORT CONNECTOR (QTY/KIT - 1)
PREVIOUS
8 CARTRIDGE ASSY. 20 BOLT FOR END COVER
9 PRESSURE PLATE (QTY/KIT - 1)
POWER STEERING
7
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
ALTERNATOR
BELT
TENSIONER
BOLT
STEERING WHEEL 1
RESERVOIR
COLUMN ASSEMBLY JOINT 7
PRESSURE LINE 8 SUCTION LINE
8
PULLEY PUMP
INTERMEDIATE ENGINE
LINE
RETURN
JOINT
5
2
9
POWER RACK & LOCK
PINION STG. NUT
6
GEAR
The power steering offers the following advantages :- Pump is driven by engine 5PK poly ‘V’ belt.
• Reduces steering effort and driver fatigue The Power Steering Pump provides the hydraulic
assistance for the Power Steering Gear to operate.
• Provides precise steering control.
8
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
BEARING
ROLLER BELLOW
BELLOW CLIP PINION ASSEMBLY INNER BALL
BELLOW STRAP JOINT ASSY
PINION
BALL- BEARING RACK ASSY
RACK TUBE
(CYLINDER)
OUTER BALL JOINT
POWER RACK & PINION STEERING and pinned on housing and the Piston swaged
GEAR Fig. 3 to the Rack. The bore of the steel tube is honed
The Power Rack & Pinion Steering Gear comprise of : for smooth Piston movement.
Manual steering mechanism The two sides of the Cylinder (RH & LH) are
1. Manual steering mechanism is based on proven, connected to the Rotary Control Valve by external
reliable, smooth and lashfree Rack & Pinion feed pipes.
mechanism. OPERATION
The Pinion is supported on Ball & Needle Roller What happens during steering manoeuvre ?
POWER
STEERING
Bearings and the Rack on anti friction bush to
ensure high efficiency and smooth operation and When the driver turns the steering wheel, he transmits
the mechanism is designed to operate manually force from the wheel to steering gear input shaft.
in the event of hydraulic power failure. Input shaft rotation is transmitted to the Pinion through
Rotary control valve (Hydraulic control valve) Torsion bar which is pinned at one end to the Input
2. The Rotary Control Valve combines simplicity of shaft and pressed firmly into the Pinion at the other
construction with desirable performance end.
characteristics that provides responsive steering The Pinion tends to push the Rack linearly through
control. the Rack tube bore.
The input shaft and the valve sleeve constitute But the linear movement of the Rack which is connected
the two members of the Rotary Control Valve. to the steered road wheels through link mechanism is
Power cylinder (Rack Tube) all in a single resisted by the load on the steered wheels.
compact package.
3. Power Cylinder : The built in hydraulic cylinder
is constituted by the strong steel tube press fitted
9
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
OIL IN
LH ROTARY VALVE
CYLINDER RH POSITION
RH CYLINDER
CYLINDER INPUT SHAFT
TORSION BAR
OIL IN
VALVE SLEEVE NEUTRAL
LH
LH
CYLINDER
CYLINDER
RH CYLINDER SHORT FEED PIPE LONG FEED PIPE
OIL IN
TO RH CYLINDER TO LH CYLINDER
SECTION - M VALVE ASSY
(ENLARGED)
OIL IN A A
OIL OUT BELLOW
IBJ
RACK TUBE
RACK (CYLINDER)
Fig. 4
PRESSURE
OIL IN RIGHT TURN
PRESSURE
OIL IN
CW
ROTATION
PRESSURE
OIL IN
RETURN OIL
Fig. 5
10
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
PRESSURE
OIL IN ROTARY VALVE
POSITION
PRESSURE
OIL IN
LEFT TURN
PRESSURE
OIL IN
CCW
ROTATION
PRESSURE
OIL
RETURN OIL
Fig. 6
This resistance offered by the steered wheels on the
Pinion, leads to a definite twist on the Torsion bar
depending on the input torque level.
The Torsion bar twist disturbs the neutral position of
the Rotary Control Valve (input shaft and valve sleeve).
The disturbed Rotary Control Valve directs the oil flow
from the pump to the appropriate side of the cylinder.
POWER
STEERING
The Piston Rack pressurised by the oil, moves in the
required direction overcoming the resistance offered
by the steered wheels and produces the steering
action.
The resistance in the rotation direction of Pinion is
relieved by movement of Piston Rack by hydraulic force
and the reaction of Torsion bar returns the rotary valve
to its neutral position.
The oil flow diagram in neutral, right turn and left turn
positions of the steering gear are shown in. Fig. 4, 5 &
6.
11
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
Raise the front wheel clear off the ground and support
with safety stand.
CAUTION :
Do not allow the oil to run down significantly or run out
of the reservoir. This may induce air into the system.
CAUTION :
Don’t load the system until it is bled properly. Severe
damages could occur otherwise.
12
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
STEERING ARM
BALL PIN NUT
SPANNER
LOCATION
Fig. 7
MINOR REPAIRS ON POWER RACK & REMOVAL OF OUTER BALL JOINTS Fig. 7
PINION & PINION STEERING GEAR Raise the front of the car and support it on a safety
STEERING GEAR stand in the proper location.
This section covers only minor repairs that do not Remove the front wheels
require complete dismantling of steering gear Unscrew the ball pin nut of the Outer ball joint (RH
assembly. side & LH side) and using puller part no. 2702 5890
CAUTION : 4602, remove the Outer ball joint from the steering
arm (knuckle arm). POWER
The minor repairs should be handled only by proper STEERING
trained personnel who have proper equipment, tools, Hold the Inner ball joint with 14mm spanner and loosen
instructions and know-how and authorised to perform the lock nut with 17mm spanner to free the ball joint.
the work properly and safely. Now unscrew the Outer ball joint out of the Inner ball
REPLACEMENT OF OUTER BALL JOINT (OBJ) joint (Tie rod) assembly
ASSEMBLY. Discard the Outer ball joint assembly.
NOTE : ASSEMBLY OF OUTER BALL JOINTS
The outer ball joint assemblies must be replaced if Screw in the new Outer ball joint assembly on the
either of the following conditions are detected. Inner ball joint (Tie rod)
1. Any binding in articulation of the ball pin. Align the steering gear in mid position to straight ahead
2. Any axial play between the ball and cup of Outer position (SAP) of the steered wheels.
ball joint Assy, more than 0.1 mm at + 100 gms. Connect the Outer ball joints with the steering arm
The replacement of Outer ball joint can be done on Tighten the ball nut to specified torque.
the vehicle itself without removing the steering gear Install the front wheels and lower the front of the car.
from the vehicle as explained below : Carry out wheel alignment. Now tighten the outer ball
joint lock nut to specified torque.
13
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
ASSEMBLY OF BELLOW
BELLOW STRAP
BELLOW CLIP
HOUSING
BELLOW
DOLLY
PULL OUT
Fig. 8
REPLACEMENT OF BELLOWS : Fig. 8 Pull out the bellows away from the ends of the steering
gear box along with clip.
For better access and convenience to replace the
bellows properly, remove the steering gear assembly Discard the bellow/strap & clip.
from the car as per procedure in the Mechanical
Clean the outer surface at the ends of the steering
Steering Group of this Manual.
gear and Inner ball joint assembly.
CAUTION :
ASSEMBLY OF BELLOWS
1. Plug the ports tight with protective caps in the
steering gear. Clean the outer surface of the dolly (Taper guide tool)
and insert it on the Inner ball joint Assy.
2. Use only Special Tools and do not hammer to
remove outer ball joints from steering arm Apply grease (dow corning) on the groove of both the
(knuckle arm) tie rods.
3. Take care to avoid damage to bellows, feed pipes Assemble the bellow clip on the small end of the
and input shaft when drawing out the steering bellow.
gear assembly from the car. Keeping the rack in mid gear position slide the bellows
Mount the steering gear on a mock up bracket. on the dolly big end first till the small end of bellow
locates on the greased groove.
REMOVAL OF BELLOWS
Assemble the big end of the bellows over the ends of
Remove the Outer ball joint assembly after loosening the steering gear (Housing & Rack tube) ensuring no
the lock nut. Unscrew out the lock nut (Refer twist to the bellows.
Replacement of Outer ball joint for removal procedure).
Using the strapping gun, strap the big end of the bellow
Remove the bellows straps and discard. firmly to ensure proper sealing.
14
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
RACK
SPUTNIC WRENCH
ASSEMBLY OF IBJ
Fig. 9
Slide the rack to right and left by turning the Input CAUTION :
shaft to be certain that the bellows are not deformed 1. Plug the ports tight with protective caps in the
or twisted. steering gear.
POWER
Screw in the lock nut and Outer ball joint assembly 2. Use only Special Tools and not hammer to STEERING
on the Inner ball joint. Dismount the steering gear remove Outer ball joints from steering arm
assembly from the mock up bracket. (knuckle arm)
Reinstall the steering gear on the car. 3. Take care to avoid damage to bellows, feed pipes
REPLACEMENT OF INNER BALL JOINTS and input shaft When drawing out the steering
ASSEMBLY (IBJ’S). gear assembly from the car.
NOTE : WARNING :
The Inner ball joint assembly must be replaced if either Improper tightening of Inner ball joint assemblies will
of the following conditions is detected. cause accident.
1. Any binding in articulation of the Ball rod (tie rod) Mount the steering gear assembly on a mock up
bracket.
2. Any axial play between the ball and cup of Inner
ball joint assembly, more than 0.1 mm at + 100 Remove the outer ball joints and bellows on the LH
gms. side and RH side of the steering gear (Refer
Replacement of Outer ball joint / Bellows for removal
procedure).
15
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
FEED PIPE
LONG
FEED PIPE
SHORT
FLARE NUT
A/F 11
Fig. 10
Hold the rack suitably to take care not to damage the same and replace with new ones only.
rack surface. Using sputnik wrench, unscrew the Inner
Remove the steering gear assembly from the car.
ball joint assembly from the ends of the rack.
CAUTION :
Discard the Inner ball joint assembly.
1. Plug the ports tight with protective caps in the
ASSEMBLY OF INNER BALL JOINT
steering gear.
Screw in the new Inner ball joint assembly to the ends
2. Use only Special Tools and not hammer to
of the rack by hand.
remove Outer ball joints from steering arm.
Hold the rack suitably taking care not to damage the
3. Take care to avoid damage to bellows, feed pipes
surface. Using Sputnik wrench, tighten the Inner ball
and Input shaft when drawing out the steering
joint assembly to 8 kg-m torque.
gear assembly from the car.
Stake the Inner ball joint (RHS & LHS) using a punch
Carefully unscrew the flare nuts at the ends of
against the notch on both the ends of the rack.
the short/long feed pipes connected to housing
Reassemble the bellows and Outer ball joint (Refer and rack tube ends using 11 mm spanner.
Replacement of Outer ball joint/Bellows).
Discard the feed pipes.
Dismount the steering gear from the mock up bracket.
Blow clean the inside of the new feed pipes (short/
Reinstall the steering gear on the car.
long) with compressed air.
REPLACEMENT OF FEED PIPES (SHORT/
Install the feed pipes (short/long) by screwing
LONG) Fig. 10
the flare nuts at the ends to housing and rack
CAUTION : tube by hand.
Do not attempt to repair any bent or damaged feed Now tighten the flare nuts to 1.7 kg-m torque.
pipes. Whenever feed pipes are removed discard the
Reinstall the steering gear assembly on the car.
16
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
PRESSURE PORT
RETURN PORT
Fig. 11
REPLACEMENT OF INPUT SHAFT SEAL Disconnect the air pressure supply as soon as the
Fig. 11 seal is out.
Remove the steering gear assy. from the car. Discard the seal.
Caution : Wipe the seal bore with a clean cloth.
1. Plug the ports tight with protective caps. Determine by inspection that seal bore is in good
condition.
2. Use only Special Tools and not the hammer for
POWER
removing the outer ball joints from knuckle. Clean the seal guide tool and insert it on the input STEERING
shaft covering the serration.
3. Take care to avoid damage to bellows, feed pipe
and input shaft when taking out the steering gear Apply power steering fluid on the input shaft seal and
from the car. slide it down the seal guide tool into the housing bore
with lip facing down. Using seal pressing tool part no.
Mount the steering gear assy. on a mock up bracket 2702 5890 46 05, press the seal till it butts on the
with Input shaft facing upwards. bearing face.
Using circlip plier remove the input shaft seal retaining Using circlip plier compress and engage the circlip in
ring. the bore of the housing. Now remove the circlip plier
Unplug the return port and hold the clean cloth around and using a drift, press the circlip until it locates in the
the input shaft and apply air pressure to the return groove of the housing bore.
port. Reinstall the steering gear on the car.
The air pressure will force out the input shaft seal to
come out of the gear and some fluid will leak out of
the gear.
17
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
PUMP 8
RETURNLINE
PULLEY
INTERMEDIATE ENGINE
JOINT
5
LOCK 9
POWER RACK &
2 NUT
PINION STG. GEAR
1. Looseness in Stg. Joints / Links Check for any interference (or) condition that may
cause the gear to distort due to improper mounting
2. Yoke adjustment in stg. gear. / tightness. Correct if required.
18
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
Fig. 13
19
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
Diagnostic Gauge
Suction line
Intermediate Joint
Return Line
Engine
Fig. 14
GENERAL 2. Steering Gear - Internal leakage
The Diagnostic Gauge is designed to conduct on PREPARATION OF HYDRAULIC SYSTEM
vehicle hydraulic tests in Power Steering System for
a detailed trouble shooting when all other aspects Install Diagnostic Gauge in the pressure line (fluid
checked prove satisfactory. supply line from Pump to Steering Gear).
The Diagnostic Gauge comprises of a PRESSURE Check and top up oil in Reservoir. Bleed the system
GAUGE, FLOW METER, SHUT OFF VALVE AND as per procedure (Refer page 6).
HOSES provided with quick coupling for easy Place a thermometer in the Reservoir to record
connection. Fig. 14 temperature. With the shut off valve of Diagnostic
Using this Diagnostic Gauge, we can check the Gauge fully open, warm up the hydraulic system by
following and compare to specification of the system. partially closing the shut off valve until the pressure
gauge reads 100 PSI (7 bar). When the temperature
1. Pump Performance Check reads 51.70 C and 57.20 C open the valve.
a. Flow The system is now warmed up and ready for
b. Relief Pressure conducting the hydraulic test.
c. Pump response
20
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
21
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
• First key to diagnose a steering problem is to understand exactly what the problems is
• Save a lot of time and work by talking to the customer/driver, understand and verify the problem reported.
• Walk around the vehicle, looking for anything that may be an obvious cause of the problem.
COMMON
COMPLAINTS
22
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
Sensitive to steering Air drawn in due to insufficient fluid Add fluid and bleed the system
wheel speed. per filling and bleeding procedure
More prevalent when Air being sucked in through cracks Replace/correct the crack/
steering fast or loose fittings/hose / pipes in loose fitting , hoses, pipes in
suction line suction line fill and bleed the
system as per procedure
Flow From the pump is less than Repair (or) replace the Pump.
minimum recommended for
steering gear.
Present only in one Unequal tyre pressure Inflate both steered wheels to
direction of turn equal specified pressure. POWER
STEERING
Feed pipe to concerned cylinder is Replace the deformed feed pipe
deformed
Present in both the Low tyre pressure Inflate both steered wheels to
direction of turn equal specified pressure.
Low hydraulic fluid Check and rectify external leak if
any. Top up the oil and
23
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
Present as intermittent Pump drive belt slip or worn out Adjust belt tension or replace belt
loss of power belt and adjust as required
assistance
24
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
Prevalent when Engine idling speed low/erratic Adjust the engine speed for steady
turning at low speeds, tending to stall when the steering idling rpm.
particularly at rough wheel is turned affecting steady
roads or turning at minimum flow from pump.
engine idle speed while
car is stationery. Air in the system or Power If oil level is too low, look for
Steering oil too low. external leak. If any, correct & fill
oil and bleed the system.
Looseness or lash in steering Determine by inspection from
system that may be drifting under steering wheel to steered wheels,
load when turning. links/joints/mountings for
looseness/wear/ crack. Renew/
replace the affected part (s).
Improperly adjusted Steering Gear. Adjust the Rack guide to
May be Rack guide (Yoke) has Specification. If problem is not
backed off excessively or worn. corrected, replace the Steering gear.
Front shock absorber/ Replace the defective shock
suspension strut malfunctioning. absorber/suspension strut.
Vibration / shock / kick Pump stops momentarily due to Adjust the belt tension to
felt when turning the belt slipping on drive pulley. specification.
steering wheel to lock.
POWER
COMPLAINT AS MAY BE NARRATED BY THE CUSTOMER STEERING
REDUCED WHEEL TURN • Very high turning • Not enough turn from centre to lock
radius required
• Wheel cut restricted • Unequal number of turns from centretolock
25
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
26
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
Resistance or binding Poor tyre condition/uneven tyre Replace with good recommended
felt preventing wear/mismatched tyres tyres, inflate to specified pressure
smooth/quick return
of steered wheels
Tyre pressure low or unequal Correct tyre pressure to
specification
Improper wheel alignment Correct wheel alignment to
specification
Binding in steering column Determine by inspection after
disconnecting column from
Steering Gear, the cause for
binding and correct / renew
affected components
Rubbing/interference of any part Determine by inspection the cause
with any other part during steering for rubbing/interference and
movement. correct the same
Improper mounting causing Remove the Steering gear and
distortion to Steering gear. determine by inspection what
interference or condition is causing
the gear to distort and correct the
problem.
Deformed/damaged Feed pipes Replace the Feed pipes
on Steering Gear
Input torque high due to improper Remove the Steering gear. Check POWER
STEERING
adjustment of Steering gear. and adjust Rack guide adjustment
to specification. If the problem is not
corrected, replace the Steering gear.
Binding in Steering axle (Upper/ Determine by inspection and
lower links) renew/replace Steering axles/
links/bushes / ball joints
Insufficient oil flow to steering Repair or replace the Pump if flow
gear for adequate steering speed. is less.
27
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
Determine by inspection,
possibility of air suction through
loose pipe fittings, hose clamping.
Tighten or replace as necessary.
Check Pump shaft seal for
leakages, if any. Fill and bleed the
system.
Squealing noise from Low belt tension or worn out belt Tighten the belt or replace as
pump necessary
Abnormally loud Pump internals excessively worn out or Replace the pump
noise from pump damaged
Rattling or chattering Loose pump pulley Tighten or replace the pulley. If
noise shaft is found damaged, replace
the Pump
Loose or worn steering columns/ Tighten or replace the parts as
intermediate joints necessary
Loose inner or outer ball joints Tighten to replace the parts as
necessary
Rack guide adjustments improper Adjust to specification if not
or disturbed. corrected, replace the Steering
gear
Clicking noise heard Some component is loose and Determine by inspection, tighten or
during a turn or when shifting under load replace if necessary
changing direction
Vibrating Noise Unclamped/Rubbing/damaged/ Determine by inspection and
deformed pipe lines correct or replace if necessary
28
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
POWER STEERING
29
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
WHEEL AND TYRES
NEXT
GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
WHEELS AND TYRES
WHEELS
AND
TYRES
i
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
WHEELS AND TYRES
CONTENTS
1. Technical specification
a. Tyres 1
b. Wheels 1
2. Tightening Torque 1
3. Exploded Views :
a. Steel Wheel Rim 2
b. Alloy Wheel Rim 3
4. Replacement Instruction
a. Tyres 4
b. Wheels 4
5. How to measure wheel runout 4
6. Matched Tyres and Wheels 5
7. Inflation of tyres 5
8. Tyre rotation 5
9. Tyre mounting and demounting 6
10. Balancing wheels
a. General procedure 7
b. Off-vehicle balancing 7
WHEELS
AND
TYRES
iii
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
WHEELS AND TYRES
SPECIFICATION
TYRES :
WHEELS :
TIGHTENING TORQUE
1. Wheel Bolts 80 Nm
8 kg m
59 Lb. ft
WHEELS
AND
TYRES
1
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
WHEELS AND TYRES
8.0
WHEELS
AND
TYRES
2
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
WHEELS AND TYRES
8.0
WHEELS
AND
TYRES
3
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
WHEELS AND TYRES
Replacement of Tyres :
How to measure wheel runout :
When replacement is necesary, the original equipment
type tyre should be used. Replacement tyres should To measure wheel runout, it is necessary to use an
be of the same size, load range and construction as accurate dial indicator. The tyre may be on or off the
those originally on the vehicle. Use of any other size wheel.The wheel should be installed on a wheel
or type tyre may affect ride, handling, speedometer/ balancer for proper measurement.
odometer calibration, vehicle ground clearance and tyre
clearance to the body chassis. Take measurements of both lateral runout and radial
runout at both inside and outside of the rim flange.
It is recommended that new tyres be installed in pairs With the dial indicator set in place securely, turn the
on the same axle. If necessary to replace only one wheel on full revolution slowly and record every
tyre, it should be paired with the tyre having the most reading of the indicator. (fig 1)
tread, to equalise braking traction. Also do not mix
different types of tyres (viz. radial, bias etc) on the When the measured runout exceeds the specification
same vehicle, because it badly affects the handling of and correction by the balancer adjustment is
the vehicle. impossible, replace the wheel. If the reading is affected
by welding, paint or scratch, it should be ignored.
Replacement of wheels :
Radial Lateral
Wheels must be replaced if they are bent, dented, runout limit runout limit
have excessive lateral or radial runout, air leak through
welds, have elongated bolt holes, if wheel bolts will Steel wheel 1.14 mm 1.4 mm
not stay tight, or if they are heavily rusted. Wheels / alloy wheel (0.045 in) (0.055 in)
with greater runout than specification may cause
vibrations.
WHEELS
AND
TYRES
1.Radial Runout 1
2.Lateral Runout
* Ignore high points due to welds,
scratches, etc.
Fig 1.
4
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
WHEELS AND TYRES
WHEELS
After mounting, inflate to specified pressure so that
AND beads are completely sealed.
TYRES
Warning :
6
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
WHEELS AND TYRES
Warning :
Remove stones from tread, clean the tyre and rim before Fig 5.
balancing for safety to achieve better results.
Off-Vehicle Balancing :
Notes :-
WHEELS
1) Permissible imbalance for assembly tyre with rim, AND
95 gmcm Max. TYRES
7
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
NEXT
GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
INTRODUCTION : The body skin panels of Indica MPFI are made of 0.7 mm
thick coated steel sheet.The four doors and bonnet consist
of inner and outer panels to ensure rigidity.The body shell
design particularly ensures maximum safety of the
occupants during full frontal as well as offset impacts. Side
impact bars have been incorporated in the doors. There
are specially formed impact initiators.They ensure that in
the event of a collision the collapse begins at
predetermined locations and progresses in a predicted
manner. This all goes to make the car totally safe.
BODY
i
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
CONTENTS
A. Tightening torques 1
B. Precautions :
1. Instructions to be followed while removing, installing & handling air bag modules 2
2. Safety Precautions 2
3. General Precautions 3
2. Bonnet lock 5
3. Bonnet hood 5
4. Hood Insulation 7
10. Front window glass, window glass channel and window winding mechanism 11
11. Assembly of glass guide channels, window regulator & window glass of front door 13
iii
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
CONTENTS
D. Body repairs 39
F. Paint care 47
iv
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
A. TIGHTENING TORQUES :
Csk. : Countersunk
BODY
Soc. : Socket
Hex. : Hexagonal
1
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
1. Instructions to be followed while 11. Do not try to open, repair or dismantle the air
removing, installing and handling bag module.
of air bag modules.
12. Do not expose the module to heat or fire.
(Ensure that the battery is disconnected while
working with the air bag /belt pre-tensioners) 13. Always store inactivated modules in a dry, cool
and secure area.
1. Always handle air bag modules with care.
• Follow the above mentioned instructions for the
2. Always wear safety glasses when repairing an belt pre-tensioners as well.
air bag Supplementary Restraint System (SRS)
vehicle and when handling air bag module. 2. SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
3. Carry a live air bag module with air bag Some important precautions need to be taken while
deployment door pointed away from your self and handling air bag units. They are as follows :
others. This will reduce the risk of injury in the
event of an accidental deployment. Service
4. Do not keep a live air bag module with the • The inflator is intended not to fire below the
deployment door faced down. threshold current. To avoid inadverdent triggering
of the air bag, NEVER apply a current through the
5. Do not lift the module by connected wires and squib except with the specified test equipment
cable harnesses. and procedures
6. After deployment, the air bag surface can contain • The system has backup power for about 30
propellent residue. Wash your hands with soap seconds after the battery is disconnected. Wait
and water afterwards. for at least ONE minute after disconnecting the
battery before servicing the vehicle to prevent
7. Never probe the connectors on the air bag module accidental deployment and personal injury.
Doing so can result in air bag deployment which
will lead to personal injury. • Never dispose the air bag module un-deployed
without proper instructions as this may result in
8. Air bag modules with discolored or damaged possible injury. All deployments must follow
deployed doors must be replaced & should not special instructions to be safe. All units shall be
be repainted. activated (deployed) prior to disposal. It is
recommended that the module assembly be
9. To avoid accidental deployment and possible dismantled for recycling of the individual
personal injury, the backup power supply must components. The gas generator after activation
be depleted before repairing or replacing any air can be scrapped as metal or depending on
bag Supplementary Restraint System (SRS) design, recycled for reclamation of steel and
components. To deplete the backup power aluminium. The air bag modules or their
supply energy, disconnect the battery ground components must not be adapted or installed in
cable and wait for one minute. Be sure to any other vehicle other than the specific vehicle
disconnect auxillary batteries and power for which they are designed and manufactured.
supplies (if equipped) as well. Any attempt to adapt or install air bag modules or
their components in any other vehicle can result
10. Do not apply or connect electric current to the in personal injury to the occupants in the event of
module except as specified for installation. Do accidents.
2
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
• Vehicles should not be fitted with additional • If the air bag cover has opened during transport or
protective devices like bull bars etc. handling, the air bag must be returned to the
supplier.
Storage
• Do not attempt to refold the bag into the cover.
• Store air bag module in a dry, cool and secure Deployment protection may be compromised or
area. injury may be induced. This is because foreign
objects could enter the bag, or the vehicle
• Deployed air bags are safe to handle and may be specific bag-folding pattern could be altered from
stored as scrap material or in accordance with its original optimised design.
company policy.
Fire
3. GENERAL PRECAUTIONS
3
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
WHEEL ARCH
A
4
A
2
3
FIRE WALL
1
HOOD RELEASE LEVER
HOOD LATCH
BOWDEN CLIP
SECTION A-A
Fig 1.
C. REMOVAL AND FITMENT : FITMENT :
1. HOOD LATCH CABLE a) Insert the loose end of the cable into the passenger
cabin through the opening in the firewall (2).
REMOVAL : (RHD) Fig 1.
b) Fit the end of the cable to the hood latch release
a) Open the hood (bonnet) and support it on the stay lever (1).
rod.
c) Route the cable to pass along the wheel arch and
b) Remove the end of the cable from the hood latch under the member radiator support top, as shown
release lever (1) in the passenger cabin. in Fig 1.
c) Pull out the cable through the firewall (2) from the d) Fit the loose end of the cable to the hood latch
engine house side (3).
d) Remove the end of the cable from the hood latch e) Finally strap the cable to the bowden clip (ref.
(3). section A - A)and snap the bowden clip to the
e) Unclip the bowden clip (4) and pull the cable free member radiator support (4) as shown in Fig 1
from the vehicle. and section A - A.
4
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
2. BONNET LOCK
REMOVAL :
a) Remove the 2 Nos. of Mounting screws. Fig 2.
b) Pull out the cable from the hook.
c) Take out the lock plate.
FITMENT :
a) Insert the cable in the hook.
b) Also insert the cable cover in the groove. Fig 3
c) Fix the mounting plate on front tie member.
d) Tighten the 2 mounting screws to specified
torque.
e) Operate the bonnet opening lever from inside and Fig 2
ensure that the bonnet pops up properly, if not
loosen the mounting bolts and move the lock in
the oval slots provided in the mounting holes, so
that it opens properly.
f) Apply the recommended grease to the sliding
plates and cable.
Fig 3
3. BONNET HOOD :
REMOVAL :
a) Remove the pipe connection for windshield
washer from the connector. Fig 4
BODY
Fig 4
5
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
Fig 5
NOTE :
Hinges if damaged should be replaced and for removing
the hinges unscrew the 4 mounting bolts (2 in LH and
2 in RH) 5, 6, 7 & 8 and then fit it back Fig 6. 5
6
7
STAY 8
ROD
Fig 6
6
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
HOOD INSULATION
Fig 7
7
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
Sr. No. Preparation on Glass (Windshield & Tailgate) Preparation on Body shell
1. Clean the glass with cleaner Betaseal Clean the Body shell flange area
43518. Allow it to dry completely. conforming to glass with Cleaner Betaseal
Assemble the rubber mould to the glass. 43518. Allow it to dry completely.
2. Apply a thin & even (Approx. 0.5 mm thick Apply a thin and even coat (Approx 0.5 mm
wet layer) of Primer Betaseal 43520A on thick wet layer) of Primer Betaseal
glass. Allow it to dry for minimum 2 minutes. 43533AT on painted surface. Allow it to dry
for minimum 2 minutes.
3. Fill up the mould groove with Sealant
Betaseal 58702 with the applicator gun.
(This sealant at later stage spreads on
glass and mating shell flange area,
when glass is fixed.)
FIg 8
8
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
BODY
Fig 9 Fig 12
9
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
FITMENT :
a) Fit the Trim by pressing from all sides ensuring
that all clips are fixed properly. (Replace damaged
tree clips)
b) Fit back the Door pull handle, Door lock housing,
Speaker cover and the window-winding handle. 1
c) Tighten all the 8 mounting screws.
d) Fit the Inner belt mould back properly in its groove.
NOTE :
Do not Overtighten the Door trim mounting screws.
2 3
8. FRONT DOOR LATCH :
REMOVAL : (Trim already removed)
a) Remove 3 mounting screws at the side of the Fig 13
door for the latch i. e. screw nos.1, 2 & 3 Fig 13
b) Remove the Longer linkage connecting the latch
to Inner Handle from the latch groove after
removing the plastic clip.
LINK FROM
c) Remove the Linkage from latch to link connector. INNER HANDLE
Fig 14 TO THE LATCH
10
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
Extended
Boltable Glass
Guide Channel
Rear Glass
Guide
Channel
Fig. 15
Fig 16
11
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
INNER BELT
OUTER BELT
Fig 17
Fig 18
Fig 19
12
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
10
Fig 20
BODY
11 12
Fig 21
13
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
Fig 22
10
Fig 23
Fig 24
14
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
LINK-2
3
4
5
Fig 26
BODY
15
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
Fig 27a
LOCK NUT
Fig 28
16
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
FRONT OF CAR
GLASS DIVISIONAL
CHANNEL
BODY
Fig 30
17
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
Fig 31
Fig 32
FITMENT :
Follow the reverse procedure of Removal for Fitment. 4
Removal of Striker ( Both For Front and Rear 4
Door) :
a) Unscrew the 2 mounting screws 4 & 5 with
5 mm Allen key. Fig 33 5 5
b) Pull out the striker.
Fig 33
18
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
Fig 33b
1 BODY
3
3
LINK FROM LATCH TO
DOOR OUTER HANDLE
19
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
20
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
REMOVAL: BODY
21
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
Fig b (RHD)
22
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
4 7
6
5
RHD Version
Fig 36
21. DASH BOARD Fig 36 1. DIGITAL CLOCK
(Steering Wheel, Driver airbag, and Floor console 2. FACIA CENTRAL CLUSTER
removed) 3. SPEAKER GRILLS
a) Remove the A pillar trim (LH & RH) Fig 37
4. VENTILATION CONTROLS
b) Remove the 2 bottom mounting screws of the
5. POWER SOCKET
Facia A/c control on Facia central cluster, then
pull out the Facia A/c control. 6. POWER WINDOW SWITCH PACK
A- PILLAR TRIM
BODY
Fig 37
23
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
Fig 40
24
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
TREE CLIP
BODY
GRAB HANDLE
Fig 41 Fig 44
25
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
HEAD RESTRAINT
PLATE PROTECTOR
SIDE VALANCE SPRING RETAINER PLATE
OUTBOARD
STRIKER BUSH INBOARD
ASSY LATCH
26
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
2 PAB SWITCH
3
BODY
FLOOR CONSOLE
HOUSING REAR 5 1
5
CONSOLE MOUNTING
SCREW GROMMET FOR
CONSOLE
MOUNTING
SPRING CLIP
BRACKET FOR CONSOLE MOUNTING
Fig 47
27
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
TAILGATE LATCH
TAILGATE HINGE
TAILGATE LOCK
Fig 48 Fig 49
Fig 51
28
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
FITMENT :
1
a) Insert the cable in the hook of the Tail gate striker. 3
b) Align the Tail gate striker with the holes on the tail
gate sill and tighten the 2 mounting screws
Fig. 52
c) Fix back the striker cover and tighten the 2
mounting screws.
TAILGATE LATCH : 2
REMOVAL :
a) Remove the 3 mounting bolts i. e. bolt nos. 1, 2
& 3 of the Tail gate latch Fig 53.
b) Disconnect the link connecting the latch and the
tail gate lock Fig 54.
FITMENT : Fig 52
a) Insert the Tail gate latch from outside on to the
Tail gate.
b) Connect back the link connecting the lock and
the latch.
c) Tighten the 3 mounting bolts to the specified torque.
TAILGATE LOCK :
(Tailgate trim already removed) LINK CONNECTING
LOCK AND THE LATCH
a) Pull out the Tail gate trim.
b) Disconnect the link from the tail gate latch to the
tail gate lock.
c) Slide out the Lock plate from the panel from inside.
TAIL GATE TRIM
d) Pull out the lock from outside.
FITMENT : TAIL GATE LOCK
a) Insert the lock unit from outside into the tail gate. Fig 53
b) Slide back the lock ring on to the lock unit from
inside the Tail gate panel.
BALANCER :
REMOVAL :
a) Remove the balancer from the tail gate by pulling
it out from the ball pin.
BODY
b) Unscrew the 2 mounting bolts i. e. Bolt nos. 1 &
2 of the Balancer on LH inner side of the d-pillar
Fig 54. 1
c) Similarly remove the other side Balancer.
2
FITMENT :
a) Fit the 2 mounting bolts of the balancer on LH
inner side of the d-pillar.
b) Fix the other end of the balancer (i.e the tail gate
end) on to the ball pin on the tail gate.
Fig 54
29
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
4 1
SECTION A-A
8
T/G SILL
INNER
CUTOUT
9
REINF. REAR QUARTER
Fig 55
30
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
BODY
31
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
Fig 58
32
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
33
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
FRONT BUMPER :
2 2
7 6 5 A B C D F
6 7
E
5
G H I J K
4 3 3 4
View from inside of bumper
Fig 62
d) Next tighten the splash guard and the Bumper
31. FRONT BUMPER : FIG. 62 to the vehicle using mounting screws (3) & (4)
REMOVAL : e) Match the surface of the bumper with the surface
a) Remove the front wheel arch liner on both the left of the fender and then tighten the screws (6) &
hand and right hand side by removing the self (7)
tapping screws (8) f) Tighten all remaining screws (1),(2),(3),(5),(6) &
b) Next remove the bumper by unscrewing the (7) The screws should be loosely fitted.
screws marked (2),(3),(4),(5),(6), & (7) Fig 62. g) Fix the front bumper to the vehicle by using
c) Disconnect the wiring harness connection to the screws (2),(3),(6) & (7) Fig 62. They should be
fog lamps (if fitted) partially tightened.
c) The splash guard if required is removed by h) Next fix the front wheel arch liner (align the holes
removing the screw marked (1) with the mounting locations on the bumper & the
vehicle body) Tighten the bumper to the BIW an
FITMENT :
bumper using self tapping screws (8)
a) First fix the splash guard to the BIW (vehicle body) NOTE :
by partially screwing the screws (1). The screws
should be loosely fitted. The procedure for fitting LH / RH liner is similar.
b) Connect the wiring harness connection to the 31a. GRILL REMOVAL AND FITMENT :
fog lamps (if fitted) a) It can only be removed after removal of front
c) Fix the front bumper to the vehicle by using bumper as it is fitted from inside.
screws (2),(3),(6) & (7) Fig 62. They should be b) To remove unscrew 11 nos. screws (A to K)from
partially tightened. inner side of bumper.
34
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
Fig A
Fig B
Fig C
35
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
1
2
3 10
4 5 6
7
8
8
7
6 5 5 6
10 1 2 3 4 10
7 8 8 7
View from inside of bumper
Fig 63
32. REAR BUMPER : c) Match the bumper surface with the body side
outer surface and then tigten the screws (5)
REMOVAL :
& (6).
a) First remove the rear wheel arch liner by removing
d) Next tighten the remaining screws (1),
the self tapping screws.
(2),(3),(4),(7) & (8) The screws should be loosely
b) Next remove the rear bumper by removing the fitted.
screws marked (1),(2),(3),(4),(5),(6),(7),(8) & (10)
e) Then fix the wheel arch liner (aligning the holes
Fig 63.
of the liner to the corresponding location in the
c) Disconnect the connection of wiring harness to bumper/BIW) by using self tapping screws.
the registration plate lamp before removing the (Procedure for both sides liner fitments are
bumper free. similar).
FITMENT : f) Then fix the wheel arch liner (aligning the holes
a) Connect the wiring harness to the registration of the liner to the corresponding location in the
lamps. bumper/BIW) by using self tapping screws.
(procedure for both sides liner fitments are similar)
b) Fix the rear bumper to the vehicle body using
screws (1),(2),(3) & (4) Fig 63. Keep the screws g) Removal the rub rail by unscrewing 3 screws,
loose (i.e. partially tightened). after removing rear bumper.
36
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
Fig 65
Fig 66
37
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
Fig 66a
Fig 67a
38
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
SIDE VIEW :
P
M
K
39
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
REAR VIEW :
W
Z
X
Y
40
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
PREVIOUS
BODY
TOP VIEW :
B C D E
F
c f
b d
41
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
42
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
REPAIR OF JOINTS INSIDE THE CAR CABIN, ENGINE
COMPARTMENT : Fig. 70
Product recommended : Dinitrol 401 brushable paintable
sealant based on synthetic resin and rubber. The material
should be brushed onto the joints. Allow to dry for two
hours before painting.
Surface preparation : Ensure that the surface is free of oil,
grease, and dust.
Use water & degreaser to clean
Packing : Dinitrol 401 - one kg tin
Fig 70
REPAIR OF CLINCH JOINTS : Fig. 71 & 72
Product recommended : Dinitrol 410 : Polyurethane one
component paintable.
Application : Fit the cartridge into a manual or compressed
air operated gun and apply material onto the joints. The
bead of required size can be achieved by shaping of the
nozzle into the desired shape.
Surface preparation : Ensure that the surface is free of oil,
grease, and dust. Use water & degreaser to clean.
Packing : Dinitrol 410 - 310 ml cartridge.
Fig 71
BODY
Fig 72
43
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
Dinitrol Rockote
Characteristics : Dinitrol Rockote is a quick drying acrylic
stone chip protection product. The grey elastic product
efficiently protects the vehicle body from stone chips and
road salt.
Range of use : Dinitrol Rockote is designed for treatment
of cars, buses, trucks and other vehicles, on line application
as well as in the aftermarket. The product is designed to
protect the most exposed parts such as doorsills, spoilers,
bumpers, wheel arches, edges, under chassis etc.
Application : Dinitrol Rockote can either be applied with
brush, low or high pressure equipment. The spraying is
recommended airless with a product temperature of 15
to 350 C
Technical data dinitrol Rockote
Colour Black/Grey
Type of film Elastic
Density at 230 C 1400 kg/m3
Viscosity at 230 C 1200 mPa s
Dry matter content 66% by weight
Rec. Film thickness 500 mm
Drying time (touch dry) 3 - 4 hrs
Effect on car paint None
Heat resistance >1000C
44
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
Fig 73
Fig 74
BODY
Fig 75
45
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
Fig 77
Fig 78
46
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
E. PAINT CARE
CAUSE FOR CONCERN :
The Tata Indica is painted using contemporary and
state of the art technology to safeguard the body shell
from corrosion. However certain precautions need to
be taken to ensure better care of paint finish and long
term corrosion protection of Indica.
The common causes of corrosion of car are :
• Accumulation of dirt and moisture in hard to reach
areas under the vehicle.
• Paint or underbody chip off due to minor accidents
or due to the impact of stones or gravel against
the painted surface.
Fig 79
Certain environmental conditions or particular
locations where the vehicle is driven may precautions need to be taken.
accelerate the rate of corrosion. Hence special
care needs to be taken to repair any damage to • The underbody must be thoroughly pressure
the paint or protective coating, as soon as washed after every three months.
possible, in such areas. Please be very careful • In case the car is driven near coastal areas or on
in case of the following situations.
salted roads in icy cold winter conditions the
• If the car is driven in areas having hot and sultry underbody must be pressure washed once a
weather. month.
47
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
48
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
49
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
spills onto the painted surface.. In case of such • It is recommended that you wax your Indica after
a spillage immediately rinse the affected area a wash as wax forms a protective layer over the
with water. Avoiding wiping the area as far as painted surface.
possible, however if wiping is required, ensure to
wipe the area gently with soft cotton cloth. • Always keep the drain holes and channels clear
so that water drains off freely and does not
• Avoiding using sharp objects to scrap off tar or accumulate in crevices and box sections.
mud from a painted surface as it may develop
scratches or may peel off the paint. • Any damages in the paint film such as dents
and scratches are prone to corrosion and hence
IN THE FIRST 90 DAYS :
must be rectified immediately.
It is recommended not to wax or polish your Indica in
the first 90 days. This will allow the paint finish to
• A higher salt contents in the air accelerates
completely age and cure. When the car is ready to corrosion in coastal areas and hence more care
wax, do not use silicone containing or super polymer should be taken in case your Indica is driven in
containing waxes or polishes, (e.g. Teflon). Indica's these areas in wet season.
OEM finish does not need such extreme protection
and if the vehicle is involved in an accident, the removal
of such waxes would be time consuming and
expensive. It is advised to use ordinary organic waxes.
"TO DO" LIST FOR INDICA PAINT FINISH CARE IN
RAINY SEASON
CAR BODY :
The exterior of the car is the only line of defence
between the interior and critical components. Not only
that, but most modern cars are monocoque i.e. the
bodies are themselves the load bearing structures.
So making sure they weather the rainy season is not
only an aesthetic reason, it's a pretty good technical
reason too.
The main cause of body and underbody deterioration
is corrosion. Modern cars come with galvanized metal,
rust proofing, etc. but with our fierce monsoons,
additional care needs to be taken. Following
precautions must be taken :
• Do not allow dirt to accumulate on any painted
surface. Water trickles off painted surfaces but
dirt settles on the damp areas and eventually
eats into the paint work. Most corrosion beings
on the inside, so your Indica may need more
than a wash down.
• Wheel-arch's, doorsills and doors are most
susceptible to corrosion and hence special care
needs to be taken to keep these areas clean.
• Do not use household detergents to wash paint
work as they are strong and may affect the metal
and promote corrosion.
50
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
BODY
BODY
51
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
NEXT
GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
i
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
CONTENTS
1. Technical specification 1
2. Tightening Torques 2
3. Schematic Diagram of Airconditioning Cycle 3
4. Layout of A. C. System (BHER) 4
5. Main Parts of A. C. System 5
6. HVAC controls 7
7. Climate Box & Control Panel (BEHR HVAC) 9
8. Removal & fitment of A. C. Components 10
9. Trouble shooting Tips 13
10. Precautions in Handling refrigerant 15
11. Discharging the system refrigerant recovery 16
12. System Charging & Evacuation 17
10. Flushing the system 21
11. A. C. Performance Testing 23
12. Do’s & Don’ts & Safety Tips for A/C system 26
13. Function & inspection of A. C. components 27
14. Trouble shooting 28
AIR
CONDITIONING
iii
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS :
AIR
CONDITIONING
1
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
TIGHTENING TORQUES :
SR. JOINT TIGHTENING TORQUE
NO.
6. R. D. outlet pipe end with ilet end of R. D. to expansion valve inlet pipe. 10 Nm + 10 %
2
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
Fig. 1
SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM OF AIRCONDITIONING CYCLE
INDEX
COLD AIR
Expansion
Valve
LOW TEMP
LOW PRESSURE VAPOUR
Evaporator
AIR CONDITIONING
HIGH
TEMP
HIGH
PRESSURE
GAS
HIGH
Compressor TEMP
HIGH
PRESSURE
LIQUID
TRINARY
Condenser PRESSURE
SWITCH Blower
GROUP INDEX
Condenser Fan
NEXT
ENGINE COMPARTMENT CAB
PREVIOUS
3
AIR
CONDITIONING
4
Fig. 2
LAYOUT OF A.C. SYSTEM (BEHR)
INDEX
Hose suction
Hose discharge
AIR CONDITIONING
Heater
outlet
Magnatic Clutch Servo motor
A. C. Compressor
Heater inlet
with water
valve
Compressor
Mounting Bracket Drain hose Blower motor
GROUP INDEX
Condenser Assembly
Tube liquid
Trinary Pressure
Switch
NEXT
Condenser fan
Receiver Drive
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
5
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
Magnetic clutch :
A magnetic clutch is used to connect and disconnect the
compressor from the engine.
ATTRACTIVE FORCE
Main components are stator, rotor, and pressure plate.
SWITCH
IRON
Principle : (I)
When the current is fed to the coil (as shown fig. on the IRON
(II)
right), magnetic force is generated in iron II which attracts
iron I.
BATTERY
Construction :
A magnetic clutch consists of a stator, rotor with pulley,
and pressure plate to engage the drive pulley and
compressor magnetically.
The stator is fixed on the compressor housing, and the Fig. 3
pressure plate is attached to the compressor shaft.
Two ball bearings are used between the inner surface of STATOR
the rotor and the front housing of the compressor. BALL BEARING
PRESSURE PLATE
Operation : SNAP RING
PULLEY
Fig. 4
ATTRACTED
ELECTROMAGNET
Fig. 5
6
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
HVAC CONTROLS
Fig. 6
HEATING, VENTILATION & AIR CONDITIONING D E
7
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
8
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
NOTE :
Refrigerant charged in the air conditioning circuit has been
identified on the label over front body member. Use only
refrigerant as given in the label for topping up or recharge,
i.e. do not charge R 12 (CFC) in the vehicle earlier charged
with R 134a (Non CFC) or vice versa.
AIR
CONDITIONING
9
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
Blower Assly.
Kinematic Assembly
Heater Outlet
Clip Bowdon Cable (single End)
Bowdon Cable
Distribution Box Assy. Hvac
Temperature
Cabele Movement
Cable Movement Towards Face Mode
Bowdon Cable
Temperature Towards Full Warm
Clip Bowdon Cable
Distribution
Clip
Towards Full Warm
Base Plate
Front Plate
10
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
wiring harness by removing the connectors. Rotate the Mode knob at Foot – Defrost position 8 fit
the plastic clip of Bowden cable (control cable) on
Disconnect the earth terminal while removing the Baseplate Assembly, ensuring proper routing of the
climate box. Remove the hex nuts from the cable through the slot on the bevel gear.
mounting points of the climate box on the fire wall
Check for free rotation of the Mode knob.
and then remove the climate box with drain hose.
11
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
Fit the center cluster connect electrical connection base-plate. In case it is not convenient in some cases,
to PCB and front plate, without breaking the latches. the dashboard should be removed.
Fit 2 screws of the front plate. Ensure that the hazard
Remove the wiring harness connector from the
warning switch connector is connected properly.
resistor.
Connect the refrigerant pipes to Expansion valve
Connect the wiring harness connector to the resistor.
ends. Make sure that o-rings are properly smeared
with lubricant oil before connecting. Fit the dashboard ensuring the routing of both the
bowden cables (control cable) from outside the
Remove the tape from the heater inlet & outlet ends.
vertical support for dashboard.
Connect the hoses to the heater inlet & outlet end.
Fit back the control panel on the dash - board.
Check the system for leakage and charge the
4. Housing Evaporator Assly :
system.
Evaporator housing holds the complete evaporator (cooling
2. Blower Complete :
coil) assembly. When it is required to replace the
Remove the climate box as explained above. evaporator, it is better to replace along with the housing
assembly.
Remove the connector for blower motor, resistor &
anti freeze switch. Replacement procedure :
Remove the screws between the blower housing Remove the climate box from the cabin.
and evaporator housing.
Separate the evaporator housing assly from the
Remove the screws on top side of the blower blower housing assly & distribution housing assly by
assembly. removing the screws between the housing
assemblies
Replace the Blower assembly with a new one & fit
the screws. Replace the Evaporator Housing Assembly with new
one. And assemble with blower housing &
Put the climate box at it’s position.
distribution housing assly, with self tapping screws.
Tighten the nuts at mounting points & the earth
Fit back the climate box assembly in the cabin.
terminal to the firewall.
5. Anti Freeze Switch :
Put the connector to the blower motor, resistor &
antifreeze switch. The function of antifreeze switch is to protect the
refrigerant system from the damage. It switches off the
Fit the dashboard (Refer Climate Box section for
compressor when the water is condensed and forms to
details)
ice on the fins of evaporator. Suction pipe becomes extra
3. Resistor : cool and sometimes iced up, liquid refrigerant remains
after expansion valve due to insufficient heat transfer
The resistor is meant for regulating the speed of the
across the evaporator surface and eventually the
blower as per the user’ s requirement. The speed is in 4
compressor will get damaged due to liquid refrigerant
steps. It has 3 coils in series for regulating the speed of the
inflow.
blower, as per the user’ s requirement. The speed is in 4
steps. NOTE : Please do not tamper the set screw of anti
freeze switch as it is factory set.
It also has a temperature safety fuse. This fuse blows off
when the resistor temperature in creases beyond the Replacement procedure :
permissible limit.
Remove the wiring harness connector from the anti
Replacement procedure : freeze switch.
Remove the Control panel base plate (Refer Climate Remove the mounting screws from mounting
Box removal for details). bracket on the housing evaporator assembly.
Resistor becomes accessible through the opening Remove the probe carefully from the Evaporator
in the dash – board after removing the control panel core.
12
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
NOTE : The feeler is a capillary tube and must Fit the Base-plate Assembly & Front-plate as.
not be bent or twisted sharply as it may
9. Rotary Knob for Mode :
damage the unit.
Remove the Base-plate Assembly.
The feeler of the new switch must be inserted to
the same depth that is 100 mm and the remaining Pull out the knob by slightly flexible the snap-fits &
bend to be made so as to keep the feeler as close as replace it with a new one.
possible to the housing.
Fit the Base-plate Assembly Front-plate.
6. Housing Distribution Assembly :
10. Rotary Knob for Blower switch :
Remove the climate box .
Remove the front-plate by removing the 2 screws
Separate the distribution housing from the entire from the bottom.
assembly by removing the screws between the
Gently pull the knob of blower switch & replace it
Housing Evaporator assembly and the Housing
with new one.
Distribution assembly.
Put the front-plate in it’s position 8 tighten the 2
Replace the Housing distribution assembly.
screws.
Fit the new Housing Distribution Assembly to the
11. Lamp Assembly :
Housing Evaporator assembly with the help of
screws. Remove the Base-plate Assembly.
7. Kinematic Assembly : Disconnect the connector of lamp assly and pull out
the three lamp holders from the Base - plate, replace
Kinematic assembly controls the flap movement and
with new lamp assly and connect the connector.
distributes the air as required at different outlets.
Wires of the lamp assly should be snap-fitted into
Replacement procedure : the wire clips.
Remove the Bowden cable (control cable) holding Fit the Base - plate Assembly & Front-plate.
clip on the kinematic base plate with a nose plier
12. Lamp (Bulb) :
and remove the eyelet of Bowden cable (control
cable) from gear partly. Remove the front-plate by removing the 2 screws
from the bottom.
Remove the mounting screws from the kinematic
base plate that is fitted on the Distribution Housing. Gently pull out the bulb and fix the new bulb with
blue caps.
Replace the Kinematic Assembly with a new one.
Put the front-plate in it’s position & tighten the 2
Keep the Mode knob at Defrost position & put the
screws.
eyelet of the cable on gear partly.
Re - Installing the original Compressor :
Now fit the Bowden cable (control cable) on the
Kinematic baseplate with the clip. Oil should be changed at the time of re-installing the
original compressor. Drain and measure the refrigerant oil
8. Control Panel Assembly :
contained in the compressor. Charge oil through the
In each switching position 1 to 4, It should show discharge port of the compressor with the same amount
continuity between the respective terminal and the of new refrigerant oil.
ground.
NOTE :
Remove the Base-plate Assembly (Refer Climate Box AIR
In case for some reasons the flushing is not possible, ensure CONDITIONING
removal ).
that the complete system contains 120 ml oil.
Pull out the blower knob.
Remove the electrical connector from the blower
switch and pull out the blower switch by flexing the
snap-fits and fix the new switch.
13
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
Installing a New Compressor : Drain and measure the TROUBLE SHOOTING TIPS
compressor oil from the original compressor.
The most basic and important element of effective trouble
Drain the oil quantity equal to Tolal oil – Drained oil from shooting is safety.
the new compressor (New compressor comes with 120
ml of oil). The basic steps are:
Note: In case of sudden refrigerant leakage on any Before attempting any troubleshooting procedure, learn
of the A. C. component, it is recommended to flush the Operating sequence of the unit.
the system completely and then ensure that the Most refrigerant - side problems, if permitted to continue
complete A. C. system contains 120 ml compressor result in compressor failure. For example, an overcharged
oil. system would lead to eventual premature compressor
failure.
Unless the root cause is determined the next compressor
is also doomed to fail,
Many problems produce similar symptoms. If cooling is
not sufficient, the possible causes, could be :
1. Condenser dirty
2. Fan direction reverse
3. System over / under charged
14
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
15
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
Connect gauge manifold in the system before AC system DO NOT ATTEMPT TO TREAT YOURSELF
is made operational through quick couplers.
2. Always use proper workshop practices, do not bypass
This will enable you to record suction & discharge agreed practices
pressures.
3. Always work in a well ventilated area
Based on gauge pressure observations & with the help of
4. Avoid skin contact, as R134a will cause frost bite on
chart given in this manual try to locate the problem.
contact with bare skin
PRECAUTIONS IN HANDLING 5. Do not abuse the refrigerant cylinder, or any other
REFRIGERANT tools you may need to use
Refrigerant (R134a) 6. Do not weld or steam clean on or near any air
(Tetra flouroethane, CF3-CH2F) conditioning components when pressurized.This may
Specifications : HFC 134a cause a dangerous pressure build up in the system.
CH2 F CF3 7. Do not discharge refrigerant into an enclosed area.
Oil : Mineral oil ND - 8
8. When purging a system, discharge the refrigerant
Care should be taken when discharging the air conditioning slowly.
system to ensure the refrigerant is not released to the
atmosphere but captured for recycling. Environment & 9. If it is necessary to transport or carry a cylinder of
friendly refrigerant R134a is not an ozone depleting refrigerant in a car, keep it in a luggage compartment.
substance but its release would add to the green house 10. Refrigerant cylinders should always be protected
warming effect. from the radiant heat of the sun & keep in a cool
Refrigerant R134a is transparent and colourless in both place.
the gaseous and liquid states. At all normal temperatures 11. When filling a refrigerant cylinder, never completely
and pressures it will be a vapour. The vapour is heavier fill it. Always leave space for expansion. If the cylinder
than air and is non - flammable, non-explosive, non- was completely filled and the temperatures
poisonous and non-corrosive (except when in contact increased, hydraulic pressure with its tremendous
with moisture). force would result, leading to cylinder bursting
The following precautions in handling R134a should be accidents.
observed at all times : 12. Never discharge a system or do brazing / welding /
NOTE : operation when the main engine is on.
R134a and R 12 are not compatible and must never 13. Do not drop, dent or abuse refrigerant gas cylinders.
be mixed. 14. Always chain or strap cylinders in place to prevent
l. Always use safety glasses and gloves when handling them from tripping over or damage, from moving
or servicing air conditioning systems. If R 134a does around.
enter the eye, freezing of the eye can occur and could 15. Always keep the cylinders capped.
result in blindness. The procedure outlined below is
16. Never heat a cylinder with open flame or place electric
suggested if R 134a enters the eye.
heater in direct contact.
a. Keep calm.
17. Always double check that you have proper refrigerant
b. Do not rub eyes. container. The refrigerant cylinders are colour coded
c. Splash large quantities of cool water into the eyes to avoid confusion. R 134a is BLUE.
to increase the temperature 18. Use proper size spanners, wrenches to avoid damages
d. Tape a sterile eye patch in place to prevent dirt to valve & threads.
from entering the eye
e. Go immediately to a doctor or hospital for
professional care
16
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
3 4
5
2
Fig 11
DISCHARGING THE SYSTEM 4. The automatic recovery unit will operate until the air
REFRIGERANT RECOVERY conditioning system has been emptied of refrigerant
down to atmosphere pressure. The cylinder can now
Various Refrigerant Recovery Units ( RRU ) are now be closed.
available. The following procedure is typical for the use of
these units when recovering refrigerant from a car air 5. Measure the amount of PAG (Poly Alkaline Glycol) oil
conditioning system. removed from the A/C system. This oil is normally
separated from the incoming refrigerant into the RRU.
1. Connect the RRU outlet to an R 134a recovery cylinder New clean PAG oil must be added into the system
with a refrigerant hose and open the valve on the before recharging with refrigerant.
cylinder. Ensure that the cylinder has sufficient
capacity to hold the refrigerant in the system to be
serviced. This can be confirmed by weighing the
cylinder or by referring to the volume gauge if fitted.
2. Connect a gauge manifold set to the car air
conditioner. Connect to both the suction and
discharge sides of the system. Connect the centre
hose of the gauge set to the inlet of the recovery unit.
Connect the RRU to electrical supply. AIR
CONDITIONING
3. Open the gauge set and quickly connect stop taps to
allow refrigerant to enter the RRU via the centre hose.
At this point, depending on which unit is being used,
the RRU will switch on. If the RRU is-not the automated
type, switch the unit on.
17
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
SYSTEM CHARGING AND EVACUATION Charging the system includes the following steps :-
The following equipment is required for system charging 1. Filling charging cylinder
and evacuation procedures. 2. Evacuation and leak test
1. The refrigerant calibration charging cylinder or 3. Charging system
weighing device.
4. Performance test
2. Pressure gauges and hoses.
3. Vacuum pump FILLING A DIAL-A-CHARGE- CYLINDER
4. Refrigerant Recovery Unit (including compressor oil 1. Open valve on bottom of charging cylinder,
collector ) allowing refrigerant to enter cylinder from storage
cylinder.
5. Electronic leak detector
2. Bleed cylinder via valve on top (behind pressure
CAUTION :
gauge) as required to allow refrigerant to enter. This
The wearing of safety goggles and gloves is mandatory valve should be connected via a hose to a Refrigerant
during system charging or discharging. Recovery Unit ( RRU ) and recovery cylinder. When
refrigerant reaches the desired level, close valve at
NOTE :
bottom of cylinder and be certain that bleed valve is
All hoses at point of connection to the system must have securely closed.
isolation valves fitted.
1
6 7
8
2
5
4
3
Fig 12
18
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
19
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
20
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
OPEN HIGH SIDE VALVES &
ALLOW AS MUCH AS
EVACUATION- REFRIGERANT AS POSSIBLE
CONNECT CHARGING TO ENTER SYSTEM, BUT
STATION NOT MORE THAN SPECIFIED
21
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
INVERTED DECANTING
FLUSH GUN CYLINDER (LIQUID)
FLUSH, THEN
REVERSE FLUSH
RECOVERY DEVICE
SELF MADE
FITTING
CONDENSER
Fig 14
22
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
FAULTY
COMPRESSOR DRAIN PLUG NEW E.G. 100 cc
COMPRESSOR INSTALLED
E.G. 100 cc
REMOVED NEW
COMPRSSOR
Reinstalling the original Compressor Drain as much of the original oil as possible from the
evaporator or condenser. Add the same amount of new
1. Drain and measure the refrigerant oil contained in refrigerant oil, either to the original or new evaporator or
the compressor. condenser.
2. Charge oil through the discharge port of the If replacing condenser - add approximately 20 cc oil.
compressor with the same amount of new refrigerant
oil. If replacing evaporator - add approximately 20 cc oil.
If the amount of oil in the original compressor was not If replacing the FDR - add approximately 20 cc oil
checked, then approximately 120 cc of new oil should be The FDR must be replaced whenever the system has been
added to the compressor being installed. (This is assuming opened to the atmosphere for repair.
the compressor being installed has first been drained).
Blown or Ruptured Pipe / Hose
Installing a New Compressor
When replacement is required add approximately
1. Drain and measure refrigerant oil from the original 10 cc oil each. If slow leak through any joint.
compressor drain plug.
2. Drain factory installed refrigerant oil from new
compressor drain plug (total lubricant quantity 265
cc).
AIR
3. Measure the same amount of new refrigerant oil that CONDITIONING
23
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
Ambient temperature 0
c
Grill Temperature
1 2 3 4
Average grill temperature - (1+2+3+4)/4 = ____0 C*
* Performance is satisfactory if temperature measurement is within range as shown in graph 1
24
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
PROCEDURE :
NOTE : Initially, conduct open door test and then
close door test.
Insert temperature probe into dash vents as
shown in Fig. 16. The probe MUST NOT exceed
50 mm.
Keep all dash vents open & facing straight
ahead position.
STEP 1 Park vehicle in shade, with bonnet hood closed.
STEP 2 a. Open all the doors for open door test.
b. Close the all doors & windows for close
door test.
STEP 3 Check the ambient temperature
Place a thermometer in the centre dash vents.
STEP 4 Connect both high & low pressure gauges to Fig 16
system.
STEP 5 Start the engine and switch ON the A. C.
STEP 6 Select the following :
Mode Knob : Full Face Position
Blower Switch Knob : On 4th speed.
Fresh/Recirculation Switch :
Fresh air mode for open door test
Recirculation mode for closed door test.
Temperature Control Knob : Full coldest
position.
STEP 7 Increase the engine speed to approx. 1500
rpm
STEP 8 Record readings on high & low gauges (only
whilst compressor running)
Compare high pressure (Pd) & low pressure
(Ps) with dotted area in graph 2. If the point
falls outside dotted area, refer Trouble Shoot-
ing chart.
STEP 9 Check centre grill temp. ofter 10 min. as
shown in figure :
A. If it is open door test : The drop in average
grill temperature with reference to
ambient temperature should be 15 0C
minimum within 10 minutes (Fresh Air
Mode), i. e. the point should fall in dotted Variation of Centre Grill Temp. for Open Door Test.
area as shown in Graph 1. If it is not refer
Graph 1 AIR
trouble shooting chart for further CONDITIONING
25
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
Graph 2
26
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
3. Add Recommended oil & Quantity in Adequate Quantity of Compressor oil prevents
the compressor during refrigerant charging. poor pumping and premature wearing of internal
components.
4. Clean evaporator periodically to Clogged evaporator results in less air flow and
remove dust and foreign particles. reduced cooling.
5. Educate Customer on proper usage Proper usage of AC control will give optimum
of AC controls cooling
(Refer owners manual)
6. Adjust proper engine rpm. Less rpm will result in stalling of engine and less
cooling.
7. Check coolant level and ensure proper This will prevent overheating of engine.
engine tuning
8. Check proper belt tension. Loose belt will slip and over tight belt will result
in noise and premature failure of magnetic
clutch of the compressor.
2. Do not leak check the AC system with Higher pressure may result in damage
more than 20 kg / cm2 pressure. To AC components.
3. Do not Leave AC joints open. Moisture tends to enter the AC system if the
joints remain open for long time.
27
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
28
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
3. LOW SIDE - High Expansion valve stuck open. Change expansion valve
HIGH SIDE - High
PS > 3 kg / cm2
Pd > 25 kg / cm2
Frosting on the Suction side piping.
5. LOW SIDE GAUGE - Low or Vacuum Expansion valve stuck closed / 1. Remove refrigerant
HIGH SIDE - High or / insufficient refrigerant flow 2. Evacuate / dehydrate
PS < 3 kg / cm2 to Vacuum to suction side of compressor. 3. Change filter drier
Pd > 25 kg / cm2 Foreign material or moisture 4. Charge correct
DISCHARGE AIR - slightly cool entry causing rust formation. amount of oil & refrigerant
5. Check performance
AIR
CONDITIONING
29
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
HIGH SIDE TUBES - Cool and showing to suction (low) side of 5. Check performance
signs of sweating or moisture build up compressor.
at the position after the point of
restriction. Temperature difference
found on the both the sides of the
clogged component.
7. LOW SIDE GAUGE - Normal to Vacuum Excessive moisture in the 1. Remove refrigerant
(Gradual reduction) system. 2. Evacuate / dehydrate
HIGH SIDE GAUGE - Normal Moisture can freeze within the 3. Change expansion valve (check)
PS 3 kg / cm2 to Vacuum expansion valve and cause 4. Change filter drier
Pd 14 to 16 kg / cm2 blockages through rust 5. Charge correct
DISCHARGE AIR- Becomes warmer as formation. amount of oil & refrigerant
low side cycles to a Vacuum. 6. Check performance
30
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
Note : All Ps, Pd values mentioned in trouble shooting chart are for ambient temp. 350C, for other ambients, refer
graph 2 .
AIR
CONDITIONING
31
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
2 ASSY BASEPLATE HVAC CONTROLS COMPLETE BEHR 7 ASSY PCB FOR HVAC CONTROL PANEL
5 KNOB (MODE & F/R & TEMP) -BEHR 10 FACIA HVAC CONTROLS (BEHR)
32
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
1 ASSY HVAC UNIT COMPLETE RHD BEHR 11 O’RING (ID 14.0 x 1.78 THK)-BEHR
2 ASSY.BLOWER COMPLT (BEHR) 12 ASSY THERMOSTAT -BEHR
3 FRESH/RECIRC SERVO MOTOR DLX M/S BEHR 14 ASSY KINEMATIC LINKAGES
4 PLASTIC CONNECTING ROD FOR MICRO MOTOR BEHR (DISTRIBUTION CONTROL) AIR
CONDITIONING
6 ASSY EVAPORATOR UNIT RHD BEHR 15 ASSY CABLE (MODES CONTROL) BEHR
7 ASSY BLOWER RESISTOR (4-SPEED) M/S BEHR 16 CLIP BOWDEN CABLE SINGLE END (BEHR)
9 ASSY BLOCK VALVE 2T FINAL (324335)-BEHR 17 ASSY CABLE (TEMPERATURE CONTROL) BEHR
10 O’RING (ID 11.10 x 1.78 THK)-BEHR 18 ASSY W/H CABIN COOLING DLX M/S BEHR
33
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
A C PIPING
1 ASSY HOSE SUCTION COMPLT. PL (110CC)-(BEHR) 8 O’RING (ID 10.77 x 2.62 THK)-BEHR
2 ASSY HOSE SUCTION 110CC PL BEHR 9 O’RING (ID 140 x 178 THK)-BEHR
3 ASSY CLAMP HOSE SUCTION BEHR 10 CLAMP -HOSE DISCHARGE (CONDENSER END)
4 O’RING (ID 17.17 x 1.78 THK)-BEHR 11 ASSY TUBE LIQUID WITH CLAMP BEHR
5 O’RING (ID 13.94 x 2.62 THK)-BEHR 12 ASSY TUBE LIQUID (BEHR)
6 ASSY HOSE DISCHARGE WITH CLAMP 110CC 13 O’RING (ID 765x178THK)- BEHR
7 ASSY HOSE DISCHARGE 110CC 14 CLAMP (TUBE LIQUID)-BEHR
34
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
4 CONDENSER SIDE SEALING RH BEHR 10 TRINARY PRESSURE SWITCH (SEDAN) M/S BEHR
5 CONDENSER SIDE SEALING LH BEHR 11 ASSY R/D MTG BKT BEHR
6 ASSY TUBE LIQUID R/D INLET (BEHR)
35
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIR CONDITIONING
1 ASSY MF CONDENSER + FAN BEHR 5 ASSY COND FAN SHROUD (WITHOUT FAN)-BEHR
2 ASSY MF CONDENSER CORE (BEHR) 6 ASSY CONDENSER FAN MOTOR (IFB) M/S BEHR
3 ASSY CONDENSER FAN 110W - BEHR 7 HEX FL NUT AM6 TS17430-8-SS8451-8C
4 CONDENSER FAN BLADE 110W - BEHR 8 HEX NUT M6LH IS 13164-P3-8-SS8451-8C
36
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
NEXT
GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
ELECTRICAL
i
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
CONTENTS
Sr. No. Description Page No.
iii
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
iv
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
GROUND
OR MAGNETIC
EARTH BATTERY
CLUTCH
CROSSOVER
TWO WAY WITHOUT HORN
SWITCH JOINT
FUSE LAMP / BULB
STEERING LOCK CUM IGN. SWITCH
RESISTOR
M MOTOR
LED LOCK ACC. IG. START
(A) (B)
VARIABLE M WIPER
RESISTOR MOTOR
RELAY
THERMISTOR
M W/S WASHER
0
t MOTOR
(E) (C)(D)
CIGARETTE G
3 ALTERNATOR J B G
LIGHTER ELECTRONIC
A D C CONTROLLER /
H E F RELAY BASE
HEATER BLOWER
M
DEFROSTER MOTOR VIEW FROM
CABLE ENTRY
SOLENOID
VALVE COUPLER BUZZER
(A)
(D)
ELECTRONIC FAN THERMOSTAT ELECTRICAL
CONTROLLER SW.
(J)
(B)
(C) (E)
1
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
8. Position Lamp Rear 12V, 5 W (of 21/5W Bulb) BAY 15D CAP 2 Nos.
9. Stop Signal Lamp 12V, 21W (of 21/5W Bulb) BAY 15D CAP 2 Nos.
10. Reverse Signal Lamp 12V, 21W BA 15S CAP 2 Nos.
11. Rear Fog Lamp 12V, 21W BA 15S CAP 2 Nos.
12. Roof Lamp 12V, 10 W Festoon Bulb 1 No.
13. Front Fog Lamp 12V, 55 W H3 - (55W) 2 No.
2
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Fig. 2
ELECTRICAL
Fig. 3
3
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
A. C.
COMPRESSOR 8-9
mm
TENSIONER
POWER STEERING
PUMP
Fig. 4 Schematic
4
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
ELECTRICAL
5
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
6. INSTRUMENTS CLUSTER
INDICATOR GAUGES :
Remove steering wheel as per procedure given UPPER NACELLE
in ‘BODY’ section. Refer to safety precautions
relating to Airbags.
Removal of Instrument Cluster
1) Remove the upper steering nacelle and then the
lower steering nacelle. Fig.7 by removing 3
screws (The upper and lower nacelle can be
removed without removing the steering wheel LOWER NACELLE
also)
2) Unscrew the two screw on the front bezel and
remove the rear bezel. Then remove the front
bezel by removing two front screws. Fig.8 Fig. 7
3) Remove the mounting screws on the Instrument
cluster. Fig.9
4) Disconnect the connectors from behind the
cluster.
5) Take out the Instrument cluster.
Installation of the instrument cluster
Follow the steps given above in the reverse order.
Note :-
Cluster is supplied as a single unit. Please do not attempt
to dismantle.
Fig. 8
Fig. 9
6
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
SPEEDOMETER, MAIN ODOMETER AND TRIPMETER
(ON LCD) :
The speedometer indicates the car speed in km/hr. The
odometer records the total distance the car has been
driven.The tripmeter can be used to measure the distance
travelled on each trip or between fuel fillings.
7
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
8
Petrol
INDEX
ELECTRICAL
GROUP INDEX
Set Knob Fuel Gauge
Mode Selector Knob
Temperature
Gauge LCD
NEXT
* All indicators and Chrome ring may not be provided on some clusters.
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Head Lamps, Front Parking Lamps and Front HEAD LAMP TOP SIDE OF HEAD
MOUNTING LAMP
Turn Signal Lamps LUG
Removal of Head Lamp Assembly & Head Lamp
Bulb
1. Remove the front bumper as per procedure given
in Body Section Fig.11
2. Remove the connectors for head lamp, parking
lamp and front turn signal lamp
3. Remove the two flange screws on top of the head
lamp and the nut behind it Fig.10 BULB FOR HEAD
LAMP DIREC- DIRECTION
HEAD LAMP BULB TION LAMP
4. Take out the head lamp assembly. RETAINER CLIP LAMP HOLDER
5. Remove the rubber cap & take out the retaining Fig. 10
clip. Then take out the bulb.
Installation of head lamp
Follow the steps given above in the reverse order.
Inspection of head lamp
1. Check the connectors for any loose terminals or
wires broken at the term. ends.
2. See if any of the filaments in the bulbs is blown.
Replace faulty bulbs
3. Check if the lens or reflectors is damaged. Re-
place head lamp if it is so.
For connections refer the schematic circuit for Head
lamps, Parking lamps, Fog lamps.
Fig. 11
ELECTRICAL
9
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Fig. 12
Fig. 13
10
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
ELECTRICAL
Fig. 14
11
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
SIDE REPEATER
LAMP
Fig. 17
12
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Removal
Remove the 4 screws which hold the 2 lamps on to
the rear bumper and take out.
Remove the electrical connection from the lamp.
Fig. 18
Installation
Hold the lamp in position under the rear bumper and
tighten the two screws.
Roof Lamp Fig. 19
Removal
Pull the roof lamp from the roof lamp mounting bracket Fig. 19
till the catches are released.
Remove the electrical connections from the lamp and
+ 12V
take it out. +
Installation
(12V 5W
(12V 10W)
Insert the lamp into the cut-out in the roof molding 2 NOS.)
and press till the catches are engaged.
A schematic circuit diagram showing the Roof lamp
OFF
is given in Fig. 20 & 20a
The connectors for the roof lamp are as shown in
Fig. 20a OFF
ON
DOOR
Fig. 20
TERMINALS
ELECTRICAL
13
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
14
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
8. WIPER SYSTEM :
Front wiper system :
Front wiper controller :
Function :
It generates the variable time delay during the
Intermittent wipe operation of the wipers on the
vehicles.
Location
Near steering column ( Refer Fig.1) In cabin fuse box.
Connection details Fig. 22 & 23
C Input Wiper motor park Sw. Com. VCC/GND Wiper moving/Wiper park
Performance check :
• When the intermittent input (Ter. D) goes high,
Ter. A should get connected to Ter.B for one wipe
cycle (The unit assumes the wipe cycle is
completed when Ter.C goes to GND from VCC
level). Then for time ‘t’ seconds (the time should
vary from 2 to 15 second with the resister R
varying from 0 to 64 K). (Varied by knob provided
on combi switch on RHS ).Ter. A and B should
ELECTRICAL
be disconnected. Again Ter.A and B get
connected for one wipe cycle. This cycle
continues as long as Ter.D is high.
Fig. 23
15
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
• When wash input (J) becomes active, output Ter. WIPER ARM
A should get connected to terminal B after 0.7 MOUNTING NUTS
WIPER ARM
sec. (Delay provided for water to reach from the
nozzle to glass) and when Ter. J goes low Ter. A
gets disconnected from Ter. B after 2 sec. The
wash should have higher priority than the
intermittent signal.
Alternately use the test rig for Front wiper control
unit (Part No. 2699 5420 9928) and check the
proper functioning. WIPER MOTOR
LEAF SCREEN MOUNTING
Removal of front wiper system BRACKET
16
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
OK NOT OK TO
WINDSHIELD OL
GLASS WINDSHIELD
GLASS
Fig. 26
FLEXER
CLAW CRIMPING
Fig. 27
LUBRICATION
AREA ELECTRICAL
(ONE DROP
EACH)
Fig. 28
17
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Windscreen Wash
Removal
1) Disconnect the battery negative cable
2) Remove the front bumper
3) Disconnect the windscreen washer tube from the WASHER BOTTLE
bottle.
Disconnect the connector to front windscreen washer
pump and take out the front wash pump from the wash
bottle.
4) Unscrew the bolts holding the washer bottle
bracket and take out the bottle along with the
bracket. Fig. 29
Installation Fig. 29
Follow the above steps in the reverse sequence.
Inspection
Connect the battery positive and negative terminals to
washer motor positive and negative terminals and
check if it is working properly.
Check the bottle for cracks and leakages if any.
For circuit diagram of the Windscreen washer refer
wiring diagram section.
NOTE :
Where there are 2 motors mounted on the Washer
bottle, one is for front and the other is for rear washer.
The rear washer tube is enclosed in the floor wiring
harness.
18
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
ELECTRICAL
19
NEXT
INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
FRAME RADIATOR
SUPPORT
HORN MOUNTING
BRACKET
HORN
HEX PL SCREW
ASSY. BRACKET
HEX FL NUT
HEX SCREW
Fig. 31
Fig. 33
20
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Performance check
Sound : Sound output should not show a
cracking sound. Tone should be good
for entire voltage range.
Buzzer type : Beep at the rate of 1 beep/second.
ELECTRICAL
21
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
• If the keyless entry or central locking functions b) Remove door inner trim. (Refer Body group in
this manual). Open out required portion of plastic
are found inoperative, check if the LED on the
membrane.
user remote is blinking when the LOCK/UNLOCK
buttons are pressed. If so, replace the battery in c) Disconnect electrical connectors of master cum
the user remote. If user remote is O.K. check for follower.
proper fitment of connectors and relays at the
control unit. If these are O.K. replace relays first,
followed by control module.
22
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Fig. 37
23
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Connection details :
Ter. Ter. Description Active Level Condition
Name Type
24
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
- +
ALTERNATOR
L2
L1
S3
! P +ve
S1 •
• Vcc
EARTH
Fig. 39
ELECTRICAL
25
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Performance check
INPUT OUTPUT
KEY IGN KEY IN DRVER PARKING LAMP SEAT BELT
POSITION POSITION DOOR SW. SWITCH SWITCH
26
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
15aK A
50
Steering Column
15
400 900
P
250
For removal of steering lock cum ignition switch, refer IGN
OFF
Mechanical steering group of this manual.For circuit FOR TERMINAL DETAILS, REFER
connections, refer Fig. 42 and wiring diagram section. THE TABLE GIVEN BELOW
Fig. 42
Connection details :
15 - 30
50 - 30
15a- 30
P - 30
KA - 30
KA - 30
THIS REQUIREMENT
ELECTRICAL CONNECTION MUST EXIST. MUST BE MET WHEN
KEY IS ROTATED FROM
LOCK TOWARD OFF
ELECTRICAL CONNECTION CAN EXIST. POSITION.
27
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
POSITION
Key out Key in
LOCK LOCK ACC. IGN CRANK
Key in sensor
TERMINALS
Battery
Accessories
Ignition
Crank
Key rotation forward Steering Steering Steering Steering Steering
Locked Locked Free Free Free
Key rotation backward Steering Steering Steering Steering Steering
Locked Free Free Free Free
Fig. 44
28
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
ELECTRICAL
Fig. 45
29
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Fig. 47
TER. 5
TER. 4
FREE
TER. 3
1 TER. 1 TER. 2
4
✬ ✬
2 3
STICKER LOCATION
Fig. 46 Fig. 48
30
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
31
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
32
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Connection details
FLASHER
Connection details are shown in Fig. 54 L
Fig. 55
ELECTRICAL
33
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Removal
1) Remove the facia central cluster.
2) Remove the two screws 1 & 2 holding hazard
warning switch on to the facia central cluster.
Fig. 57
3) Disconnect the connector and take out the
switch.
Inspection :
Ensure that the mounting lugs of the facia central
cluster are not broken.
Installation
Fig. 56
Follow the removal procedure in a reverse order
for installing of the Hazard warning switch.
For the circuit of hazard warning switch refer the
wiring diagram sections.
Fig. 57
34
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
64.5 9 1/4 50 +4
2PIN CONNECTOR
IGN METER
BROWN FULL
WIRE SEAL
METER
GAUGE VIOLET
3/4
TERMINAL
(Violet)
1/2
TENK UNIT BRAZED
SOLODERED 1/4 ELECTRICAL
TERMINAL
(BROWN)
EMPTY HIGH
EMPTY LOW
Fig. 60
35
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
6. Miscellaneous Accessories :
6.1. Horn
6.2. Heated Rear Window.
6.3. Immobiliser/Anti theft system.
NOTE : In addition to these guidelines also
6.4. Window Winder.
refer to the respective sections for additional
troubleshooting of Alternator, Starter motor &
Wiper motor.
36
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
• Battery getting warm 1) Alternator voltage regulator Replace the regulator with a
faulty genuine spare.
• Battery indication in 1) Alternator terminals loose Connect the terminals properly
instrument cluster remains 2) Alternator drive belt snapped Replace alternator belt
ON after engine is started 3) Battery terminals loose Tighten battery terminals
4) Battery terminals corroded Clean the terminals
5) Starter motor connections Tighten the connections
loose
ELECTRICAL
37
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
● Engine cranking, but not 1) Starter motor terminals Tighten starter motor terminals
starting loose
2) Battery discharged (Check Recharge battery. Replace
alternator charging system) battery if battery is dead
3) Starter motor solenoid not Replace starter motor
working properly
4) Starter motor faulty Replace starter motor
38
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
TEMPERATURE TRANSDUCER/GAUGE
Fault Possible Causes Remedial Action
● Temperature gauge not 1) Connectors loose at the Fix the connectors properly
working instrument cluster
2) 20 pole connector from Fix the connector properly
Cabin W/H to Front W/H
loose or 10 pole connector
from Front W/H to Engine
W/H loose
3) Two pole connector at Fix the connector properly
Temperature transducer
loose
4) Temperature transducer Replace temperature transducer
faulty
5) Temperature gauge faulty Replace temperature gauge
ELECTRICAL
39
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
RPM METER
Fault Possible Causes Remedial Action
● RPM meter not working 1) Connectors on the cluster Fix the connectors properly
loose/20 pole connector
from Front W/H to Cabin
W/H loose / 3 pole connector
on alternator loose
2) Alternator phase signal Check the output with an RPM
output is not available at meter in working condition. If
terminal W on the alternator there is no output, replace
alternator
3) RPM meter faulty Replace RPM meter with the
correct RPM meter with proper
pulley ratio
HEAD LAMPS, FRONT PARKING LAMPS & FRONT TURN SIGNAL LAMPS
Fault Possible Causes Remedial Action
Head Lamps
● Single head lamp (RH or 1) Grounding point no. E5 Tighten grounding properly
LH) not working (RH) or E4 (LH) loose
2) Head Lamp connector Fix connector properly
(3 pole) loose
3) Bulb blown Replace bulb
● Both lamps not working in 1) Head lamp high / low beam Fix the fuse in the base
high / low beam fuse (15A) in cabin fuse box properly. If blown, check for
loose/blown short in the circuit and then
replace the fuse
2) Head lamp high / low beam Fix the relay properly
relay in cabin loose
3) Head lamp high / low beam Replace relay
relay faulty
4) Connectors at combi-switch Fix the connectors properly
loose/10 pole connector
from Front W/H to cabin
W/H loose
40
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
● Single front parking lamp 1) Connector (2 pole) loose Fix the connector properly
not working 2) Bulb loose/fused Fix the bulb properly. Replace
bulb if blown
3) Grounding point no E5 Tighten the grounding properly
(RH) or E4 (LH) loose
4) Parking lamp LH/RH fuse Fix the fuse properly in the base.
(5A) in cabin fuse box If blown, check for short in the
loose/blown circuit and then replace the fuse
5) Battery supply not reaching Check the continuity from
parking lamp LH/RH fuse battery to the lamps through the
input combi-switch, Front W/H and
Floor W/H connectors and
rectify the discontinuity in the
circuit.
● Both parking lamps not 1) Combi-switch connectors Fix the connectors properly
working loose/20 pole connector
from Front W/H to Cabin
W/H loose
2) Combi switch faulty Replace combi-switch
Front turn signal lamps
● Front right / left signal 1) Grounding point in engine Tighten the grounding properly
lamps not working compartment i. e. point no. 31/3
near LH head lamp loose
2) Connector at the lamp (2 pole) Fix the connector properly
loose
3) Bulb loose/fused Fix the bulb properly. Replace
bulb if blown
ELECTRICAL
41
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Reverse lamps
● Single reverse lamp not 1) Grounding point no. E13 Tighten grounding properly
working loose
2) Bulb loose/fused Fix the bulb properly. Replace
bulb if blown
3) 6 pole connector from Floor Fix the connector properly
W/H to Rear Cluster Lamp
loose.
● Both reverse lamps not 1) Reverse lamp fuse (20A) in Fix the fuse in the base firmly. If
working cabin fuse box loose / blown blown, check for short in the
circuit and then replace the fuse
2) Reverse lamp switch faulty Replace reverse lamp switch
Parking Lamps
● Single parking lamp rear 1) Grounding point no. E13 Tighten grounding properly
not working loose
2) Parking lamp LH/RH fuse Fix the fuse properly in the
(5A) in cabin fuse box loose base, if blown, check for short in
/blown the circuit and then replace the
fuse
3) 6 pole connector from floor Fix the terminal properly
W/H to Rear cluster lamp
loose
4) Bulb loose / fused Fix the bulb properly. Replace
bulb if blown
5) Battery supply not reaching Check the continuity from
parking lamp LH/RH fuse battery to the lamps through the
input combi-switch, Front W/H and
Floor W/H connectors and
rectify the discontinuity in the
circuit.
● Both parking lamps not 1) Combi switch connectors Fix the connectors properly
working at all loose/20 pole connector
from Front W/H to Cabin
W/H loose
2) Combi switch faulty Replace combi -switch
Stop Lamp
● Single stop lamp not 1) Grounding point no. E13 Tighten grounding properly
working loose
42
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
● Both stop lamps not 1) Stop lamp fuse (10A) in cabin Fix fuse firmly in the base.
working fuse box loose/blown Replace if blown
2) Connector (18 pole) from Fix the connector properly
Cabin W/H to Floor W/H
loose
3) Adjustment of stop lamp Adjust the switch to correct
switch not proper setting
4) Brake lamp switch faulty Replace switch
● Rear right / left turn signal 1) Grounding point no. E13 Tighten grounding properly
lamps not working loose
2) Bulb loose / fused Fix the bulb properly. Replace
bulb
● No indicator lamp is 1) Flasher fuse (10A) in cabin Fix fuse properly in the base.
working fuse box loose/blown Replace fuse if blown
2) Flasher in cabin fuse box Replace Flasher
faulty
3) Connector at Hazard Fix the connector properly
Warning Switch loose
● Single lamp not working 1) Grounding point no. E13 Tighten grounding properly
loose
2) 6 pole connector from Floor Connect the terminal properly
W/H To Rear cluster lamp
loose
3) Bulb loose / fused Fix bulb properly in holder.
Replace bulb if blown
● Both lamps not working 1) Rear fog lamp fuse (20A) in Fix the fuse properly. If blown,
cabin fuse box loose/blown check for short in the circuit and
then replace the fuse
2) Rear fog lamp relay in cabin Fix relay properly ELECTRICAL
fuse box loose
3) Rear fog lamp relay located Replace relay
(near steering column) faulty
43
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
● Both lamps not working 1) Combi-switch faulty light stalk Replace combi-switch light stalk
44
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
ROOF LAMPS :
Fault Possible Causes Remedial Action
● Spot lamps not working 1) Bulbs loose / blown Fix the bulbs properly. Replace
bulbs if blown
2) Switch erratic Replace roof lamp
● Cabin lamp not working in 1) Bulb loose/fused Fix the bulb properly. Replace
‘ON’ position bulb if blown
2) Switch operation erratic Replace Roof lamp
HAZARD WARNING :
Fault Possible Causes Remedial Action
● Indicator lamps are not 1) Connector at the switch Fix the connector terminal
working when hazard loose properly
warning switch is operated 2) Hazard warning switch faulty Replace switch
3) Flasher fuse (10A) in cabin Fix fuse properly in the base.
fuse box loose/blown Replace fuse if blown
4) Flasher in cabin fuse box Replace Flasher
faulty
ELECTRICAL
45
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
FRONT WIPER :
Fault Possible Causes Remedial Action
● Front wiper system not 1) Grounding point no. E3 Tighten grounding properly
working at all loose
2) Connector (6 pole) loose at Fix the connectors properly
the front wiper motor
3) Wash wiper fuse (25A) Fix the fuse firmly in the base. If
in cabin fuse box blown, check for short in the
loose/ blown circuit and then replace the fuse
● Front wiper system does 1) Terminals in the front wiper Connect the terminals properly
not work in all speeds motor connector loose /
Terminals in front wiper
controller base loose
2) Front wiper controller erratic Replace front wiper controller
46
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
REAR WIPER :
Fault Possible Causes Remedial Action
● Rear wiper system not 1) Grounding point no. E14 Tighten grounding properly
working at all loose
2) Connector (4 pole) loose at Fix the connector properly
the rear wiper motor
3) Wash wiper fuse (25A) in Fix the fuse firmly in the base. If
cabin fuse box loose/blown blown, check for short in the
circuit and then replace the fuse
4) Rear wiper controller / relay Fix the controller / relay in the
in cabin loose in the base base properly
5) Rear wiper controller / relay Replace the faulty part
faulty
6) Rear wiper switch in facia Replace switch
pack faulty
7) Rear wiper motor faulty Replace rear wiper motor
● Rear wiper switch symbol 1) Bulb loose / fused Fix the bulb properly. Replace if
not lighting blown
● Rear wiper switch on-state 1) Bulb loose/fused Fix the bulb properly. Replace if
indication not lighting blown
● Both legend and on-state 1) Grounding near side Tighten the grounding properly
indication on Rear wiper repeater lamp RH i. e. grounding
switch not lighting point no. E15 is loose
2) Bulb loose / fused Fix the bulb properly. Replace if
blown.
REAR WASH :
Fault Possible Causes Remedial Action
● Rear Windscreen washer 1) Water tank empty Fill tank with Windscreen
not working washer fluid
2) Washer tube joints are open Connect the joints properly
3) Grounding point no.E5 Tighten grounding properly
loose
4) Connection loose at rear Fix the connectors properly
windscreen washer pump /
connection from Cabin W/H
to Front W/H loose.
5) Wash wiper fuse (25A) in Fix the fuse in the base
cabin fuse box loose/blown properly. Replace if blown. ELECTRICAL
47
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
● Rear windscreen washer 1) Bulb loose/fused Fix the bulb properly. Replace if
switch symbol not lighting blown
● Rear windscreen washer 1) Bulb loose/fused Fix the bulb properly. Replace if
switch on-state indication blown
not lighting
● Rear windscreen washer 1) Grounding near side Tighten the grounding properly
switch illumination repeater lamp RH is loose
not working at all 2) Bulb loose/fused Fix the bulb properly. Replace if
blown
HORN :
Fault Possible Causes Remedial Action
● Horn not working 1) Grounding point no.E4 Tighten grounding properly
loose
2) Ring terminals at horn loose Connect the terminal properly
3) Horn fuse (15A) in Engine Fix the fuse firmly in the base.
compartment fuse box in Replace if blown
Cabin fuse box loose/blown
4) Horn relay in cabin loose Fix the relay properly
5) Horn relay coil fuse (5A) in Fix fuse firmly. If fuse d\blown,
cabin fuse box loose/blown check for short in the circuit
and then replace the fuse
6) 20 pole connector from Fix the connector properly
Cabin W/H to Front W.H
loose
7) Horn switch terminal / horn Replace control switch plunger
switch contact in steering topping/Adjust horn switch
pad improper contact in steering pad properly
● Horn sound distorted 1) Horn terminals loose Connect the terminals properly
2) Horn setting screw disturbed Adjust the setting screw till a
clean and sharp sound is
obtained
48
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
● Heated Rear Window not 1) Grounding point no. E14 Tighten grounding properly
working loose
2) Connection loose at Heater/ Fix the connectors properly
Connection from Cabin W/H
to Floor W/H loose or Floor
W/H to Tail gate W/H loose
3) Heated Rear Window fuse Fix fuse firmly in the base. If
(20A) in cabin fuse box blown, check for short in the
loose/blown circuit and then replace the fuse
4) Heated Rear Window timer Fix the timer firmly in the base
loose
5) Terminals loose at Heated Connect the terminals properly
Rear Window fuse base/
Heated Rear Window timer
base
6) Heated Rear Window timer Replace timer
in cabin fuse box faulty
7) Heated Rear Window switch Replace switch
faulty
8) Heater coil open Check for continuity in the
heater coil. Replace rear
windscreen glass if coil is open.
• Heated Rear Window 1) Bulb loose /fused Fix the bulb properly. Replace if
switch symbol not lit blown
• Heated Rear Window 1) Bulb loose/fused Fix the bulb properly. Replace if
switch ON-state indication blown
not lit
• Both the legend and ON- 1) Grounding near side Tighten the grounding properly
state indication on Heated repeater lamp RH is loose
Rear Window switch not 2) Bulb loose/ fused Fix the bulb property. Replace if
lighting blown
ELECTRICAL
49
NEXT
INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
• One or more of the doors 1) Grounding point no. E12 Tighten grounding properly
(but not all doors) not loose
locking / unlocking
properly 2) ECU connector (34 pole) loose Fix the connector properly
Ground point for Immobiliser
ECU = E1
3) Connection from door W/H to Fix the connector properly
Floor W/H (8 pole for Front
door RH, 4 pole for Front
door LH, 6 pole for rear
doors) loose
4) Central Locking Unit Fix the connector properly.
controller connection loose
5) Link between CLU actuator Fit the link properly. Replace
and latch has come off or is link if broken
broken
6) CLU actuator faulty Replace actuator
• Vehicle not starting (starter not 1) Air connection or supply not Check the 12V between, Key-in
working) present. & ground, Ignition & ground,
Starter & ground.
50
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
• Lock or unlock function is not 1) Discharged battery on remote Check LED on the remote, when any
working with remote. one button is pressed(lock/unlock)
i.e. remote battery is OK. If that LED
is flickering or not glowing, then
battery is dead.Change the battery.
• Vehicle is continuously going 1) Door open or door switch faulty The unit is sensing door open signal
into panic mode, when vehicle One of the door switch is faulty.
is locked by remote Check all the door switches
including Dickey & bonnet.
• Vehicle is not going into panic 1) Door switch faulty. When vehicle is locked by remote
mode, when vehicle is locked then open individual door & check
by remote & door is opened by if vehicle goes into panic mode.
mechanical key. If not then that particular door switch
is faulty. Rectify.
• Central door locking not working 1) Fuse/relays faulty. Check the fuse of the CDL 30A.
Check the relays of CDL which are
mounted on immobilser bracket.
Replace.
• In CDL function, front doors are 1) Wrong connection. Interchange the two pole connector
locking & rear doors are not wires from patch harness which are
locking. going to the Actuators.
• Vehicle does not go into lock 1) Key present in ignition. Remove key out of vehicle, close
mode when operated by remote the door & lock using remote.
ELECTRICAL
51
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
WINDOW WINDER :
Fault Possible Causes Remedial Action
• One or more of the 1) Fuse (30A) for the respective Fix fuse firmly in the base. If
window winders not door loose/ blown under blown, check for short in the
working driver seat circuit and then replace the fuse
2) Grounding point no.E12 Tighten grounding properly.
loose.
3) Relay in relay box under Push the relay firmly till clicking
driver seat not fixed firmly sound is felt.
4) Motor connections are loose Remove the door trim and fix
the connector properly.
5) Relay faulty Replace the relay
6) Door W/H connector not Fix the connectors firmly.
mating with Floor W/H
52
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Wind Shield Wiper Motor Model 5SW60B series are of units designed to operate a link type Wiper system
to be used on Cars / Utility vehicles.
The Wiper Motor is a self switching two pole design having permanent magnet field system and provided with
a gear box, housing a final gear. The power developed by the motor is transmitted by worm teeth, provided on
the Armature shaft, through the final gear system to the rotary link. The rotary motion of the rotary link is
converted to reciprocating linear motion (to and fro motion) of the connecting rods which in turn operates the
wiping blades. The contacts in the cover plate ensure regenerative breaking to the Armature on completion
of the wiping cycle when the switch turned ‘OFF’ and ensures consistent parking position of the Wiper arms
and blades. The arms resting position is pre-set to suit the installation requirements.
ELECTRICAL
53
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
2) PRECAUTIONS :
1) Circuit cable resistance drop does not
exceed 1.0 volt with motor current of 5.0
Amps.
2) Observe correct polarity while connecting
motor.
3) Ensure recommended Arm / Blade sizes are
used.
ROUTINE MAINTENANCE :
1) Check for light run current, speed, direction
of rotation and parking position of wiper
motor to ensure correct assembly.
54
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
3) SPECIFICATION :
1. TYPE 5SW60
RANGE
7. OPERATING TEMPERATURE
9. 2 Nm LOAD 45 ± 5 RPM
SPEED
10. 14 Nm LOAD > 20 RPM
WIRING DIAGRAM :
ELECTRICAL
55
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
EXPLODED VIEW
56
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
ELECTRICAL
57
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
6) SYSTEM DISMANTLING
Fig.1
Fig.2
Fig.3
58
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Fig.4
Fig.5
6) SYSTEM DISMANTLING :
When dismantling the unit, carefully note
down the positions in which the various
components are fitted in order to ensure their
correct replacement on re-assembly.
ELECTRICAL
Fig.6
59
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Fig.7
Fig.8
Ref. Fig.9
Fig.9
60
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Ref. Fig.10
Fig.10
Ref. Fig.11
Fig.11
Fig.12
61
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Ref. Fig.13
Fig.13
Ref. Fig.14
Fig.14
Fig.15
62
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Ref. Fig.16
8) BENCH INSPECTION :
Ref. Fig.17
Fig.17
Ref. Fig.18
ELECTRICAL
Fig.18
63
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
9) REASSEMBLY :
It is reverse order of dismantling procedure.
Note the following precautions.
64
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Fig.22
BELLIVELI WASHER
5) Belliveli washer in position.
Ensure that the Belliveli Washer
is replaced in proper position on
to the gear spindle as shown in
Ref. Fig.23
If it is assembled vice-versa,
motor will have frictional losses.
Fig.23
Fig.24
65
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Fig.25
description value
Thrust screw nut 2.0 — 2.6 Nm
Yoke fixing screw 2.0 — 2.6 Nm
Brush Plate fixing
screw 0.8 — 0.9 Nm
Cover plate fixing
screw 2.0 — 2.5 Nm
Rotary link nut 12 to 14 Nm
66
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
11) TROUBLESHOOTING :
DEFECT REMEDY
ELECTRICAL
67
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Rear Screen Wipermotor Model RW43 series is a single spindle, single speed unit designed to operate a single
Arm and Blade to wipe the Rear Wind Screen of Vehicles. The Motor is a self switching two pole design having
permanent magnet field system, and provided with Gear Box housing and final Gear. The power developed by the
motor is transmitted by worm teeth on an extension of the Armature Shaft through the final gear system.
The rotary motion of the finalgear is converted to oscilatery motion through a transmission mechanism housed in
the Gear Box, which operate the wiper Arm and Blade. The contacts in the Switch moulding provided on the Gear
Box ensure a re-generative breaking on completion of the wiping cycle when the switch is turned “OFF”, and
ensures consistant parking position of the Wiper Arm and Blade. The Arm resting position is preset to suit the
installation requirements. The wiper motor incorporates radio interference capacitor.
PRECAUTIONS :
1) Circuit cable resistance drop does not
exceed 1.0 volt with motor current of
5.0 Amps.
2) Observe correct polarity while connecting
motor.
3) Ensure recommended Arm / Blade sizes are
used.
68
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
2) ROUTINE CHECKS :
1) Remove oil, tarspots or similar deposits from
the wind screen with methylated
spirits (denatured alcohol).
2) Do not use silicone or wax polishes on wind
screen.
3) Ensure all electrical connections are in good
condition.
4) Keep wiping blades in good condition.
5) Worn or perished blades should be replaced.
WIRING DIAGRAM :
ELECTRICAL
69
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
3) SPECIFICATION :
1. TYPE RW43
RANGE
7. OPERATING TEMPERATURE
70
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
EXPLODED VIEW
ELECTRICAL
71
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
72
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
If the Wiper Motor does not start after the Wiper Switch
is turned ‘ON’.
a) Inspect the lead connections and
plug connection.
b) Inspect Wiper Switch
c) Inspect the fuse
d) Inspect the brush contacts with the
commutator
e) Inspect for dirt or heavy Carbon
Content on the Commutator Dia.
thoroughly.
73
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
7) DISMANTLING :
When dismantling the unit, carefully note down the
positions in which the various components are fitted
in order to ensure the correct replacement on re-
assembly.
Unscrew the arm fitting nut.
Ref. Fig.2
Fig.2
Fig.3
Fig.4
74
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Fig.5
Fig.6
ELECTRICAL
Fig.7
75
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
8) BENCH INSPECTION :
Brush replacement : If the brush length is below the
minimum required length, replace the complete brush
carrier assembly.
Fig.10
76
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Fig.11
Fig.12
9) REASSEMBLY :
Ref. Fig.13
ELECTRICAL
Fig.13
77
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Smear ‘Turbo 41’ oil over armature shaft and final gear
output shaft before assembly. Ref. Fig.14
Belliveli Washer.
Fig.16
78
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
✘
Ref. Fig.17
Fig.17
Check for Light run current, speed, direction of rotation
and parking position of wiper motor to ensure correct
assembly.
Ensure that the fasteners are tightened to the
mentioned tightening torque values.
description value
Thrust screw nut 2.0 — 2.6 Nm
Yoke fixing screw 2.0 — 2.5 Nm
Brush Plate fixing
screw 0.8 — 0.9 Nm
Cover plate fixing
screw 2.0 — 2.5 Nm
ELECTRICAL
79
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
11) TROUBLESHOOTING :
DEFECT REMEDY
80
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
1) GENERAL DESCRIPTION :
The A 128 Alternator with internal cooling fans and with inbuilt Regulator is designed as a battery charging machine
for Passenger Cars. The Alternator is designed and matched to form part of an integrated battery charging system
for Automotive applications. This is a 3 phase machine of revolving field and stationary armature type, self limiting
in current output. It is ventilated and cooled by means of two internal fans welded on to either side of the rotor.
ELECTRICAL
81
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
PRECAUTIONS :
DO’s : DONT’s :
• Do ensure that all electrical connections are clean • Do not flash the Alternator output leads to check
and secure. the working of the Alternator.
• Do ensure that no electrical connection in the • Do not run the Alternator with the battery discon-
circuit including the battery is open. Do observe nected.
correct polarity while connecting battery to
altenator ie. connect negative to negative and • Do not disconnect any lead of Alternator / Regula-
positive to positive. Otherwise, Alternator will be tor with the engine in running condition.
damaged.
• Do not disconnect battery cables while the en-
• Disconnect all Alternator terminals, while carrying gine is running.
out welding jobs on the vehicle.
2) ROUTINE CHECKS :
• Ensure correct battery electrolyte level.
• Check the general condition of the battery.
• Apply petroleum jelly to battery terminals.
• Ensure that the ventilation slots are clear.
• Keep the Alternator clean.
• Ensure that the electrical connection and
tight & secure.
• Check and ensure that mounting bolts are
tightened properly.
• Ensure that the belt on the Alternator is in
good condition.
• Check the belt tension and ensure that it is
neither too slack nor too tight.
• Adjust the belt deflection to 10-15 mm when
pressed at midway of the longest
point between pulleys. (Refer Page 5)
82
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
3) SPECIFICATION :
1. TYPE A128
2. RATING CONTINUOUS
6. MAXIMUM PERMISSIBLE
SPEED 18.000 R.P.M.
WIRING DIAGRAM :
ELECTRICAL
83
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
4) SALIENT FEATURES :
84
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
DOES
THE VOLTMETER
READ BETWEEN
14.0 TO 14.8 VOLTS ?
N
YES O
IS RATED
CURRENT OUTPUT NO
REMOVE THE
REACHED WITHOUT VOLTAGE NO ALTERNATOR AND CHECK
DROPPING BELOW ELECTRICAL
13.0 VOLTS ?
YES
85
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
EXPLODED VIEW
86
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
ELECTRICAL
87
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
6) DISMANTLING
Before dismantling the parts, note down the position
of various parts, in order to ensure their proper
replacement on reassembly. Follow the step by step
procedure mentioned below :-
1) Remove the 4 No’s through bolt securing
the front bracket and rear bracket.
Ref. Fig.1
Fig.1
★ Blow hot air over the rear bracket bearing housing for a
few seconds till to temperature of the bearing housing i s
15OC over the ambient temperature. Ref. Fig.2
Fig.2
Fig.3
Fig. 3
88
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Fig.4
Fig.5
ELECTRICAL
Fig.6
89
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Fig.7
Fig.8
Fig.9
90
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Fig.10
Fig.11
ELECTRICAL
Fig.12
91
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Fig.13
Fig.14
Fig.15
92
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
7) BENCH INSPECTION :
On dismantling the unit conduct the
following checks:
Brush check
• Minimum required
Brush lenghth : 7.5mm
Ref. Fig.16
7.5 mm
minimum
If the brushes are below the minimum required length
renew the brushes in sets not individually. De’ solder
the brush lead assy. INSERT New brush assembly
and solder. Make sure that the brushes move freely
inside the brush box.
Fig.16
Fig.17
Bearing check (SRE & DE)
• Bearing should rotate freely without
any excessive play. If play is OHM METER
observed, the bearings should be
replaced.
Fig.18
93
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
110V
AC SUPPLY
Fig.19
Stator insulation test
• Using 230 volt AC main supply, con
nect a 15W bulb. Connect one of
the probes to any of the three leads
and the other probe to the body. The
lamp should not glow. If the lamp
glows it indicates poor insulation.
Replace the stator assembly.
Ref. Fig.20
110V
Fig.20
Fig.21
94
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
9) RECTIFIER ASSEMBLY CHECK :
• Remove the rectifier assembly from
the unit and check as follows:
i) Continuity check
Connect as shown in figure 24. Use the
multimeter with two probes.
Connect the positive probe of multimeter to
phase connecting points and negative probe
to rectifier body. All
diodes should indicate continuity. If not, it
indicates open circuit. Replace the rectifier
assembly.
ELECTRICAL
Fig.24
95
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Fig.25
Fig. 25
Fig. 26
96
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
11) REASSEMBLY :
Fig.27
ELECTRICAL
Fig.28
97
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Note : Use a hot air blower which delivers air suitable to raise the
bracket temperature near the bearing housing to 50 o~60 oC.
Focus the nozzle of hot air blower to SRE bearing housing and
take care that to hot air is not directed towards the plastic mouldings.
Fig.29
PIN
Fig.30
Fig.31
98
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Fig.32
ELECTRICAL
99
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
description value
Pully Hexacon Nut 99 - 13.7 N-m.
100
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
13) TROUBLESHOOTING :
BEFORE STARTING ENSURE THE BATTERY CONDITION
1. Warning light does not appear (a) If the bulb does not light,
when Ignition switch is on. ground WL terminal of the
alternator.
(b) If the bulb now lights the
caused are :
(ii) Jammed brushes or brush Free brushed, Replace , if
lead adrift. necessary.
(iii) Dirty slip ring Clean the slip ring.
(iv) Rotor open circuit. Check that the ends of the rotor
(v) Yellow lead connecting winding are soldered properly to
rectifier to regulator open. slip ring terminals. Resolder the
windings, if open, or replace the
rotor.
(c) If the bulb does not light
even after grounding WL
Terminal, the causes are :
(vi) Fused warning lamp bulb. Check for short circuit, if any, in
the wiring harness. After
rectifying the short replace bulb.
101
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
102
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
2) PRECAUTIONS :
SOLENOID CHECK :
The following points must be adhered to when
starting the engine :- To check the solenoid switch connect a bulb in
series with the main terminal contact, energise
• Ensure that all electrical connections the winding if the bulb glows solenoid switch is
to the Starter are in a good condition. OK.
• Turn the Starter switch and release
as soon as engine fires.
• If the engine does not fire, allow it
to rest before operating the switch
again.
• If the engine does not start, ascertain
the cause and do not drain the
battery by keeping on cranking the
engine.
• Do not operate the Starter when the
engine is running, otherwise serious
damage could occur both to the
Starter pinion and the flywheel ring
gear teeth.
• Do not operate the Starter with a low
charged battery.
ROUTINE MAINTENANCE :
• Ensure that the starter motor
mounting bolts (to the engine) are securely
fastened.
• Check that the electrical
connections are clean and tight.
• Cables should be examined for
fractures, particularly where the
strands enter the teminal lugs.
• Inspect fixing brackets for any
cracks.
ELECTRICAL
103
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
3) SPECIFICATION :
CONNECTION DIAGRAM :
12
104
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
EXPLODED VIEW
ELECTRICAL
105
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
106
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
6) DISMANTLING :
Fig.1
Fig. 1
SOLENOID
FIXING NUT
Fig.2
PLUNGER
ELECTRICAL
Fig.3
107
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Fig.4
THROUGH
BOLT
Fig.5
Fig. 5
Fig.6
108
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Fig.7
Fig. 7
Fig.8
ELECTRICAL
Fig.9
109
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Fig.10
Fig. 10
Fig.11
SHIM
12) Remove the drive assembly. THRUST WASHER
JUMP RING
Ref. Fig.12
DRIVE ASSEMBLY
THRUST COLLAR
Fig.12
110
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
Fig.13
7) BENCH INSPECTION :
Fig.14
Brush Spring
• Check Spring pressure in conjunction with new
brushes.
• Fit brush on the commutator with brushes in
working condition.
• Spring pressure reading at the moment of lift should
be 1.8 / 2.5 kg (New)
1.25 / 2.0 kg
(Washout pushable)
Ref. Fig.15 ELECTRICAL
Fig.15
111
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
8) ARMATURE TEST :
FT
SHA
Fig.16
Ref. Fig.17
Fig.17
• Insulation test
Before testing ensure B.G. plate is free from dust.
Connect the test lamp to the brush box. If the lamp
glows - renew the brush plate.
Ref. Fig.18
Fig.18
112
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
REASSEMBLY :
It is reverse order of dismantling proce-
dure. Note the following precautions.
1. When assembling the C.E. bracket to the
C.E. side of the yoke, the brush plate
assembly should not tilt and to be adjusted
to fixing holes.
2. Slide the drive assembly onto the armature.
Slide collar, and locate jump ring onto the
groove. Lock the jump ring to the thrust
collar, put back the thrust washer and shim
before sliding the armature assembly into the
D.E. bracket.
3. Replace new rubber seals.
Lubrication :
Apply grease (OKS 410) into C.E. and D.E.
bearing bushes and OKS 475 for drive splines.
ELECTRICAL
113
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
10) Testing :
After reassembly, Check for no load, lock torque and
run torque as follows insert fig.
RUN
TORQUE 9.7 ± 0.2 230 MAX 4.5 MIN 2300 MIN
LOCK
7.0 ± 0.2 550 MAX 13.0 MIN ------------ Fig.20
TORQUE
TIGHTENING TORQUE :
description value
Yoke fixing screws 15.7 - 17.2 N-m.
B.G. fixing screws 3.5 - 4.0 N-m.
Fixing bolt 5.7 - 6.2 N-m.
Starter terminal nut 5.1 - 5.7 N-m.
Solenoid mounting nut 5.1 - 5.7 N-m.
114
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
11) TROUBLESHOOTING :
BEFORE STARTING ENSURE THE BATTERY CONDITION
DEFECT CAUSE REMEDY
1) Pinion fails to engage. Discharged Battery. Substitute with a fully charged bat-
tery:
if the starter now cranks the engine,
then the battery must be attended to.
2) Armature fails to rotate or Discharged / Defective battery. Substitute with a fully charged battery.
rotates slowly and the starter if the starter now cranks the engine,
does not crank the engine then the battery must be attended to.
though pinion has engaged
with ring gear
Loose or oxidised battery terminals / Clean the terminals and smear petro
Corroded or loose connections / leum jelly. Tighten all connections.
Defective earth connections.
Starter terminal or brush box having Remove the starter for further
earth fault. Defective Solenoid investigations and replace parts as
Switch. Defective Armature / found to be necessary.
Field Coils.
Contd...
ELECTRICAL
115
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
4) Armature rotates, pinion Clutch slip. Remove the starter from the vehicle
engages with the ring gear but and replace drive assy., test and refit
the engine is not cranked starter.
(A whining noise is heard).
5) Starter continues to run after Sticky starter switch or Disconnect starter cable immediately
the Ignition switch is released. Ignition switch at starter battery terminal. Replace
starter switch or Ignition switch as
applicable.
6) Starting problem
before investigating any starting First ensure that the battery cables If the battery has been removed from
problem, it is essential to and connections are in good the vehicle it is essential that it is
ensure that the battery is in a conditions, clean and tight with the reconnected with the correct polarity.
satisfactory condition. earth connection secure. Ideally Reverse polarity connection will
A defective battery will result in check the battery condition using a seriously damage the Alternator &
cranking difficulties. battery tester. associated parts.
Identify your vehicle symptom, then follow in order the likely causes and checks.
116
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
LAYOUT OF FRONT WIRING HARNESS (RHD)
INDEX
ELECTRICAL
GROUP INDEX
1 FR AND REAR WASH MOTORS 12 BRAKE FLUID SWITCH 23 EARTH - E11
2 FRONT FOGLAMP RH 13 EARTH 24 TO ENGINE W / H
3 EARTH 14 TO FLOOR W / H 25 TO SENSOR W / H
4 HORN 15 TO CABIN W / H 26 BONNET SWITCH
5 HEADLAMP RH 16 TO MAXIFUSE (ENGINE W / H) 27 FUSE AND RELAY BOX (ENGINE)
6 FRONT POSITION/PARKING LAMPS 17 FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR LH 28 FRONT FOGLAMP LH
NEXT
7 FRONT BLINKERS RH 18 EARTH E13 29 HOOTER
8 HEADLAMP LEVELLING MOTOR RH 19 FRONT WIPER MOTOR 30 HEADLAMP LH
9 ABS ECU HU
PREVIOUS
20 TO CABIN W / H 31 POSITION / PARKING LAMPS LH
10 FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR RH 21 TO FRONT WASHER 32 FRONT BLINKERS LH
11 AC COMPRESSOR CLUTCH 22 TO ENGINE COOLING W / H 33 HEADLAMP LEVELLING MOTOR LH
117
ELECTRICAL
118
LAYOUT OF CABIN WIRING HARNESSES (RHD)
INDEX
ELECTRICAL
GROUP INDEX
1 TO FRONT W / H 11 TO ROOF LAMP 21 TO CABIN HVAC W/H
2 TO FLOOR W / H 22 TO SRS / AIRBAG W/H
12 EARTH - ROOF
3 TO DRIVER DOOR W / H 23 TO FRONT W/H
13 SIDE INDICATOR LH
4 FACIA SWITCHES 24 TO ACCESSORY RELAY (12V 50A)
14 FRONT DOOR SWITCH LH
5 INST LIGHT DIMMER 15 EARTH 25 DIGITAL CLOCK
6 FUSE AND RELAY BOX - CABIN 26 STOP LIGHT SWITCH
16 DASH SPEAKERS LH
7 DASH SPEAKER RH 27 HEADLAMP LEVELLING SWITCH
17 TO CO-DRIVER DOOR LH
8 EARTH 28 STEERING LOCK / IGNITION SWITCH
18 HAZARD WARNING SWITCH
NEXT
9 SIDE INDICATOR RH 29 COMBINATION SWITCH (ON STEERING COLUMN)
19 RADIO / MUSIC SYSTEM
10 DRIVER DOOR SWITCH 30 INSTRUMENT CLUSTER
20 CIGARETTE LIGHTER
PREVIOUS
LAYOUT OF AIRBAG WIRING HARNESSES (RHD)
INDEX
ELECTRICAL
GROUP INDEX
1 DRIVER AIRBAG
2 PASSENGER AIRBAG
3 CABIN W/H
4 ECU SRS
NEXT
5 GROUND
6 INHIBIT SWITCH
7 PRETENSIONER LH
PREVIOUS
8 PRETENSIONER RH
119
ELECTRICAL
120
LAYOUT OF TAILGATE WIRING HARNESSES (RHD)
INDEX
ELECTRICAL
GROUP INDEX
1 REAR WIPER MOTOR
2 REAR GLASS HEATER
3 REAR GLASS WASH TUBE
4 TAILGATE SWITCH
5 HIGH MOUNTED STOP LAMP
6 TO FLOOR WIRING HARNESS
7 EARTH / GROUND FOR TAILGATE
NEXT
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
LAYOUT OF FLOOR WIRING HARNESSES (RHD)
ELECTRICAL
121
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
122
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
ELECTRICAL
123
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
124
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ELECTRICAL
125
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER
126
CIRCUIT SCHEMATICS RELAY FUSE BOX FOR INDICA AND INDIGO SOUTH AFRICA MPFI PETROL E-II VERSION
127
128
129
130
131
132
INDEX NEXT
ELECTRICAL
133
134
135
136
137
138
139
140
141
142
143
144
ABS
EMS
NEXT
GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS AIRBAG
CONTENTS :
1) General 2
A) Salient Features
2) Detailed Description 3
A) Electrical
3) Specification 3
A) Laptop/Desktop
B) Vehicle Interface Unit
5) Maintenance 11
A) Trouble shooting
DIAGNO-
STICS
1
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS AIRBAG
A. SALIENT FEATURES
2
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS AIRBAG
2. DETAILED DESCRIPTION :
A. Electrical
3. SPECIFICATION :
A. Laptop / PC (Fig. 4)
The software works with the above features of a Fig 2.Diagnostic connector under co-driver seat
Desktop/ Laptop .
Any other combination of speed and RAM less
then specified will slow down the response of
the software.
DIAGNO-
STICS
Fig 3.Diagnostic connector cap removed
3
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS AIRBAG
Fig 4. Laptop
DIAGNO-
STICS
Fig 6. OBD cable connected to diagnostic
connector
4
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS AIRBAG
A. Installation of Software
Installation Procedure:-
B. Operating Procedure
i. Main Menu :
5
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS AIRBAG
Fig 8.
6
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS AIRBAG
ii. DETAILS :
b] SENSOR INFO :
DIAGNO-
STICS
7
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS AIRBAG
Fig 10.
8
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS AIRBAG
This allows to read error codes recorded in the This service is used to write Vehicle
error buffer in ECU. ACU-3 can record up to 16 Identification Number (VIN) .
error codes. Reading the 16 error codes requires Enter the VIN number in the text window. This
to execute two commands. has to be entered as per the
On clicking of READ DTCs , user has to first Car Manufacturer.
select First 8 DTCs and then The maximum length of VIN number is 19.
Second 8 DTCs from the popup menu. If length of VIN number is less then 19 then
number will be stored with succeeding zeros.
After this Error codes will displayed in the list. If After clicking the button a small screen will
errors are not there then No Errors Present appear in the data display area , enter the VIN
message will be displayed. number and then Click ok .
But error codes will be recorded again if they are This service is used to read the VIN number from
not physically cleared. the ECU. The ECU is capable to store 19 bytes
of data in its memory. If length of VIN number is
less then 19 then number will be stored with
succeeding zeros.
The command displays the following response
in the data display area:-
9
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS AIRBAG
j] IGNITION LOCK :
10
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS AIRBAG
5. Maintenance :
A. Troubleshooting
ECU communication error 1) LEDs status On the - Check the OBD cable connection with
Silicon Engines interface Diagnostic Connector of wiring harness.
unit. - Check the OBD cable connection with Multi
protocol Interface module.
- Check the DSR and DTR LEDs on Silicon
Engines module. If both are red re-initialise the
unit.
DIAGNO-
STICS
11
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIRBAG FAULTCODE & REPAIR GUIDELINE
ERR_LEAK_PLUS_ Co-driver pre tensioner line Co-driver Pretensioner line Check the wiring
SQUIB (1) shorted to +ve supply. Firing of shorted supply line harness for damage.
pre-tensioner inhibited. Replace if necessary.
ERR_LEAK_PLUS_ Driver Pretensioner line shorted Driver Pretensioner line Check the wiring
SQUIB (2) to +ve supply. Firing of shorted supply line. harness for damage.
Pretensioner inhibited. Replace if necessary.
ERR_LEAK_PLUS_ Driver airbag line shorted to +ve Driver airbag line shorted Check the wiring
SQUIB (3) supply. Firing of airbag inhibited. supply line. harness &
Clockspring for
damage. Replace if
necessary.
ERR_LEAK_PLUS_ Co-driver airbag line shorted to Passenger airbag line Check the wiring
SQUIB (4) +ve supply. Firing of airbag shorted supply line. harness for damage.
inhibited. Replace if necessary.
ERR_LEAK_PLUS_ RH side airbag line shorted to RH Side airbag line shorted Check the wiring
SQUIB (9) +ve supply. Firing of airbag supply line. harness for damage.
inhibited. Replace if necessary.
ERR_LEAK_PLUS_ LH side airbag line shorted to LH Side airbag line shorted Check the wiring
SQUIB (12) +ve supply. Firing of airbag supply line. harness for damage.
inhibited. Replace if necessary.
ERR_LEAK_GND_ Co-driver pre tensioner line Co-driver pre-tensioner line Check the wiring
SQUIB (1) shorted to GND supply. Firing shorted to Vehicle Ground. harness for damage.
of pre-tensioner inhibited. Replace if necessary.
ERR_LEAK_GND_ Driver pre tensioner line shorted Driver pre-tensioner line Check the wiring
SQUIB (2) to GND supply. Firing of shorted to Vehicle Ground. harness for damage.
pre-tensioner inhibited. Replace if necessary.
ERR_LEAK_GND_ Driver line shorted to GND. Driver airbag line shorted to Check the wiring
SQUIB (3) Firing of airbag inhibited. Vehicle Ground. harness &
Clockspring for
damage. Replace if
necessary.
ERR_LEAK_GND_ Co-driver line shorted to GND. Passenger airbag line Check the wiring
SQUIB (4) Firing of airbag inhibited. shorted to Vehicle Ground. harness for damage.
Replace if necessary.
DIAGNO-
STICS
12
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIRBAG FAULTCODE & REPAIR GUIDELINE
ERR_LEAK_GND_ RH side airbag line shorted to RH Side airbag line shorted Check the wiring
SQUIB (9) GND. Firing of airbag inhibited. to Vehicle Ground. harness for damage.
Replace if necessary.
ERR_LEAK_PLUS_ LH side airbag line shorted to LH Side airbag line shorted Check the wiring
SQUIB (12) GND. Firing of airbag inhibited. to Vehicle Ground. harness for damage.
Replace if necessary.
ERR_HIGH_RES_ The resistance in the Co-driver Co-driver Pretensioner not Check connections
SQUIB (1) Pretensioner is higher than the connected or connection and wiring harness for
specified limit. loose or line open. damages. If problem
persists try replacing
wiring harness or
Pretensioner.
ERR_HIGH_RES_ The resistance in the Driver Driver Pretensioner not Check connections
SQUIB (2) Pretensioner is higher than the connected or connection and wiring harness for
specified limit. loose or line open. damages. If problem
persists try replacing
wiring harness or
Pretensioner.
ERR_HIGH_RES_ The resistance in the Driver Driver airbag not connected Check connections
SQUIB (3) airbag line is higher than the or connection loose or line and wiring harness for
specified limit. open. damages. If problem
persists try replacing
wiring harness or
airbag.
ERR_HIGH_RES_ The resistance in the co-driver Passenger airbag not Check connections
SQUIB (4) airbag line is higher than the connected or connection and wiring harness for
specified limit. loose or line open. damages. If problem
persists try replacing
wiring harness or
airbag.
ERR_HIGH_RES_ The resistance in the RH side RH side airbag not Check connections
SQUIB (9) airbag line is higher than the connected or side airbag and wiring harness for
specified limit. pigtail not connected to the damages. If problem
airbag wiring harness or persists try replacing
connection loose the airbag or wiring
harness.
DIAGNO-
STICS
13
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIRBAG FAULTCODE & REPAIR GUIDELINE
ERR_HIGH_RES_ The resistance in the LH side LH side airbag not connected Check connections
SQUIB (12) airbag line is higher than the or side airbag pigtail not and wiring harness for
specified limit. LH side airbag connected to the airbag damages. If problem
not connected or side airbag wiring harness or connection persists try replacing
pigtail not connected to the loose. the airbag or wiring
airbag wiring harness or harness.
connection loose.
ERR_LOW_RES_ Low resistance in the Co-driver Shorting in the wiring Check the wiring
SQUIB (1) Pretensioner line. harness. Internal error in harness for shorting
Pretensioner. and replace if
necessay. If problem
persists, replace
wiring harness or
Pretensioner.
ERR_LOW_RES_ Low resistance in the driver Shorting in the wiring Check the wiring
SQUIB (2) Pretensioner line. harness. Internal error in harness for shorting
Pretensioner. and replace if
necessay. If problem
persists, replace
wiring harness or
Pretensioner.
ERR_LOW_RES_ Low resistance in the driver Shorting in the wiring Check the wiring
SQUIB (3) airbag line. harness. Internal error in harness for shorting
Pretensioner. and replace if
necessay. If problem
persists, replace
wiring harness or
airbag.
ERR_LOW_RES_ Low resistance in the co-driver Shorting in the wiring Check the wiring
SQUIB (4) airbag line. harness. Internal error in harness for shorting
airbag line. and replace if
necessay. If problem
persists, replace
wiring harness or
airbag.
ERR_LOW_RES_ Low resistance in the RH side Shorting in the wiring Check the wiring
SQUIB (9) airbag line. harness. Internal error in harness for shorting
side airbag line. and replace if
necessay. If problem
DIAGNO-
STICS
14
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIRBAG FAULTCODE & REPAIR GUIDELINE
persists, replace
wiring harness or
side airbag.
ERR_LOW_RES_ Low resistance in the LH side Shorting in the wiring Check the wiring
SQUIB (12) airbag line. harness. Internal error in harness for shorting
side airbag line. and replace if
necessay. If problem
persists, replace
wiring harness or
side airbag.
ERR_CAP_NOT_ ECU internal capacitor not Malfunction of the internal Check the battery
CHARGED (1) charged. ECU power circuit. voltage to the ECU. If
the problem persists
change the ECU.
ERR_CAPACIATANCE ECU internal capacitor error. Malfunction of the internal Check the battery
_CAP(1) ECU power circuit. voltage to the ECU. If
the problem persists
change the ECU.
ERR_BATTERY_ Vehicle battery voltage too high Battery overcharged or Check the vehicle
VOLTAGE or too low. undercharged. Leakage of battery voltage.
battery voltage. Acceptable voltage
range- 10.5 to 16
Volts.
ERR_CHILDSEAT_OC Error in resistance of PAB Passenger airbag inhibition Check the PAB
inhibition switch. switch not connected or inhibition connections.
resistance values not in Check resistance of
drawing limits. Inhibition switch as
per drawing. Replace
if necessary.
ERR_WLAMP_LEAK_ Warning lamp voltage not OK. Warning lamp not connected Check the warning
VBAT or the lamp has fused. lamp and its proper
connection. Replace
the lamp if necessary.
ERR_BLAMP_LEAK_ PAB inhibition LED voltage not LED not connected or the Check the PAB
VBAT OK. lamp has fused. inhibition LED and its
connection. Replace
the wiring harness or
DIAGNO-
STICS
15
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIRBAG FAULTCODE & REPAIR GUIDELINE
Inhibition switch if
necessary.
ERR_WLAMP_LEAK_ SRS lamp on instrument cluster Shorting in the wiring Check wiring harness
GND shorted to Vehicle Ground. harness or in the cluster. for shorting and
replace if necessary.
ERR_BLAMP_LEAK_ PAB inhibition LED shorted to Shorting in the wiring Check wiring harness
GND Vehicle Ground. harness or in the Inhibit for shorting and
switch. replace if necessary.
ERR_LOWER_ Fault in the Co-driver Internal fault in ECU. Replace the ECU
TRANSISTOR(1) Pretensioner firing circuit in the
ECU. Firing of the Pretensioner
inhibited.
ERR_LOWER_ Fault in the driver Pretensioner Internal fault in ECU. Replace the ECU
TRANSISTOR(2) firing circuit in the ECU. Firing
of the Pretensioner inhibited.
ERR_LOWER_ Fault in the driver airbag firing Internal fault in ECU. Replace the ECU
TRANSISTOR(3) circuit in the ECU. Firing of the
airbag inhibited.
ERR_LOWER_ Fault in the co-driver airbag Internal fault in ECU. Replace the ECU
TRANSISTOR(4) firing circuit in the ECU. Firing
of the airbag inhibited.
ERR_LOWER_ Fault in the LH side airbag Internal fault in ECU. Replace the ECU
TRANSISTOR(12) firing circuit in the ECU. Firing
of the side airbag inhibited.
ERR_LOWER_ Fault in the RH side airbag Internal fault in ECU. Replace the ECU
TRANSISTOR(9) firing circuit in the ECU. Firing
of the side airbag inhibited.
ERR_UPPER_ Fault in the Co-driver Internal fault in ECU. Replace the ECU
TRANSISTOR(1) Pretensioner firing circuit in the
ECU. Firing of the Pretensioner
inhibited.
ERR_UPPER_ Fault in the driver Pretensioner Internal fault in ECU. Replace the ECU
TRANSISTOR(2) firing circuit in the ECU. Firing
of the Pretensioner inhibited.
DIAGNO-
STICS
16
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIRBAG FAULTCODE & REPAIR GUIDELINE
ERR_UPPER_ Fault in the driver airbag firing Internal fault in ECU. Replace the ECU
TRANSISTOR(3) circuit in the ECU. Firing of
the airbag inhibited.
ERR_UPPER_ Fault in the co-driver airbag Internal fault in ECU. Replace the ECU
TRANSISTOR(4) firing circuit in the ECU. Firing
of the airbag inhibited.
ERR_UPPER_ Fault in the LH side airbag firing Internal fault in ECU. Replace the ECU
TRANSISTOR(12) circuit in the ECU. Firing of the
side airbag inhibited.
ERR_UPPER_ Fault in the RH side airbag firing Internal fault in ECU. Replace the ECU
TRANSISTOR(9) circuit in the ECU. Firing of the
side airbag inhibited.
17
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIRBAG FAULTCODE & REPAIR GUIDELINE
ERR_NO_COMM_ LH side Remote sensing unit Fault in wiring harness. Check the wiring
DRV_SAT connection open harness connections
for damage. Replace
the wiring harness if
problem persists.
ERR_NO_COMM_ RH side remote sensing unit Fault in wiring harness. Check the wiring
PSNG_SAT connection open. harness connections
for damage. Replace
the wiring harness if
problem persists.
ERR_DRV_SAT RH Remote sensing unit Internal Fault in Remote Replace the RSU
malfunction. sensing.
ERR_PSNG_SAT LH Remote sensing unit Internal Fault in Remote Replace the RSU
malfunction. sensing.
ERR_DRV_SAT_VOLT Insufficient supply to driver Internal Fault in Remote Check the battery
Remote sensing unit. sensing. supply. If problem
persists try replacing
the ECU or RSU.
DIAGNO-
STICS
18
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
AIRBAG FAULTCODE & REPAIR GUIDELINE
ERR_PSNG_SAT_ Insufficient supply to Co-Driver Internal Fault in Remote Check the battery
VOLT Remote sensing unit. sensing. supply. If problem
persists try replacing
the ECU or RSU
ERR_RSU_ Malfunction of the remote Internal Fault in Remote Replace the RSU
SATURATION control unit. sensing.
DIAGNO-
STICS
19
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS ABS
CONTENTS :
1) General 2
A) Salient Features
2) Detailed Description 3
A) Electrical
3) Specification 3
A) Laptop/Desktop
B) Vehicle Interface Unit
5) Maintenance 8
A) Trouble shooting
DIAGNO-
STICS
1
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS ABS
1. GENERAL :
A. SALIENT FEATURES
2
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS ABS
2. DETAILED DESCRIPTION :
A. Electrical
Required power supply :
Serial cable OBD Cable
Power supply for the Laptop/Desktop.The PC/Laptop Vehicle
Vehicle Interface Unit does not require any (with Interface
software) Unit
external power supply . It works on vehicle RS232 COM
battery, provided through the OBD cable . Port
3
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS ABS
Fig 4. Laptop
DIAGNO-
STICS
Fig 6. OBD cable connected to diagnostic connector
4
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS ABS
5
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS ABS
Fig 9.
The Following operations can be performed with the help • No Of DTC’s Gives the number of Diagnostic
of these commands trouble codes
a] Read ECU status • Relay status gives the relay status of the Relay
b] Actuate the components • Motor Status gives state of the Pump motor. In
default condition Pump Motor should be ‘OFF’ .
c] Read the Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC’s)
• Valve status give the condition of the valves,
d] Clear the Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC’s)
normally the Inlet valves are ‘ON’ and Outlet valves
a] On clicking the ‘Read ECU status’ the frame as are ‘ OFF’
shown in Fig. 9 is displayed.
• After applying the Brake , and clicking the ‘Brake
light SW’ , the Status bar Display’s ‘BRAKE SWITCH
ON’
• After clicking the ‘WHEEL SPEED’ button, the
following frame appears which shows the wheel
speed data .This is the real time data for the wheels .
6
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS ABS
Fig 12.
DIAGNO-
STICS
7
NEXT
INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS ABS
5. Maintenance :
a. Troubleshooting
ECU communication error 1) LEDs status On the - Check the OBD cable connection with
Silicon Engines interface Diagnostic Connector of wiring harness.
unit. - Check the OBD cable connection with Multi
protocol Interface module.
- Check the ‘DSR’ and ‘DTR’ LEDs on Silicon
Engines module. If both are red re-initialise the
unit.
DIAGNO-
STICS
8
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS FAULTCODE LIST
Faultcode
Table List
of Contents:
DIAGNO-
STICS
9
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS FAULTCODE LIST
Faultcode List
Effects:
• Correct function of ABS solenoid valves & of
return pump motor is no longer guaranteed.
• ABS is passive during the time span but not
switched off.
• ABS warning lamps are switched on.
• EBD is switched off at below 6.9V.
Note:
The solenoid valves are switched to passive
during under or over voltage, a possible return
flow of the return pump is suppressed during
the time span.
DIAGNO-
STICS
10
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS FAULTCODE LIST
Faultcode List
Effects:
DIAGNO-
STICS
11
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS FAULTCODE LIST
Faultcode List
Effects:
DIAGNO-
STICS
12
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS FAULTCODE LIST
Faultcode List
Effects:
Note:
DIAGNO-
STICS
13
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS FAULTCODE LIST
Faultcode List
Effects:
DIAGNO-
STICS
14
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS FAULTCODE LIST
Faultcode List
Effects:
DIAGNO-
STICS
15
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS FAULTCODE LIST
Faultcode List
Effects:
DIAGNO-
STICS
16
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS FAULTCODE LIST
Faultcode List
Effects:
DIAGNO-
STICS
17
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS FAULTCODE LIST
Faultcode List
Effects:
DIAGNO-
STICS
18
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS FAULTCODE LIST
Faultcode List
Effects:
Note:
DIAGNO-
STICS
19
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS FAULTCODE LIST
Faultcode List
Effects:
Note:
DIAGNO-
STICS
20
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS FAULTCODE LIST
Faultcode List
Effects:
Note:
DIAGNO-
STICS
21
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS FAULTCODE LIST
Faultcode List
Effects:
Note:
DIAGNO-
STICS
22
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS FAULTCODE LIST
Faultcode List
Effects:
Note:
DIAGNO-
STICS
23
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS FAULTCODE LIST
Faultcode List
Effects:
DIAGNO-
STICS
24
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS FAULTCODE LIST
Faultcode List
Effects:
DIAGNO-
STICS
25
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS REPAIR GUIDELINES
TableRepair
of Contents:
Guideline
DIAGNO-
STICS
26
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS REPAIR GUIDELINES
Repair Guideline
DIAGNO-
STICS
27
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS REPAIR GUIDELINES
Repair Guideline
Ignition on
• Brake not actuated • 0V
• Brake lights must
not illuminate • Positive short with line BLS 14 or with
line switch “NC side”, or line to rear lights.
DIAGNO-
STICS
28
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS REPAIR GUIDELINES
Repair Guideline
• Ignition OFF
• Disconnect 26-pin plug from ABS unit
and remove assembly from vehicle.
• Install new ABS unit
• Connect 26-pin plug to ABS unit.
• Ignition ON and control the warning
lamps.
• All warning lamps
illuminate and switch
off after a short time
DIAGNO-
STICS
29
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS REPAIR GUIDELINES
Repair Guideline
Note:
On ABS the control unit terminals for the solenoid valves are marked as not accessible in the current flow diagrams and also
not accessible on the plug connector of the ABS unit. Testing of the solenoid valve internal resistance is therefore not
possible.
Reason: The connections, supply voltage to the solenoid valves as well as to the output stages are contained within the
electronics unit.
DIAGNO-
STICS
30
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS REPAIR GUIDELINES
Repair Guideline
Positive pin 17
• Initiation fault First, not during a Motor relay,
regulation Inside ECU
• Running-on Second, actuated pump Pump motor
fault motor with diagnostic- pin 2
tester.
• Ignition on
DIAGNO-
STICS
31
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS REPAIR GUIDELINES
Repair Guideline
Important Notes :
• Ignition OFF before the plug connector will dividedfrom the speed wheel sensor
• Don’t exchange the connection- pins of the speed wheel sensor inside the 26pin connector.
• Ignition on • ABS,EBD and brake • Short circuit Speed Wheel Sensor control
warning lamps Unit
illuminate • Line rupture
• Ignition off • Sensor fault
• Disconnect the 26pin connector of the
control-unit and the connector of the
speed wheel sensor
• Connect ohmmeter between plug K1 • Correct correlation • Exchange sensor lines
and terminals pin 5 and 4 lines WSS(FR) and
Wire lines(FR)
• Check internal resistance from ECU • Internal-resistance • Repair and exchange the wiring harness
(FR) to wheel speed connector (FR). (1,00KOhm to and connectors when possible
1,90Kohm)
• Move cable around by hand • Line no interrupt • Exchange wheel speed sensor FR
especially in area of wheelarch.
Observe continous display of reading.
• Connect ohmmeter between plug K1 • Greater 100 Kohms • Repair and exchange the wiring harness.
wheel speed sensor terminals FR &
to ground or positive.
DIAGNO-
STICS
32
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS REPAIR GUIDELINES
Repair Guideline
DIAGNO-
STICS
33
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS REPAIR GUIDELINES
Repair Guideline
Important Notes :
• Ignition OFF before the plug connector will dividedfrom the speed wheel sensor
• Don’t exchange the connection- pins of the speed wheel sensor inside the 26pin connector.
• Ignition on • ABS,EBD and brake • Short circuit Speed Wheel Sensor control
warning lamps Unit
illuminate • Line rupture
• Ignition off • Sensor fault
• Disconnect the 26pin connector of
the control-unit and the connector of
the speed wheel sensor
• Connect ohmmeter between plug K1 • Correct correlation • Exchange sensor lines
and terminals pin 7 and 6 lines WSS(FL) and
Wire lines(FL)
• Check internal resistance from ECU • Internal-resistance • Repair and exchange the wiring harness
(FL) to wheel speed connector (FL) (1,00KOhm to and connectors when possible
1,90Kohm)
• Move cable around by hand • Line no interrupt • Exchange wheel speed sensor FL
especially in area of wheelarch.
Observe continous display of reading.
• Connect ohmmeter between plug K1 • Greater 100 Kohms • Repair and exchange the wiring harness.
wheel speed sensor terminals FL &
to ground or positive.
DIAGNO-
STICS
34
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS REPAIR GUIDELINES
Repair Guideline
DIAGNO-
STICS
35
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS REPAIR GUIDELINES
Repair Guideline
Important Notes :
• Ignition OFF before the plug connector will dividedfrom the speed wheel sensor
• Don’t exchange the connection- pins of the speed wheel sensor inside the 26pin connector.
• Ignition on • ABS,EBD and brake • Short circuit Speed Wheel Sensor control
warning lamps Unit
illuminate • Line rupture
• Ignition off • Sensor fault
• Disconnect the 26pin connector of the
control-unit and the connector of the
speed wheel sensor
• Connect ohmmeter between plug K1 • Correct correlation • Exchange sensor lines
and terminals pin 3 and 1. lines WSS(RR) and
Wire lines(RR)
• Check internal resistance from ECU • Internal-resistance • Repair and exchange the wiring harness
(RR) to wheel speed connector (RR). (1,00KOhm to and connectors when possible
1,90Kohm)
• Move cable around by hand • Line no interrupt • Exchange wheel speed sensor RR
especially in area of wheelarch.
Observe continous display of reading.
• Connect ohmmeter between plug K1 • Greater 100 Kohms • Repair and exchange the wiring harness.
wheel speed sensor terminals RR &
to ground or positive.
DIAGNO-
STICS
36
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS REPAIR GUIDELINES
Repair Guideline
DIAGNO-
STICS
37
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS REPAIR GUIDELINES
Repair Guideline
Important Notes :
• Ignition OFF before the plug connector will dividedfrom the speed wheel sensor
• Don’t exchange the connection- pins of the speed wheel sensor inside the 26pin connector.
• Ignition on • ABS,EBD and brake • Short circuit Speed Wheel Sensor control
warning lamps Unit
illuminate • Line rupture
• Ignition off • Sensor fault
• Disconnect the 26pin connector of the
control-unit and the connector of the
speed wheel sensor
• Connect ohmmeter between plug K1 • Correct correlation • Exchange sensor lines
and terminals pin 7 and 6. lines WSS(RL) and
Wire lines(RL)
• Check internal resistance from ECU • Internal-resistance • Repair and exchange the wiring harness
(RL) to wheel speed connector (RL). (1,00KOhm to and connectors when possible
1,90Kohm)
• Move cable around by hand • Line no interrupt • Exchange wheel speed sensor RL
especially in area of wheelarch.
Observe continous display of reading.
• Connect ohmmeter between plug K1 • Greater 100 Kohms • Repair and exchange the wiring harness.
wheel speed sensor terminals RL &
to ground or positive.
DIAGNO-
STICS
38
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS REPAIR GUIDELINES
Repair Guideline
DIAGNO-
STICS
39
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS REPAIR GUIDELINES
Repair Guideline
Note :
Speed sensors are fitted to all four wheels. The fitting conditions(air gap, position and location) can be taken from
OEm documents. The terminal designations can be taken from test steps 6 to 9 and 11 to 14, repair guideline for
wheel speeds.
DIAGNO-
STICS
40
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS REPAIR GUIDELINES
Repair Guideline
Important Notes:
• Ignition OFF before the plug connector will divided from the wheel- speed sensor.
• Check the wheel-speed and • Wheel- speed by • Intermittent contact between wheel-
correlation of the wheel to the sensors wheel FR speed sensor to cable harness(connector)
• Check wheel-speed signal of the • Wheel- speed must • Air gap between sensor and impulse
correct min value be always existent. wheel.
• Wheel speed more
than 2 km/h(under
test-bench wheel
speed the same as
the rollers)
DIAGNO-
STICS
41
NEXT
INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS REPAIR GUIDELINES
Repair Guideline
Important Notes:
• Ignition OFF before the plug connector will divided from the wheel- speed sensor.
• Check wheel-speed signal of the • Wheel- speed must • Air gap between sensor and impulse
correct min value be always existent. wheel.
• Wheel speed more
than 2 km/h(under
test-bench wheel
speed the same as
the rollers)
DIAGNO-
STICS
42
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS REPAIR GUIDELINES
Repair Guideline
Important Notes:
• Ignition OFF before the plug connector will divided from the wheel- speed sensor.
• Check the wheel-speed and • Wheel- speed by • Intermittent contact between wheel-
correlation of the wheel to the sensors wheel RR speed sensor to cable harness(connector)
• Check wheel-speed signal of the • Wheel- speed must • Air gap between sensor and impulse
correct min value be always existent. wheel.
• Wheel speed more
than 2 km/h(under
test-bench wheel
speed the same as
the rollers)
DIAGNO-
STICS
43
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS REPAIR GUIDELINES
Repair Guideline
Important Notes:
• Ignition OFF before the plug connector will divided from the wheel- speed sensor.
• Check the wheel-speed and • Wheel- speed by • Intermittent contact between wheel-
correlation of the wheel to the wheel RL speed sensor to cable harness(connector)
sensors
• Check wheel-speed signal of the • Wheel- speed must • Air gap between sensor and impulse
correct min value be always existent. wheel.
• Wheel speed more
than 2 km/h(under
test-bench wheel
speed the same as
the rollers)
DIAGNO-
STICS
44
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS REPAIR GUIDELINES
Repair Guideline
Note:
• The valve relay is contained within the control unit and is not exchangeable. The relay contact on the no side is
within the the control unit and is not routed out on the 26-pin plug of the unit. The voltage on the contact (e.g. after
an actuation) cannot be measured with a multimeter. A relay actuation via diagnosis
tester is not possible.
Ignition off
• Replace ABS Unit
DIAGNO-
STICS
45
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
ABS REPAIR GUIDELINES
Repair Guideline
Note :
The sensor is sensitive to shock acceleration against the housing and consequently against the sensor
element. Disturbances of this kind e.g. through hammer blows during body repairs are not permitted.
DIAGNO-
STICS
46
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS EMS
CONTENTS :
1) General 2
A) Salient Features 2
2) Detailed Description 3
A) Electrical 3
B) Diagnostics Equipment Details 3
C) Explanation of Buttons of HDM 4
DIAGNO-
STICS
1
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS EMS
1. GENERAL :
The Engine Management System ECU controls the
complete functioning of Engine. The Microcontroller
inside the ECU, evaluates continuously the signal from
the all the sensor. Based on this data the ECU controls
parameters like air / fuel proportion.
A. SALIENT FEATURES
The Diagnostic tester (Hitachi diagnostic monitor
(HDM 2000)) has a capability to communicate with
the ECU. This user friendly diagnostic kit makes
trouble shooting simpler. The tester is light weight
and compact in size to facilitate easy portability.
This works on vehicle battery supply. This HDM
2000 can also be used as :
a) Multimeter
b) Oscilloscope
This tester will execute the commands supported
by ECU & provides the diagnostic data for efficient
trouble shooting.
The diagnostic unit is capable of performing
following functions :
1. Read dynamic data like
a. Iignition data
b. 02 sensor information
c. Engine sensors information
d. Engine information
e. Fuel injection information
2. Read failure codes
3. Clear failure codes
4. Functioning of few components
5. Store history of earlier failure.
DIAGNO-
STICS
2
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS EMS
2. DETAILED DESCRIPTIONS
Power Display
Screen Rubber
A. ELECTRICAL (Required Power Supply) Monitor Jacket
Lamp
The diagnostic tester does not require any external Key
power supply. It works on the vehicle battery, Pad Power
Switch
provided through the intermediate cable.
DIAGNO-
STICS
3
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS EMS
Moves up the cursor, and scrolls up the display screen. Increments a numeric value.
Moves down the cursor, and scrolls down the display screen.
Decrements a numeric value.
Moves left the cursor, and scrolls left the display screen. Increments a numeric value.
Moves right the cursor, and scrolls right the display screen. Decrements a numeric value.
Use this key for item selection, deselection, execution, confirmation, etc.,
These keys for carrying out individual functions on each display screen.
DIAGNO-
STICS
Fig. 3
4
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS EMS
DIAGNO-
STICS
5
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS EMS
6
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS EMS
Item Code
Water temperature Sensor 31
Pressure Sensor 33
ISC Valve 34
Air Temperature Sensor 36
Throttle Sensor 41
O2 Sensor 42
Vehicle Speed Sensor 43
For Example :
If the “Check Engine” lamp gives 3 slow blinks (of 1.2 Secs
each) representing the first digit of the failcode viz.,”3"
followed by 1 fast blink (of 0.16 Secs each) representing
the second digit of the failcode viz.,”1" in a cyclic fashion,
thus flashing the code “3 1” indicating that the water Temp
Sensor is faulty (from the table below).
If there are two or more sensors faulty, then the blink
codes are repeated cyclically. For example, if the water
temperature sensor and lambda sensor are faulty then
the blinking codes will be repeated like
..31….42….31….42….
N OTE:
At the end of each diagnosis and rectification of the fault,
‘HISTORY CODE’ is to be erased by opting‘CLEAR MEMORY’
option in HDM 2000 or by removing the battery supply for
atleast 3 minutes.
DIAGNO-
STICS
7
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS
DIAGNOSTICS EMS
4. ECU HANDLING CARE : l Do not use an ECU which has been dropped once.
DIAGNO-
STICS
8
NEXT
INDEX GROUP INDEX
PREVIOUS